An Analysis of English Language Teachers' Perceptions of ...
Transcript of An Analysis of English Language Teachers' Perceptions of ...
AN ANALYSIS OF ENGLISH LANGUAGE TEACHERS’
PERCEPTIONS OF CURRICULUM CHANGE
IN THE UNITED ARAB EMIRATES
Fatma Hamad Alwan
2006
2
An Analysis of English Language Teachers’
Perceptions of Curriculum Change
in the United Arab Emirates
Submitted by Fatima Hamad Ali Alwan, to the University of Exeter as a dissertation for the
degree of Doctor of Education, in teaching English as a Foreign Language, May, 2006.
This dissertation is available for use on the understanding that it is copyright
material and that no quotation from the dissertation may be published without
proper acknowledgement.
I certify that all material in this dissertation which is not my work has been
identified and that no material has previously been submitted and approved for the
award of a degree by this or any other University.
F.H. Alwan
3
Acknowledgements
There is no measure to estimate the learning that I gained from my work on this
dissertation. One lesson, however, stands out: people are pleased to help those who seek to
learn.
It is through the help and the enlightening guidance of the Almighty Allah that I was able to
accomplish this dissertation. I am also grateful to all the helpful people who manifested in
my life and helped me in some fashion: from providing guidance to supplying information
and to providing emotional and psychological support.
My special thanks and appreciation go to:
Dr. Salah Troudi, my first supervisor, for his superb guidance and valuable insight that kept
this dissertation on course throughout the various phases. His support and encouragement
have always been endless. I am proud to have been your student. Thank you!
Dr. Malcolm MacDonald, my second supervisor, for his incredible efforts in reviewing this
dissertation, and for his insightful feedback. Your contribution was exceptional. Thank you!
The words of thanks are not sufficient to express my appreciation for the participants in this
study. My very special gratitude goes to all the teachers for their unconditional love and
support. I would like to thank them for their generous devotion of their time, for their
transparency in responding to the interview questions, and for their faith in me. My dear
and faithful friends, you have touched my life. Thank you!
Further, I would like to acknowledge the service-with-a-smile attitude that I received from
the librarians both in the UK and the UAE who I had the pleasure of meeting while
reviewing literature for this study. Specifically, I would like to thank the librarians in St.
Luke’s Campus in the University of Exeter and the American University of Sharjah.
4
Librarians are the anonymous soldiers behind the success of all academic endeavours.
Thank you!
I would also like to thank my colleagues who helped me in locating references and whose
support and encouragement have been phenomenal. My thanks go to Kamil Osman, my
Ed.D. colleague, Adbulla Al-Mishteghel, English Supervisor in the Eastern Zone, Nawal
Mohammed, English Supervisor in Ajman, and Samia Mukhtar Al-Yousuf, Head of the
Statistics and Documentation Section, Ministry of Education. You have made a difference.
Thank you!
Special thanks go to my beloved husband, Mohammed Alwan, and my dear children, Nauf,
Abdulla and Faisal, for their understanding and their patience. Your love has been my
mentor. Thank you!
Very special thanks go to my dear parents who taught me that no matter how well a job is
done there is still space for improvement. You have instilled persistence in me and inspired
me to pursue my passion. May Allah bless you all!
5
Abstract
This is a qualitative study of English language female secondary school teachers’
perceptions of curriculum change in the United Arab Emirates. It aimed at understanding
curriculum change from the teachers’ perspective. The sample consisted of sixteen female
teachers in three secondary schools who had experience teaching the former and the current
English language curricula. The study was conceived within the interpretive paradigm.
This research method was selected on the basis that people’s perceptions and issues related
to curriculum are more suited to an interpretive approach, which provides thick descriptions
of the phenomenon under study and generates theory. Data collection methods included
repeated recorded face-to-face semi-structured interviews, member-checking group
interviews and document reviews. Interpretation of the data revealed that according to the
research participants, curriculum was synonymous with the materials. Participants agreed
that nothing else had changed other than the books. Teachers had contradictory affective
reactions to curriculum change since they approved of some aspects of change but were
disturbed by other aspects. Their feelings evolved with time to become more positive with
familiarity.
Expressions that teachers used conveyed their low morale and their perceptions of their role
in curriculum change as marginal, inferior and passive; and indicated that they were
excluded from the process of curriculum development. Several curriculum development
processes were found to be lacking. Teacher's voice was not active in the context of the
study due to lack of job security, and issues of hierarchy and control. The study
recommends giving voice to teachers in curriculum change by involving them in
curriculum development processes. The study also recommends eliminating factors that
lead to current defects in the English language curriculum such as the nature of student
assessment; and the unimplemented elements in the curriculum, such as needs analysis,
curriculum evaluation, teacher training and curricular support.
6
Table of Content
Acknowledgements ……………………………………………………………..
Abstract …………………………………………………………………………
Table of contents ………………………………………………………………..
3
5
6
Chapter I: INTRODUCTION………………………………………………..
11
1.1 PURPOSE AND RATIONALE OF THE STUDY ……………………… 13
1.1.1 Personal Profile ……………………………………………………… 13
1.1.2 Practical Purpose ……………………………………………………. 15
1.1.3 Personal Purpose ……………………………………………………. 16
1.1.3 Rationale of the Study ………………………………………………. 16
1.2 SIGNIFICANCE OF THE STUDY ………………………………………...
17
1.3 RESEARCH QUESTIONS ………………………………………………… 18
1.4 STRUCTURE OF THE THESIS …………………………………………... 19
Chapter II: BACKGROUND OF THE STUDY …………………………... 21
2.1 A GENERAL BACKGROUND …………………………………………… 21
2.1.1 Education in the UAE: A Brief History ……………………………… 21
2.1.2 Structure of the UAE Education System …………………………….. 22
2.1.3 Status of English in the UAE …………………………………………
23
2.2 THE EL CURRICULUM IN THE UAE …………………………………... 24
2.2.1 History of the English Curriculum …………………………………. 24
2.2.2 The Goals of the EL Curriculum in the UAE ………………………. 28
2.2.3. The Context of Teaching English in the UAE ……………………... 29
2.2.4 The Current EL Curriculum in the UAE …………………………… 29
2.2.5 Methods for Teaching English in the UAE …………………………. 30
2.2.6 Assessment in the UAE Curriculum ………………………………... 31
2.2.6.1 Student Assessment in the Curriculum ……………………… 32
7
2.2.6.2 Evaluation of Curriculum Materials ………………………… 33
2.2.7 The EL Teacher in the UAE ………………………………………….. 33
2.2.8 Teacher Training and Teacher Evaluation ……………………………. 36
CHAPTER III: LITERATURE REVIEW ………………………………… 41
3.1 CONCEPTUAL FRAMEWORK ………………………………………….. 41
3.2 TERMINOLOGY ………………………………………………………….
44
3.2.1 Teachers’ Perceptions: Definition and Synthesis of Research
Findings …………………………………………………………….
45
3.2.2 Educational Change: Definition and Synthesis of Research Findings 49
3.2.3 Curriculum: Definition and Synthesis of Research Findings ……….. 52
3.2.3.1 The EL Curriculum ………………………………………….. 56
3.2.3.2 The Components of the EL Curriculum Development
Process ………………………………………………………
57
3.2.3.3 Teachers’ Roles in Curriculum Development: Issues of
Voice versus Power …………………………………………..
58
3.3 STUDIES ON CURRICULUM CHANGE ………………………………..
60
3.3.1 International Studies on Curriculum …………………………………. 61
3.3.1.1 EL Teachers’ Perceptions of Curriculum Change …………… 61
3.3.1.2 EL Teachers’ Roles in Curriculum Development ……………. 64
3.3.1.3 Teachers’ Perceptions of Curriculum Change ……………….. 68
3.3.2 Studies on Curriculum in Arab Countries and the UAE ……………... 69
3.3.2.1 Curriculum in Arab States ……………………………………. 70
3.3.2.2 Curriculum in the UAE ………………………………………. 71
A. Curriculum Evaluation and Roles of Teachers in
Curriculum Change in the UAE …………………………..
72
B. Teacher Training and Teacher Evaluation in the UAE ….. 73
C. EL Teaching Methods in the UAE ……………………….. 75
8
D. Studies on Learner Needs in the UAE …………………... 75
E. Teachers’ Work Conditions in the UAE …………………. 76
3.3.3 Reflections on the Methods Used for Researching Teachers’
Perceptions and Curriculum Change …………………………………
77
CHAPTER IV: METHODOLOGY …………………………………………. 81
4.1 Research Design ……………………………………………………………. 81
4.2 Theoretical Rationale for Choice of Current Research Method ……………. 83
4.3 The Sample ………………………………………………………………… 84
4.4 Gaining Access …………………………………………………………….. 86
4.5 Data Collection …………………………………………………………….. 87
4.5.1 Document Reviews ………………………………………………….. 88
4.5.2 Interviews ……………………………………………………………. 89
4.6 Procedures …………………………………………………………………. 92
4.7 Data Analysis ……………………………………………………………… 94
4.8 Authenticity Criteria: Provisions for Trustworthiness …………………….. 96
4.8.1 Credibility ……………………………………………………………. 97
4.8.2 Transferability ………………………………………………………... 99
4.8.3 Dependability ………………………………………………………… 100
4.9 Ethical Considerations …………………………………………………….. 101
4.10 Limitations of the Study ………………………………………………….. 104
CHAPTER V: FINDINGS AND DISCUSSION ……………………………. 107
5.1. TEACHERS’ PERCEPTIONS OF CURRICULUM CHANGE ………….. 107
5.1.1 “Curriculum is the books” ………………………………………………... 108
5.1.2 Curriculum Change: A change of books …………………………...…….. 110
5.1.2.1 “When we say curriculum change, the books are changed.” …….. 110
9
5.1.2.2 Stability in Teaching Techniques: a point of controversy…….….. 112
5.1.2.3 The Teacher’s Book: A neglected innovation ………………….... 115
5.1.2.4 Adaptability of Teaching Materials: “We have to teach
every point” ………….……………………………………………
116
5.1.2.5 “Testing is the same old traditional way” ………………………... 120
5.1.2.6 Teachers’ Strategies to Cope with Curriculum Change …………. 123
5.1.3 Affective Issues in Curriculum Change ………………………………….. 127
5.1.3.1 Mixed Feelings …………………………………………………... 128
5.1.3.2 Tacit Resistance to Change ……………………………………… 132
5.1.3.3 Teacher Change Cycle: From Excitement to Frustration
to Confidence ……………………………………..…………….
132
5.2 TEACHERS’ ROLES IN CURRICULUM CHANGE …………………….
134
5.2.1 Teachers’ Roles in Developing the Curriculum ……………………... 135
5.2.1.1 Needs Analysis: “I wasn’t part of it.” ……………………….. 135
5.2.1.2 Curriculum Evaluation: “If nobody listens, why should we
speak?” …………………………………………..…………...
138
5.2.2 Teachers’ Roles in Implementing the Curriculum …………………... 141
5.2.2.1 “I am just the teacher” ………………………………………. 142
5.2.2.3 Teachers’ Perceptions of their Roles in Curriculum
Development: Implications of Teacher Metaphors ………….
145
5.2.2.4 Authority in Curriculum Change …………………………... 148
5.2.2.5 Teachers’ Voice in Curriculum Change: Retrospective
and prospective ……………………………………………
151
5.3 TRAINING AND SUPPORT DURING CURRICULUM CHANGE ……..
154
5.3.1 Teachers’ Perceptions of Curriculum Support: “I call it lack
of support” ……………………………………………………………
155
5.3.2 Teachers’ Perceptions of Training …………………………………... 160
5.3.3. Self–development Activities ………………………………………... 166
10
CHAPTER VI: RECOMMENDATIONS ……………………………….......
169
6.1 Phases of Change ………………………………………………………...… 169
6.2 Affective Issues during Curriculum Change………………........................... 171
6.3 Teachers’ Roles in Curriculum Change ……………………………………. 172
6.4 Teachers’ Perceptions of the Process of Curriculum Change ……………… 173
6.5 Teachers’ Metaphors as Expressions of Perceptions ………………………. 174
6.6 Contributions of the Study ………………………………………………… 175
APPENDICES …………………………………………………………………
180
Appendix I: A. The Goals of the EL Curriculum in the UAE ………….. 181
B. Excerpts from the 1994 Curriculum Document ……….. 183
Appendix II: A Description of the Materials Taught in the Secondary
Stage: English for the Emirates 10, 11 and 12 ………………...
186
Appendix III: English Test Paper Specifications in the Secondary Stage……. 194
Appendix IV: A. What is curriculum? ……………………………………….. 195
B. The Components of the EL Curriculum Development
Process: A critical account …………………………...
198
C. Teachers’ Roles in the EL Curriculum: A historical
Overview ……………………………………………...
208
Appendix V: Letter of Invitation to Participate (School principals) ………… 212
Appendix VI: Address of Invitation to Participate (EL Teachers) ……......... 214
Appendix VII: A. Interview Schedule (First Round) …….............................. 215
B. Interview Schedule (Second Round) ………………......... 218
Appendix VIII: Sample Transcripts of Interviews ……………….................... 219
BIBLIOGRAPHY ……………………………………………………………..
251
11
CHAPTER I
INTRODUCTION
INTRODUCTION
Developing the curriculum is a priority in education in the United Arab Emirates (UAE).
Through the curriculum, the country can manifest its stated educational goals to achieve its
own development (Educational Policy, 1996). Considering that curriculum change is a
healthy sign of development (The 2020 Vision, 2000), in the past three decades, which
constitute the whole history of modern education in the country (Al Hai, 1990), several
attempts have been made to develop curricula that reflect the growing educational needs
(Al Housani, 1996). Curricula in basic subjects like the Arabic language, religion,
mathematics and the English language have been updated several times (Abu Hussein,
1999).
Like the other basic school subjects, the English language (EL) curriculum, which is the
focus of this study, has undergone several attempts at change (see 2.2.1). But unlike other
subjects, the EL curriculum faces several challenges. First and foremost, EL teaching
methodology should be in accordance with international trends in foreign language
teaching, as the development of methods that suit the local context requires research that is
beyond the capability of a country whose educational system did not exceed undergraduate
12
education, where research could be supervised, until recently. Doing research, other than
for academic purposes, is not a common practice in the UAE (Alwan, 2000).
Second, learning a foreign language not only is dependent on providing the means for
learning it but transcends this to be contingent on the individual’s capabilities for learning a
foreign language (Khanji, 2000). As English is a compulsory school ‘subject’, efforts are
directed at making the students ‘succeed’ at it (Ghareeb, 1996). This includes helping
individuals with low language learning capabilities to ‘pass’ or they would not be able to
move up the grades (Alraway, 1988).
The third and fourth challenges are to have teaching materials that are flexible enough to
allow teachers to go beyond what is prescribed, and have teachers who are capable of
understanding learner needs and delivering the curriculum in ways that are compatible with
learning styles (Khanji, 2000). Consequently, the EL curriculum should be continuously
revised to reflect the emergent learning needs. This, undoubtedly, requires constant
monitoring of all aspects of the curriculum as well as definite plans for change.
The way change is introduced determines the success in achieving the goals of the
curriculum. While blueprints for change do not exist, planning is essential (Fullan, 1993 &
1999). Apparently, very little is known about the process of curriculum development in the
UAE as part of curriculum change since documentation is weak (Shaw et al, 1995), and
very little has been done to research this issue (see 3.3). Previous studies in the UAE focus
on single aspects of curriculum and mostly on teacher training and evaluation of teaching
(e.g. Al Mansouri, 2001; Al-Nayadi, 1989; Azzari & Mansour, 1998; Badri, 1991). This
13
investigation is an attempt to fill in this gap in knowledge by portraying a picture of
curriculum change in the UAE.
1.1 PURPOSE AND RATIONALE OF THE STUDY
There are various reasons why I was interested in the topic of this study. In this section, I
shall explain the practical and personal purposes as well as the rationale for carrying out
this investigation. Before doing this, I think that a personal profile of my experience with
curriculum will be helpful to the reader in understanding the underpinnings of my
intentions.
1.1.1 Personal Profile
My previous experience with the EL curriculum makes me eligible for carrying out this
study using the selected methodology. To help the reader understand the underpinnings of
dealing with the topic from its current perspective, this overview contains my personal
profile in this regard. In this brief account, I shall integrate reflections related to the focus
of the study within the description of my experience.
I worked as an EL teacher from 1985 to 1990, and a senior teacher from 1990 to 1992.
Throughout these years, I have not seen people who were interested in my views of the
curriculum. Even when I had experienced change in curriculum from one to another in
1990 (see 2.2.1), nothing was done to obtain feedback from teachers. Nonetheless, I took
the initiative in writing a detailed report about the new curriculum (Alwan, 1990). From my
14
experience, the teaching materials had been the only signal for that change since the other
aspects of the curriculum, such as assessment and teaching methodology, remained the
same.
From 1993 to 2003, I took the position of a supervisor and was responsible for following up
the curriculum through evaluating and training teachers, and monitoring students’ results.
Since I had experienced frustrations earlier in my career with regard to a perceived lack of
interest in my opinions from curriculum developers, I tried to give voice to my teachers by
encouraging them to express their views about the ‘materials’ as the aspect of the
curriculum which was pivotal to their work. In spite of my attempts to communicate their
views to the people in charge of developing the curriculum (Alwan, 1995), no action was
taken with regard to the documented feedback. At that time, the curriculum materials
remained without modifications (see 2.2.4), like other aspects of the curriculum which had
received the least or no change at all (see 2.2.3).
After completing this study, I plan to join the EL department at the Curricula Development
Centre in the MoE and start a new career in curriculum development. Prior experiences in
this field include my involvement in the Project for Evaluating National Curricula in 1999
(Loughrey et al, 1999), the Project for Writing the new English Teaching Curriculum
Document in 2000, and the Thematic Maps of the Curriculum in 2001. I had also
participated as a materials writer in the Curricula Development Centre for three consecutive
years (2000- 2002) during which I had co-authored three sets of materials; two of them had
been for the secondary stage, Grades 10 and 11. Additionally, in these three years, I had
been in charge of the nuclear training for supervisors, which is the first stage for cascade
training. Such training aims at orienting a representative group of supervisors to the new
15
materials, and familiarising them with the training materials that included handouts and
worksheets for training the teachers in their educational zones. This prior experience as an
EL teacher, a supervisor and a curriculum writer lead me to the focus of this study. Simply
put, I wanted to understand how EL teachers perceive curriculum change. The practical and
personal purposes for doing this inquiry are explained below.
1.1.2 Practical Purpose
Curriculum development in the UAE does not appear to be systematic (Alwan, 2003a;
Loughrey et al, 1999). According to Loughrey et al (1999), several components of the
curriculum seem to be lacking within the process. For instance, curriculum goals and
objectives do not seem to be based on actual students’ needs. Also, whether commercial or
locally prepared, materials do not usually respond to feedback from teachers who call for
adaptation of content to students’ needs. Further, there is no definite strategy to ameliorate
assessment and teaching methods or even teacher training. Obviously, in the history of
curriculum change in the MoE, the Project for Evaluating National Curricula in 1999 was
the only comprehensive project to research the field in this regard since it included all the
basic subjects taught, among which is the EL curriculum (Loughrey et al, 1999). Prior to
this, it is claimed that a needs analysis survey had been conducted before embarking on the
production of the current set of materials in 1992 to which there is no evidence except in
the English Language Curriculum Document of 1994 (1994 Curriculum Document
henceforth). Obviously, such attempts had been rare events rather than continuous
processes.
16
Therefore, I plan to investigate how the EL curriculum is developed and changed from the
teachers’ perspectives. I believe it is a suitable starting point to investigate the topic from
the perspective of those who are supposed to be key players in developing the curriculum
(Markee, 1997). Therefore, I aim to understand what is done to integrate teacher voice in
the EL curriculum development in the UAE.
1.1.3 Personal Purpose
At this point, I would like to make it clear that this study is not an evaluative one. Although
a good part of the data obtained from the informants falls into this category, I am not
planning to consult other people who are concerned in the whole process of curriculum
change such as curriculum developers, administrators, students and parents, as in the
tradition of evaluative research (Guba & Lincoln, 1989). On the contrary, I seek to outline
the process of curriculum change from the point of view of teachers only. Since I am with
the view that research is a cycle where no end is reached as the outcomes raise other
questions (Popper, 1970), I shall outline issues that require further investigations and
present hypotheses that may emerge from this inquiry. Thus, by investigating the topic, I
seek self-development for myself.
1.1.4 Rationale of the Study
In consideration of the above research purposes, and with reference to the fact that there is
a lack of empirical research in this field, the study is underpinned by the rationale to
understand curriculum change in the UAE. Thus investigating the issue is expected to lead
17
to the identification of potential weaknesses and strengths in the process. Doing it from the
teachers’ perspective eliminates potential bias if other individuals are included. In my
opinion, curriculum development is too critical an issue to be left without investigation.
While the 1999 project for curriculum evaluation (Loughrey et al, 1999) had been
illuminative, I think that empirical research should continue to be the basis for curriculum
change. Up to date, no other study in the UAE has been carried out to understand the
process of curriculum change. This inquiry is an attempt to unravel areas in which other
investigations can be done. Thus by investigating curriculum change and outlining the
process or framework adopted in curriculum development from the teachers’ perspectives,
this study is expected to inform current practice.
1.2 SIGNIFICANCE OF THE STUDY
Fraenkel and Wallen (2000) warn against the assumption that investigating non-researched
topics would evidently make the study important. Bearing this in mind, I piloted the topic
of the study while working on another research project related to managing innovations in
the UAE. The findings of the study showed dissatisfaction with the management of
curriculum change; that teachers were excluded from the process and that training was not
provided to teachers (Alwan, 2003b). With intensive reading, I decided on teachers’
perceptions of curriculum change as the main focus of the investigation. While there is
ample research around the world on the topics of curriculum development and change (e.g.
Burns, 1995; Elliott et al, 1999; Gibbs, 1998; Ling, 2000; Nunan, 1988; Sharkey, 2004;
Webb, 2002), still some questions remained unanswered. I expected that the study might
18
lead to useful knowledge (Burton, 1996; Frankael & Wallen, 2000), as little is known about
the topic of curriculum change in the UAE.
To sum up, the study focusses on understanding EL teachers’ perceptions of curriculum
change in the UAE. The purpose of the study is twofold: practical and personal. On the one
hand, I am particularly interested to learn about curriculum change and teachers’ roles in
curriculum development. On the other hand, I need to gain more insight into the subject
area for a prospective career. The inquiry is also guided by the rationale that no previous
research has been carried out in this area. Therefore, I hope to contribute to knowledge
through investigating a topic that has not been considered from the current perspective, by
answering the research questions presented in the next section.
1.3 RESEARCH QUESTIONS
The study sought to answer the following three major questions and their subordinate ones:
1. How do English language (EL) teachers in public secondary schools in the UAE perceive
curriculum change?
a. What do EL teachers understand by ‘curriculum’ in the UAE context?
b. What do EL teachers understand by ‘curriculum change’ in the UAE context?
c. How do EL teachers feel about ‘curriculum change’ in the UAE context?
19
2. How do EL teachers perceive their role in the process of curriculum change?
a. How do EL teachers perceive their role in developing the curriculum?
b. How do EL teachers perceive their role in implementing the new curriculum?
3. How do EL teachers perceive their training in implementing the new curriculum?
a. How do EL teachers perceive support during curriculum change?
b. How do EL teachers perceive their training during curriculum change?
c. What forms of professional development do teachers engage in in relation to
curriculum change?
1.4 STRUCTURE OF THE THESIS
The thesis is divided into six chapters as follows:
Chapter One has introduced the study. It has explained the purpose, rationale and
significance of the study.
Chapter Two provides the background information necessary to familiarise the reader with
the context of the study.
20
Chapter Three presents a literature review relating to the focus of the study, and aims to
provide a framework for understanding curriculum change in the UAE.
Chapter Four explains the methodology of the study, its design and the philosophical
standpoints that underpin the choice of methods.
Chapter Five reports the findings of the study and discusses them in the light of published
literature. It also draws conclusions based on the data.
Chapter Six summarises the main findings and recommendations of the study. It also gives
suggestions for further research.
21
CHAPTER II
BACKGROUND OF THE STUDY
INTRODUCTION
This chapter gives the background information needed to understand contextual issues
related to the topic under investigation. It is divided into two parts. The first part has a
threefold perspective. First, it gives a brief history of general education in the country.
Second, it describes the structure of the educational system. Last, it highlights the status of
the English language in the country. The second part of the chapter is concerned with the
EL curriculum in general. It gives an overview of issues related to the EL curriculum such
as the materials used, the structure and the methods used for teaching English, and
curriculum evaluation. Finally, it discusses the issues related to the EL teachers in the UAE
2.1 A GENERAL BACKGROUND
2.1.1 Education in the UAE: A Brief History
The UAE is a young state that was founded in 1971 after the British colonial withdrawal
from the Arabian Gulf. It constitutes of seven emirates: Abu-Dhabi, which is the capital,
Dubai, Sharjah, Fujairah, Ras-Al Khaimah, Umm Al Quwain and Ajman. The modern
educational system is recent but well-financed compared to other developing countries
(Suliman, 2000). Started in the early fifties with financial support from Kuwait, a
22
neighbouring Arab country, a few schools formed the foundation for developing the system
of education in the UAE. Teachers were sponsored by other Arab government aid
programmes as well (Alraway, 1988; Bel Fekih, 1993; Khlalifat, 1992). After the federation
of the emirates in 1971, and with the impact of oil revenues, education gained better
support and the number of schools increased (Alraway, 1988; Khlalifat, 1992). In 1977, the
development of education reached a turning point with the establishment of the UAE
University in Al-Ain, in the emirate of Abu-Dhabi (Al-Hai, 1990; Badri, 1991). With the
increasing demands for higher education opportunities for citizens, four Higher Colleges of
Technology were opened in 1988 (Badri, 1991) with branches in several emirates.
Nowadays, education has expanded at all levels, as there are other state-funded and private
higher education institutions all around the UAE (Khlalifat, 1992).
2.1.2 Structure of the UAE Education System
The MoE is in charge of offering educational services throughout each of the seven
emirates (Badri, 1991). It is also responsible for the planning and development of the UAE
educational system (Al-Taneiji, 2001). Currently, there are ten local authorities known as
educational zones in the UAE. Each zone supervises public and private schools within its
authority. The zones have direct contact with the main offices of the MoE and all
educational decisions are centrally made (Badri, 1991; Sulaiman, 1987; Al-Taneiji, 2001).
Formal education is comprised of four levels: kindergarten, elementary, secondary and
tertiary (Al-Hai, 1990; Al-Nayadi, 1989). The kindergarten stage consists of two years
before the elementary stage and is optional (Alraway, 1988). Students are admitted to the
elementary level when they are 5 years old. The elementary stage, which is currently
23
known as the Basic Education Cycle starting from the beginning of the school year in 2003,
is from Grade 1 to Grade 9. In this basic stage, students are taught general subjects which
include Arabic, English, Mathematics, Islamic education, social studies and general science
(Alraway, 1988). The secondary education cycle, which started in 1958-1959 (Al-Araj,
1999) and which the study focusses upon, consists of three years. In Grades 11 and 12
students are divided into two main streams: Arts and Science according to their preferences.
English, Arabic and Islamic Education are taught in both streams. The Arts students learn
simplified Mathematics and Physics beside History, Geography and Social Studies while
the science students learn Mathematics, Biology, Physics, Geology and Chemistry
(Alraway, 1988; Balfakih, 2003). In Grades 10 and 11, the end-of-semester exams are
unified among schools at the zone level only, whereas a general secondary school leaving
exam is administered to students of Grade 12, which is unified at the state level (Alraway,
1988).
2.1.3 Status of English in the UAE
English maintains a privileged position in the UAE as it is taught as a compulsory foreign
language from Grade 1 in state schools, as explained above, and from kindergarten in
private schools. With the increasing public awareness of the importance of English, the
language has gained the status of a second language. It serves as the lingua franca in
various government offices and the majority of private companies (Al Mansouri, 2001;
Guefrachi & Troudi, 2000; Loughrey et al, 1999). It is also the main medium of instruction
in tertiary education. Nonetheless, in public schools, it is considered as a school subject
(Alwan, 1995 & 2004; Guefrachi & Troudi, 2000; Zaidan, 1995).
24
In the late seventies, English was taught starting from Grade 4. However, with the
expanding awareness of the importance of improving students’ performance in the
language to equip them for the labour market as well as for pursuing undergraduate studies;
and following the results of a needs analysis and a successful experiment on teaching
English to young learners, English started to be taught from Grade 1 in 1992 (Al Housani,
1996; Guefrachi & Troudi, 2000). Currently, students in Grades 1 to 3 take an average of
70 hours of English during one academic year; while students from Grades 4 to 6 take an
average of 100 hours, and the rest of the classes have about 120 hours of English per year
(Owais, 2005).
2.2 THE EL CURRICULUM IN THE UAE
In the history of education in the UAE several curricula were adopted for teaching English,
some included commercial teaching materials, and others were locally prepared. This
section gives an overview of the EL curricula adopted in the country from its early
formation up to date. It then moves to list the goals for teaching English in the state. After
that, it gives a description of the curriculum used in the secondary stage as it is the focus of
this study.
2.2.1 History of the English Curriculum
The first unified curriculum in the UAE public schools evolved in 1972 (Al-Hai, 1990). As
Suliman (2000:51) describes it “The curriculum is traditional and textbook-based. The
25
teacher and the textbook are often the only source of knowledge”. The normal procedure is
that the MoE prescribes one set of books: a textbook and a workbook for each grade, and
provides the schools with copies for all the students and their teachers. This is applicable to
all the state schools throughout the state. Initially, the first EL course adopted in the late
1960s was based on the Grammar-Translation Method and was produced by Longman. It
was then replaced by a new set of books by Longman in the early 1970s. Then, in the late
seventies, the Crescent English Course (Crescent henceforth) was introduced. It was based
on the Communicative Approach. The course was replaced in 1987 with new sets of books
that were more eclectic as they were not purely communicative but catered for grammar as
well, meeting the demands of local needs.
The curriculum before the Crescent was a continuation of that which was introduced by
Kuwait and its educational missions in the UAE. The Crescent may be considered the first
curriculum to address the local needs for acquiring practical communication skills in
English to meet the demands of the country’s growth (Suliman, 2000). The Crescent, which
was also used in other Gulf States like Qatar and Kuwait, was based on a functional
syllabus. It was claimed to have been designed specifically to suit the Gulf States (Nunn,
1996). Although the communicative approach was the prescribed method, teachers did not
abide by it (Al-Nayadi, 1989). This might have been for cultural reasons, as in other parts
of the world (Holliday, 1997; see section 2.2.3).
In 1990, the textbooks were replaced with the National Curriculum English for UAE, based
on the intention to have national curriculum materials (Owais, 2005). Consequently, a
committee of supervisors was formed. It was headed by the Undersecretary of Education,
and several sub-committees were formed to produce a set of materials for every stage. At
26
that time, English was taught from Grade 4 to Grade 12, so nine sets of materials were
prepared in all. These included a textbook, a workbook and a class cassette for every level.
In addition, flash cards, pictures and posters were included for levels 4 to 6. English for
UAE has been criticised for its unclear approach as the sets of materials did not include a
teaching manual for teachers. Rather, there had been one general guide that listed the goals
and methods recommended, which were based on the communicative approach. Research
during this period shows that the teachers abandoned many aspects of the communicative
approach (Alwan, 1995; see 2.2.3 below). Although teaching a foreign language benefits
from learning about its culture, the Arab culture rather than the foreign culture was the
basis for English for UAE (Owais, 2005).
As Loughrey et al (1999:31) observe, English for UAE “reflects the content of the
Crescent…(but) the design and organisation of the course components (are)…incomplete”.
As the materials were all authored hastily within almost nine months, they were introduced
directly into schools without piloting or training. They remained in use for several years
without modifications other than corrections of misprints (Loughrey et al, 1999).
In 1992, a new set of materials was prepared for Grade 1 within a new curriculum: English
for the Emirates (the 1994 Curriculum Document) which claims to have taken the
recommendations of a needs analysis survey (see 1.1.2 and Appendix I-B). In the following
years, a new set of materials was introduced to each subsequent stage from Grade 1 to
Grade 12. The course was completed in September 2003 with the final set of materials for
Grade 12. The process of change took 12 years, during which the previous materials
remained without modifications. This meant that the teaching materials of the former
curriculum were in use for 8 to 10 years in the secondary stage without reviews. This new
27
curriculum also suffered from the same drawback as the previous one which was lack of
significant modifications (see 2.2.6.2 below).
The methodology recommended for English for the Emirates was eclectic with a bias
toward the communicative approach. The curriculum materials included a teaching manual
for every level but the teaching suggestions were found to be merely general directions
rather than specific ones (Gardner & Abu Libde, 1995). As in the previous curriculum, this
one did not cater for the foreign culture as well (Owais, 2005). The following table
summarises the sets of materials according to the levels. The years in which English for the
Emirates was introduced are provided.
Grade Level
Crescent English for UAE English for the Emirates
1 - - Book 1 1992-1993 2 - - Book 2 1993-1994 3 - - Book 3 1994-1995 4 Book 1 Book 1 Book 4 1995-1996 5 Book 2 Book 2 Book 5 1996-1997 6 Book 3 Book 3 Book 6 1997-1998 7 Book 4 Book 4 Book 7 1998-1999 8 Book 5 Book 5 Book 8 1999-2000 9 Book 6 Book 6 Book 9 2000-2001 10 Book 7 Book 7 Book 10 2001-2002 11 Book 8 Book 8 Book 11 2002-2003 12 Book 9 Book 9 Book 12 2003-2004
Table (1) Sets of materials prescribed in the three main EL curricula in the UAE. It is worth pointing out that the main apparent aspect of the curriculum in the review
above is the preparation of material. There is no indication that any sort of needs
analysis had been prepared before setting the goals of the current EL curriculum in the
28
UAE (Loughrey et al, 1999). However, a needs analysis survey was carried out in 2000
on which two important documents were based. The first one was a new curriculum
document that was also prepared in consequence to the recognised deficiencies as a
result of the Curriculum Evaluation Project (see 1.1.1). The second one contained the
curriculum thematic maps. I participated in both of these projects, as mentioned earlier.
Both documents are still undergoing revision. While both of these are developmental
projects for the secondary school curriculum, I shall not refer to them again as they do
not concern the current study.
2.2.2 The Goals of the EL Curriculum in the UAE
Although the general goals for teaching English in the UAE (see Appendix I-A) reflect
the importance of English, they do not seem to have been based on any needs analysis
(Owais, 2005). Based on my previous familiarity with the curriculum materials in all
levels and as a review of the curriculum materials reveals, there is a serious gap
between the curriculum goals and the curriculum embedded in English for the Emirates,
which is the current curriculum in the country (also Owais, 2005). The basis on which
the goals were established could not be identified in any of the MoE documents. In
addition, the 1994 curriculum document cannot be claimed to have been the basis for at
least the first two sets of materials as it was published two years later, nor had it been
the basis for the other sets of materials (Loughrey et al, 1999).
29
2.2.3. The Context of Teaching English in the UAE
Schools in the UAE are gender segregated. The school year, from September to June, is
divided into two semesters with a two-week spring holiday in January. All schools operate
five days a week, Saturday to Wednesday, with a two-day weekend except during end-of-
semester examinations during which the weekend holiday for schools is on Friday. The day
at school starts from 8 a.m. for girls schools and 7:30 a.m. for boys schools, with a morning
assembly that lasts for 15 minutes. The school day consists of 7 lessons per day of 45
minutes each. There is a 30-minute break after the first three lessons and a 10-minute break
before the final lesson. This is also considered a prayer break in some schools. There are
also 5-minute breaks between lessons to allow teachers the time to move from one class to
another. The last class finishes at 2:30 p.m. in girls schools and 1:30 p.m. in boys schools.
In some schools, the five-minute breaks are cancelled to allow one extra class for extra-
curricular activities, unified exams, remedial work classes or extra lessons for classes that
are behind in the coverage of the syllabus of certain subjects. In the secondary stage,
students learn English in 6 classes a week. The total number of hours in each semester is
approximately 60 hours (Owais, 2005).
2.2.4 The Current EL Curriculum in the UAE
The curriculum used in the secondary cycle when the study was conducted and this review
was written was English for the Emirates. The sets of materials for each level are referred
to as ‘Book’. Book 10 was introduced for Grade 10 in 2001, Book 11 for Grade 11 in 2002
and Book 12 for Grade 12 in September 2003 (see table in 2.2.1). The current set of
30
materials of each level consists of three books: the Pupil’s Book, the Workbook and the
Teacher’s Book in addition to one or two cassettes that contain a recording of all the texts
in the Pupil’s Book. Although the materials were meant to be for one cycle, each set of
them takes a different design to some extent regarding the structure of the content (see
Appendix II for a brief overview of the content of each set of materials).
2.2.5 Methods for Teaching English in the UAE
The 1994 Curriculum Document states that English for the Emirates has benefited from
previous courses used for teaching English in the UAE in becoming eclectic. It has “a
general ‘approach’ rather than a specific ‘methodology’” (Curriculum Document, 1994:22).
As the communicative approach has been in use for many years, the 1994 Curriculum
Document recommends a continuation of the practice. It recognises that the teachers have
also been employing other methods of teaching to meet the needs of the learners, thus it
recommends the use of other methods as well. It also highlights the successes of the
Grammar-Translation Method in teaching the reading and writing skills and the suitability
of the Direct Method for teaching highly motivated students. Successes of other methods
like the Structural Method and the Humanistic Methods are also appreciated in serving the
purposes of teaching the language from certain perspectives. Consequently, eclecticism is
thought to be the ideal solution as it recommends using the best of every method. The 1994
Curriculum Document states the following: “Our approach is eclectic or balanced because
we continue to draw inspiration from any method that has produced results” (Curriculum
Document, 1994:25). Thus grammar is recommended to be taught when relevant in
accordance with the Grammar-Translation Method, and learning by doing is emphasised as
in the tradition of the Total Physical Response Method. In addition, a variety of techniques
31
are recommended for teaching vocabulary depending on the nature of the words. For this
the following techniques are recommended: realia, models, pictures, miming, definition,
translation, deduction or synonyms and antonyms. Communicative techniques are
recommended for teaching the four skills: listening, speaking, reading and writing. In
addition, co-curricular activities are emphasised especially at the secondary level. Further,
the teachers are also encouraged to prepare educational aids to accompany the prescribed
teaching materials (see more excerpts from the 1994 Curriculum Document in Appendix I-
B).
While this is the case in policy, according to research findings, teachers had abandoned
essential features of the communicative approach even before the introduction of the
English for the Emirates (Al Mansouri, 2001; Alwan 1995; Gardner & Abu Libde, 1995).
With the absence of a detailed teacher’s manual, the choice of techniques was left to the
discretion of teachers. Generally, the dominant techniques were inductive ones based on
input from teachers (Suliman, 2000) or those based on Grammar-Translation (Alwan, 1995;
Ghareeb, 1996; Loughrey et al, 1999).
2.2.6 Assessment in the UAE Curriculum
Assessment in the curriculum involves assessment of students’ proficiencies as well as
evaluation of the materials used. This section explains how students’ performance in the
language is assessed in general. Then it proceeds to argue against the inefficiency of the
evaluation of the curriculum material.
32
2.2.6.1 Student Assessment in the Curriculum
As the Directory of Distribution of Marks (1998) demonstrates, the system of assessment
consists of 50 marks based on written exams and 50 marks based on oral assessment of the
student’s performance in the language, centred on his or her participation in the classroom,
and his or her responses to the teacher during oral discussion. However, final examinations
depend on written exams only and are believed to be the basic systematic method for
monitoring students’ progress (Hokal, 1999). There are two main assessments in each
semester that are to be averaged with the students’ results in their final exam at the end of
the semester. Generally, promotion from grade to grade is based on students’ obtaining the
minimum average; otherwise, they repeat the class. The secondary stage suffers high
percentages of students repeating classes when they fail in three subjects or they fail in the
repeated exam even for one subject (Hokal, 1999; Shaw et al, 1995; Tantawi, 1995).
Loughrey et al (1999) observe that exam results are misleading as they show average high
scores while the students’ attainment is basically low. This supports the findings of Hokal
(1999) and Shaw et al (1995) who report the high percentages of students repeating classes.
Similarly, Al Mansouri (2001) and Guefrachi and Troudi (2000) report that students have
low standards of achievement in English. In general, examinations in the UAE are believed
to have a washback effect on learners as they encourage rote learning (Suliman, 2000;
Tantawi, 1995). Khanji’s (2000) research findings show that certain measures are not
catered for in exam formats. Similarly, Altraifi (1999) states that there are negative aspects
associated with exams such as focussing on memorisation of texts. Likewise, Zaidan
(1995) observes that English language exams test the students’ ability to memorise rules
33
and vocabulary items rather than their ability to express themselves in English as a foreign
language (also Gardner & Abu Libde, 1995). Most students who reach the secondary cycle
are not able to use even simple sentences to express themselves (Loughrey et al, 1999).
Consequently, there is a need for introducing alternative means of assessment to combat
exam washback effect and unsatisfactory attainment (Khanji, 2000; Owais, 2005). An
overview of the type of exam questions shows how the test paper encourages memorisation
(see Appendix III).
2.2.6.2 Evaluation of Curriculum Materials
Several researchers have found that evaluation of curriculum materials in general was not
systematic as there are no clearly specified channels for teachers to convey their feedback
(Loughrey et al, 1999; Shaw et al, 1995). As Alwan (2003b) points out, volunteer teachers
complete open-ended questionnaires about the ‘books’ on an annual basis. However,
studies show that no inherent modifications are normally noticed as what gets to be
corrected is mainly the printing errors (Loughrey et al, 1999). Perhaps the only significant
evaluation project, however, is the Curricula Evaluation Project in December, 1999, which
stands out as the only attempt to formally evaluate the curriculum materials as mentioned
earlier.
2.2.7 The EL Teacher in the UAE
Basically, the UAE depends heavily on recruiting staff from other Arab countries
(Guefrachi & Troudi, 2000; Hokal, 1999). In the academic year 2003-2004, the total
34
number of teachers reached 10,010 of which 3,275 were EL teachers. There were 1,335
male teachers and 1,940 female teachers (Summary of Educational Statistics, 2004). The
minimum qualification required in the past was a two-year teaching diploma in addition to
the high school certificate, or a graduate degree in English language from the colleges of
Arts (Guefrachi & Troudi, 2000). Currently, diploma teachers are being replaced by
teachers who have a graduate degree in education specialising in teaching English (Owais,
2005).
With regard to recruitment, the UAE has defined but unstable hiring procedures. Those
hired to teach English need not be graduates of faculties of education. While some teachers
who work in primary schools hold teaching diplomas, most of the secondary school
teachers are graduates of faculties of Arts with specialisation in English language, English
literature or translation. Emirati B.A. holders and other Arab teachers resident in the
country (who have a B.A. and a minimum of three years teaching experience in private
schools in the UAE) sit for a written exam based on knowledge of educational theories and
the English language. After correction, only those who get more than 60 marks out of 100
are called for an oral interview. As a standard procedure, Arab teachers from Egypt, Jordan
and Syria resident in their countries sit for an exam organised specially for them. The
interviewing committee travels to their countries to interview those who pass the written
exam. Those who are recruited travel on the expenses of the MoE for a one year contract.
Some Arab countries also send teachers according to the lending agreement that has been
established with the governments of both countries based on exchanges of students and
teachers such as Egypt and Tunisia (Al-Nabeh, 1982). Starting from 2003, the written exam
was cancelled and selection nowadays is based solely on a job interview (Owais, 2005).
35
As for pre-service training, all teachers are offered a three-day training seminar to
familiarise them with the system but this is done about one month after they start their job.
National teachers who do not hold a degree in education are asked to attend a one-month
training course in the evenings. In their first year, teachers are under probation. Based on a
mid-year report submitted in January, the MoE decides whether the teacher is well-
qualified or not. In subsequent years, the contract is on a yearly basis and may be
terminated without prior notice by the end of the school year. Job security is insecure in this
case and teachers are obliged to do their best to retain the job contract (Al-Nayadi, 1989;
Alwan, 2003a, 2003b; Suliman, 2000).
As for their professional duties, teachers in the UAE carry out a large number of tasks in
addition to classroom teaching. Other non-instructional duties are administrative, technical
or disciplinary (Al-Araj, 1999; Al Housani, 1996). According to Altraifi’s (1999) findings,
teachers in the UAE sacrifice their own leisure time to satisfy work requirements. School
administrations require them to do tasks that are not part of the job. Furthermore, work
pressures affect the relationships among teachers and result in psychological stress.
In addition, teachers are expected to prepare supplements for the teaching materials. As far
as Altraifi (1999) is concerned, this act is considered a sign of distinguished performance.
As there are no funds provided by the MoE , teachers believe that the schools’ inability to
finance the preparation of extra teaching materials weakens their performance, and as a
result, they depend on their own resources to fund curriculum requirements.
Most teachers have 3 to 4 classes a day reaching 18 classes a week. With 50 minutes in
each lesson, this mounts to approximately 15 hours of actual teaching time. Other non-
36
teaching time is used for preparing lesson plans or correcting and checking students’
homework, notebooks, workbooks and exams. In case of maternity (2 months), Haj (i.e.
pilgrimage, 3 weeks) or sick leaves (open), the teachers’ loads may rise up to 21 classes per
week as they take up classes of their ‘absent colleague’ since the number of substitute
teachers (female only) has been cut back in the past few years. According to my
experience, teachers, when not teaching, seem to be doing many routine tasks related to
teaching and assessment. There are no studies that reveal the actual workload but Altraifi
(1999) found that teachers cannot finish their duties during duty hours and usually take
their work home. More background information on issues concerning teacher training and
evaluation is covered in the next section.
2.2.8 Teacher Training and Teacher Evaluation
As the majority of the teachers are expatriates, they come from diverse educational
backgrounds with regard to their pre-service training. Graduates of the faculties of
education are more informed than their peers about English language teaching with regard
to current approaches to teaching English and their knowledge of curriculum (Al-Araj,
1999). In most Arab countries, graduates of the faculties of education have their teaching
practice in the final year. Some countries offer in-service training to teachers but others do
not (Al Nuaimin, 1991).
As most of the others are graduates of the faculties of Arts, they join the service and get
their training on their first year of teaching. However, in some countries, they do not get
any form of training at all. In Egypt and Syria, for instance, teachers join the service
37
without any prior knowledge of teaching (Al Nuaimin, 1991; Amro, 2001). In Tunisia,
however, teachers have weekly workshops during a two-year intensive training programme
before they get a full-time contract as EL teachers. Similarly, teachers in Jordan join the
service without pre-service training and they are trained while doing their job during the
first year of service (Amro, 2001).
In all cases where there is actual training and in the case of graduates of the faculties of
education, teachers are exposed to current trends in English language teaching such as
communicative language teaching. However, there is little focus on independent learning or
task-based learning. Teachers are trained to implement the lessons according to the
suggestions in the teacher’s book (Al Nuaimin, 1991; Al Mansouri, 2001; Amro, 2001).
After they are recruited in the UAE, teachers get a short training course to familiarise them
with the job requirements such as daily and annual planning and foreign language teaching
techniques. Teachers are also oriented with the teaching materials of the cycle they are
working with (Alwan, 2000). In addition to this, teachers are familiarised with the new
curriculum material every time there is a change. Traditionally, EL supervisors are in
charge of training EL teachers in addition to teacher evaluation. Such on-the-job follow-up
is considered the major in-service training that teachers receive (Alwan, 2000; Ghareeb,
1996). However, supervision is synonymous with inspection as teachers perceive that the
main purpose behind classroom observation is to check that teachers are complying with
the recommended teaching techniques (Al-Nayadi, 1989; Azzari & Mansour, 1998; Hokal,
1999). Thus the model of training that teachers receive throughout their years of service in
the UAE involves merely how to deal with the materials and adapt them to students’ needs.
Therefore, the supervisors mainly give directions without guidance (Alraway, 1988; Badri,
38
1991). The training does not deal with the role of the teachers beyond delivering the
teaching materials or preparing exams (Alwan, 2000; Ghareeb, 1996). It is basically a
master-apprentice relationship whereby teachers are expected to obey orders from their
superiors (Azzari & Mansour, 1998).
According to the 1994 Curriculum Document, training teachers on how to use the new
curriculum is an essential component of the new curriculum. It explains that teachers are
encouraged to attend training courses and instructions are given to school principals to
release teachers to enable them to attend training activities. In addition, schools are also
encouraged to organise demonstration lessons. Other than that, the teachers’ opportunities
for in-service training are almost lacking (Altraifi, 1999). According to Alwan (2000) and
Ghareeb (1996), the MoE does not have a systematic approach to teacher training.
Nevertheless, as a result of active supervisory efforts, many teachers have developed
awareness for professional development and are encouraged to attend professional
development activities organised outside the duty hours and during weekends (Alwan,
2003b). The most significant professional development activities are currently offered by
TESOL Arabia, which is a locally based international organisation for teachers who use
English as the main language of instruction. Other opportunities include seminars and
workshops offered by higher educational institutions which have partnership with schools,
such as the Higher Colleges of Technology and Zayed University. Most development
activities are held outside working hours or during weekends (Alwan, 2003b).
As for teacher evaluation, which is an annual procedure, this is a shared duty between the
school’s principal and the subject supervisor. There are supervisors for all the subjects in
every educational zone who visit schools regularly to monitor teaching performance and
39
follow up student results. Supervisors who are locally promoted to take the position are ex-
teachers who have been trained to carry out the job of teacher training and teacher
evaluation. However, some supervisors are Arab expatriates from Egypt or Jordan, who had
previous experience of supervision in their countries (Azzari & Mansour, 1998; Guefrachi
& Troudi, 2000). Normally, a supervisor has about 50 to 65 teachers under his or her
supervision depending on the size of the zone and recruitment restrictions. The number of
supervisors in charge of EL teachers in 2003-2004 in all educational zones reached 70 in
total; of which 45 were males and 25 were females (Summary of Educational Statistics,
2004). These are headed by the Senior Inspector who is based in the MoE (Guefrachi &
Troudi, 2000).
Teacher evaluation depends mainly on classroom observation followed by a post-
observation conference in which the evaluator and the teacher discuss the lesson and
suggest points of improvement to the teacher’s performance. The evaluator then writes a
report on the observed lesson and his or her recommendations. In the past, there had been
separate registers for both the supervisor and the principal; however, a comprehensive
register for both evaluators was introduced in 2002, in which both evaluators document
their visits. The teacher reads and signs the report after its completion on the same day or
later at a convenient time. At the end of the school year, there is a confidential appraisal
report which is normally written in the month of May. Both the supervisor and the principal
give a rating to the teacher in areas of skills and professional development. The report is
sent to the MoE and is analysed by the department of human resources. Based on this
report, the teacher’s contract is either renewed or terminated in severe cases. Normally, a
teacher knows about her level of performance as he or she receives an official warning
during the year if his or her rating in the previous year was below expectations. Weak
40
performers are followed up intensively by the supervisors and the senior supervisor and
more development activities are arranged to improve their performance.
Recently, several innovations have been introduced in the area of teacher evaluation. In
consequence of these innovations, the final report is based on teaching portfolios and
student evaluation of teaching. While these have caused wide controversy, they continue to
be viewed more capable of covering a wider scope of the teacher’s work than classroom
observation (Alwan, 2004b; Bird & Owais, 2004). In brief, the teachers are required to
display evidence of their work in a teaching portfolio. The criteria for evaluation are similar
to the ones in the teachers’ register which is used for documenting classroom visits. These
are: (1) planning, (2) teaching aids and techniques, (3) students, (4) professional
development, (5) curricula and testing (Alwan, 2004b; Bird & Owais, 2004). As for
students’ evaluation of teaching, a random sample of students is given a questionnaire to
evaluate the teacher. Two drawbacks have been observed in this technique: the instrument
is thought to be lacking in validity, and the confidential results of this type of evaluation are
thought to affect teacher morale (Alwan, 2003b).
In the next chapter, I shall provide a review of the literature on the main focal points of the
inquiry. I shall also present a review of studies on curriculum change which are relevant to
this study.
41
CHAPTER III
LITERATURE REVIEW
INTRODUCTION
The purpose of this chapter is to provide an overview of the literature pertinent to the topic
of investigation. This chapter is divided into three sections. In the first one, I shall explain
the conceptual framework of the study. In the second section, I shall define the main
terminology used in the study and provide a brief overview of the issues around them
which are discussed in the literature. They are: teacher perceptions, change, curriculum and
curriculum development. In the last section, I will present a review of studies about
curriculum change which are of relevance to this inquiry.
3.1 CONCEPTUAL FRAMEWORK
The study that I report here was conceived within the interpretive paradigm. Within this
approach, the aim of the researcher is to understand peoples’ perspectives of the
phenomenon under investigation. This approach focuses on how participants view reality
with the objective of generating rather than verifying theory. It uses a naturalistic research
design. Crotty (1998) explains that a ‘theoretical perspective’ is a philosophical standpoint
which underpins the selected methodology. In this part, I shall explain the philosophical,
42
ontological and epistemological standpoints of social constructivism and clarify basic
aspects of interpretive research.
Interpretive research is derived from constructivist ontology (Ernest, 1994). According to
constructivist ontology, objects in the world are representations constructed by people or
cultures (Fox, 2003). In this sense, knowledge is not found or discovered but is constructed
(Bloomer, 2001; Duit & Treagust, 2003; Fox, 2001 & 2003; Schwandt, 1994 & 2001;
Warford & Reeves, 2003). As different people construct reality in different ways, there is
no single objective reality true to all (Kiviven & Ristela, 2003; Schwandt, 1994 & 2001)
but there are multiple meaningful constructions of the world in people’s minds (Guba &
Lincoln, 1989; Fraenkel & Wallen, 2000; Williams & Burden, 1999). These
representations are complex and change over time (Enteistle & Smith, 2002; Glesne &
Peshkin, 1992; Schur et al, 2002; Watts & Bentley, 1991). Further, they are filtered through
shared contextual factors (Reagan & Osborn, 2002; Schwandt, 2001). Hence comes the
declaration commonly made by interpretive theorists that there is no such thing as reality
(e.g. Burr, 2000; Radnor, 2002). My philosophical standpoint in this inquiry is the same as
explained above. As a constructivist, I understand that different people have different
perceptions (i.e. constructions) of the world, and that an individual develops different
perceptions of the world depending on contextual factors.
As for epistemology, or the view of knowledge and the theory of learning, interpretive
researchers believe that knowledge is created as a result of the interaction between the
researcher and the object of the research (Guba & Lincoln, 1994). They also view
knowledge as the understanding that the knower makes out of it. This ‘subjectivist
epistemology’ determines the methodology of interpretive research. From this perspective
43
too, there is no such thing as research which excludes the influence of the researcher
(Halliday, 2002; Hanrahan et al, 1999; Huberman & Miles, 1994). It is recommended
therefore, that researchers state clearly their beliefs and values with regard to their
methodological stance. In my overall approach in this study, I was guided by this
constructivist standpoint.
The same philosophical standpoint underpins my methodology too. The role of the
qualitative researcher, as theorists agree (e.g. Guba & Lincoln, 1989; Robson, 2002;
Woods, 1999), is to discover the participants’ perspectives on a particular issue and the
meanings they attach to it by building up a picture through thick descriptions which capture
the uniqueness of the context (Denzin & Lincoln, 1994; Ernest, 1994; Lazaraton, 2003;
Radnor, 1994).
As for data analysis, according to the interpretivist researchers, to understand the world or
social phenomena, we must interpret the data to clarify the meaning and describe the whole
picture (Schwandt, 1994; Radnor, 2002). Consequently, these researchers focus on the
social construction of reality based on how individuals interpret the world (Radnor, 2002).
Further, interpretivists also assume that the researcher and the participants create the data
mutually (Olesen, 1994). This co-creation requires that researchers ground the findings in
the informants’ constructions of reality (Guba & Lincoln. 1989- see 4.7) to reach a joint
construction.
It is important at this point to acknowledge the element of ‘reflexivity’ in interpretation,
which is the acknowledgement of the reflection of the researchers’ subjectivity in
understanding their role in the research, and that the researcher is a part of the world he or
44
she investigates (Altheide & Johnson, 1994; Atkinson, 2000; Burr, 2000; Marcus, 1994;
Punch, 1994 & 1998; Vidich & Lyman, 1994). Subjectivity is an aspect of strength in
qualitative research (Holliday, 2001). Instead of attempting to eliminate subjectivity,
researchers should capitalise on its ability to make them understand the culture of the
studied context. In fact, interpretive research theorists commend subjectivity for the
reflexivity it adds to the interpretations (Denzin & Lincoln, 1994; Schwandt, 1994- see
3.1).
3.2 TERMINOLOGY
As mentioned earlier, this study attempts to explore EL teachers’ perceptions of curriculum
change in the UAE. In this section, I shall explain the main concepts referred to in this
thesis by drawing on the literature. The main concepts are: ‘Teachers’ perceptions’,
‘change’ and ‘curriculum’. As I shall explain later, my definition of ‘curriculum’ and the
focus of the study demand a definition of ‘curriculum development’ since it is connected to
‘curriculum change’. Therefore, I will also clarify what an ‘EL curriculum’ is and the
components of the EL curriculum process. As I shall demonstrate, each of these terms has
been a point of argument, and theorists have debated that their meanings are diverse and
overlap with other terms used within the same context. In the course of the matter, I shall
be giving a brief synthesis of the research findings related to these terms which are essential
to understanding some of the findings in chapter 5.
45
3.2.1 Teachers’ Perceptions: Definition and Synthesis of Research Findings
This study investigates teachers’ perceptions of curriculum change. I shall be using the
word ‘perception’ to refer to teachers’ constructions of reality in areas related to the
educational context. This section aims at clarifying the relationship between the concepts of
‘perception’ and ‘belief’, and proceeds to consider research findings which are of relevance
to this study. Bearing in mind that the term is broad and is used synonymously with other
terms, I shall attempt to define it from a perspective which suits the focus of the study.
According to Pajares (1992:315):
“all broad psychological constructs at some point must come before the reductionist, multidimentional, or hierarchical chopping block to better suit the needs and requirements of the research”.
It is common in constructivist research to use the term perception to refer to constructions
that people form of reality. According to Lincoln & Guba (1985): “a perception…is a
partial, incomplete view of something that is nevertheless real, and capable of different
interpretation when seen from different viewpoints. It is partial and incomplete only
because each perception yields experience of only a limited number of parts of the whole”
(Lincoln & Guba, 1985:83). In this philosophical sense, teachers’ perceptions are only one
side of looking at an issue as there are other persons involved in the situations under
investigation who may hold other perceptions. In this sense too, perceptions are subject to
change due to contextual factors (see 3.1).
Perceptions are also referred to as ‘beliefs’, ‘conceptions’, ‘interpretations’, ‘attitudes’,
‘values’ or ‘feelings’ (e.g. Beck et al, 2000; Ben-Peretz et al, 2003; Campbell et al, 2001;
Collinson & Cook 2000; Dreyfus & Mazouz, 1989; Freeman, 2002; Gibbs et al, 1999;
46
Lazaraton, 2003; Richards, 1994; Tillema, 1997a, 1997b & 1998; Tillema & Knoll, 1997),
or ‘lay theories’, ‘knowledge’ and ‘theories’ (e.g. Golombek, 1994 & 1998; Sugrue, 1997).
On the other hand, some researchers, like Nespor (1987) consider ‘beliefs’ as teachers’
ways of thinking and distinguishes ‘beliefs’ from ‘knowledge’. In addition, other
researchers use the term ‘perception’ as a construct of ‘belief’ (Pajares, 1992). Rokeach
(1968- in Pajares, 1992) rightly argues that beliefs are multi-dimensional. To quote Pajares
(1992:318): “Beliefs differ in intensity and power; beliefs vary a long a central-peripheral
dimension; and the more central a belief, the more it will resist change”. This implies that
there are central or core beliefs which are hard to change, and that there are peripheral
ones at the surface that are prone to change. If we consider Lincoln and Guba’s (1985)
definition, we can reach the conclusion that peripheral beliefs are perceptions, which are
constructions of reality. Considering that the term ‘beliefs’ refers to central beliefs and
‘perceptions’ are peripheral beliefs, there is a hierarchical relationship between both
concepts, which makes the latter a construct of the former. As Pajares (1992:317) puts it:
“beliefs influence perceptions that influence behaviors that are consistent with, and that
reinforce, the original beliefs”.
To begin with, the first major finding in this field is that both beliefs and perceptions
inform practice and influence decision making with regard to choice of teaching
techniques. In consequence, classroom decisions that teachers make are based on their
perceptions of teaching and learning, of the learners and of themselves (e.g. Borg, 1998a,
1998b, 1999, 2001 & 2003; Head & Taylor, 1997; Toref & Warburton, 2005). In a very
literal sense, beliefs filter the contextual problems and help teachers to understand contexts
(Nespor, 1987). Therefore, what teachers perceive as the most important skills for their
47
pupils to learn influences what they choose to teach and their teaching techniques (Glean,
1984; Johnson, 1999; Williams & Burden, 2000).
The second finding related to teacher perceptions is that the teaching context can affect
teachers’ perceptions of themselves significantly, and the image which teachers hold of
themselves affects their classroom behaviour too (Ben-Peretz et al, 2003; Johnson, 1999;
Pajares, 1999). Williams and Burden (2000:97) define self-concept as “the amalgamation
of all of our perceptions and conceptions about ourselves which gives rise to our sense of
personal identity”. They consider ‘self-image’, ‘self-esteem’ and ‘self-efficacy’ as aspects
of ‘self-concept’ (with ‘self-image’ as views of ourselves, ‘self-esteem’ as feelings of value
we hold for ourselves, and ‘self-efficacy’ as what we believe we are capable of doing).
Teachers’ perceptions with regard to their self-efficacy affect their instructional practices
(Williams & Burden, 1998 & 2000), and are central in determining their perceived locus of
control (Pajares, 1999). Locus of control is the perception of one’s control over situations
in life (Williams & Burden, 2000). As Williams and Burden (2000) concede, when people
perceive they are responsible for their action, they are said to have an internal locus of
control and they tend to be motivated to act. However, when they see that others are
responsible for what they believe or what happens to them, they are said to have an external
locus of control. In this case, they are not motivated to act but appear to be compliant and
passive.
The third finding in the area of teachers’ perceptions is the way in which perceptions can be
investigated, and which underpins the methodology of this investigation. According to
Gatbonton (1999) and Johnson (1999) the best way to understand teachers’ perceptions is
to make them reflect on their actions. Thus Johnson (1999) uses the term ‘reasoning’ to
48
refer to the articulation of beliefs through talking about actions, and concedes that the way
teachers interpret their teaching is a major key to understanding teaching.
Last, there is a controversy whether training changes perceptions or not with the tendency
towards stressing the finding that teacher education fails to influence teachers’ perceptions.
On the first side of the argument, Nespor (1987) contends that beliefs are hard to control or
influence. On the other side, some researchers use terms as ‘initial beliefs’ (Beijaard & De
Vries, 1997; Brousseau & Freeman, 1988; Von Wright, 1997) and ‘evolution’ of teachers’
thinking (Freeman, 2002), with the implication that new beliefs can be acquired. Similarly,
there are researchers who assert that training can alter beliefs which are related to pedagogy
on the condition that they are consciously challenged (Korthagen & Lagerwerf, 1996;
Tillema, 1997a, 1997b & 1998; Tillema & Knol, 1997; Von Wright, 1997).
Conversely, according to Pajares (1992), new information is filtered through old beliefs.
Therefore, in spite of teacher education and teacher training, teacher beliefs are unlikely to
change (Johnson, 1999) since old beliefs are hard to get rid of (Pajares, 1992). When
teachers have conflicting old and new beliefs, only they can resolve these conflicts. For
this, they need more evidence from the classroom (Johnson, 1999) as well as confrontation
with themselves (Tillema & Knol, 1997). Eventually, such conflicting beliefs leave a mark
on teachers’ practices.
Even if we assume that training can affect teachers’ perceptions, I think that teachers resort
to old behaviours if the new behaviour is not enhanced, or if there are contextual
circumstances that teachers perceive beyond their control which make them revert to old
ways of teaching. In such cases, the change in perceptions is not enhanced enough to effect
49
change in beliefs. Enhancing new perceptions can be obtained through eliminating
contextual factors that impede the application of new behaviour that matches new
perceptions. Accordingly, teachers may hold certain perceptions and display classroom
practices which are not in accordance with their beliefs because the culture of the school
does not facilitate this change. Therefore, some researchers argue that to cause a change in
beliefs, the culture of the school must change first (Fullan, 1993, 1999, 2001a, 2001b;
Karavas-Doukas, 1998).
In summary, although ‘perception’ is a broad psychological concept, I tried to explain it
from the perspective which suits my research. I shall be considering ‘perceptions’, which
are constructions of reality, as constructs of beliefs based on the argument above. While
there is a tendency in the literature to use the terms interchangeably, I will abide by the
distinction explained above.
3.2.2 Educational Change: Definition and Synthesis of Research Findings
To define ‘change’, we need to consider its overlapping meaning with ‘innovation’. From a
linguistic point of view, according to Webster’s Dictionary (1993), ‘innovation’ is “the
introduction of something new” and ‘change’ is “the action of making something different
in form, quality, or state”. With reference to curriculum change literature, Markee (1997)
differentiates between change and innovation but recommends using the words
interchangeably due to the fact that they are overlapping concepts. She defines change as
“an ongoing, almost unconscious process that involves reworking familiar elements into
new relationships”; and ‘innovation’ as “a willed intervention, which results in the
50
development of ideas, practices, or beliefs that are fundamentally new” (Markee, 1997:47).
Thus, introducing an innovation in any aspect of the curriculum brings about curriculum
change. However, change has several dimensions. According to Print (1993:xvi), change is
“the process of transforming phenomena into something different. It has the dimensions of
rate (speed), scale (size), degree (thoroughness), continuity (profoundness) and direction”.
Therefore, change comes in various degrees. That is, an innovation may be introduced but
change may or may not occur.
Change may occur either naturally or deliberately (Fullan, 2001b) while innovation is a
proposition for change as it imposes change (Fullan, 1999; Print, 1993). However, both
terms can be used to refer to the process aspect and the object or strategy that is introduced.
Realising this overlap in meaning, I shall use the terms interchangeably and take them both
to mean the introduction of something different or new. Obviously, the view that an
innovation is new, of course, depends on the perceptions of the people affected by it; as
there can be a change but things may seem familiar. Understandably, an innovation loses its
novelty over time. Therefore, the perception of an innovation as a change is relative due to
the ambiguity caused by the overlapping meanings of both concepts.
When considering educational change in general, I see change as an ongoing process which
can be taking place without the deliberate introduction of something different or new.
However, when considering curriculum change, there is a deliberate attempt to introduce
one or more elements of the curriculum which are different or new (Everard & Morris,
1996; Markee, 1997). Whether this innovation is perceived as new or not by those affected
by change, still from the perspective of change managers, it is a change.
51
As seen from Markee’s definition of innovation above, ‘innovation’ is also a term used to
describe the process of change by introducing new elements. Thus whether we are referring
to curricular change or curricular innovation, there is going to be some element of the
curriculum which is new to the context. Hence comes Markee’s definition of curricular
innovation as: “a managed process of development whose principal products are teaching
(and/or testing) materials, methodological skills, and pedagogical values that are perceived
as new by potential adopters” (Markee, 1997:46).
There is ample research on educational change, but those that are related to successful
change management are the most relevant to this study. The first finding in this area is that
planning change is essential but there are unexpected impediments (Fullan, 1993, 1999;
Kotter, 1996). According to Burden (1998:3), “change … often occurs in unexpected ways
in unforeseen directions such that our preconceived notions about almost anything can be
confounded at a stroke”. Second, the rationale for change needs to be communicated to
facilitate acceptance and ensure implementation (Rea-Dickens & Germaine, 1998). Third,
curriculum change challenges teachers’ existing skills (Markee, 1997; Fullan &
Hargreaves, 1992). Therefore, introducing change does not necessarily imply that it will be
implemented by those affected by it due to lack of commitment (Fullan & Stiegelbauer,
1991). To ensure commitment, involvement of teachers in the various stages of change is
recommended (Becher & Maclure, 1978 & 1982). Last, contextual factors can either
promote or inhibit change.
52
3.2.3 Curriculum: Definition and Synthesis of Research Findings
Linguistically, curriculum is defined as: “the whole body of courses offered by an
educational institution or one of its branches”. It is also defined as: “all planned school
activities including besides course of study organized play, athletics, dramatics, clubs, and
have-room program.” (Webster, 1993:557). However, if there is a controversial concept
which has evoked a multitude of meanings and lead some writers to avoid defining it at all,
then it is the term ‘curriculum’. In this section, I shall review the different standpoints taken
in the literature when defining curriculum.
In an attempt to give a workable definition to the term ‘curriculum’, I shall refer to the list
in Appendix IV-A, and show how many of the definitions are not comprehensive and how
an amalgam of meanings could help draw a better picture of what is practically meant by
the term. As the literature shows, the meaning of curriculum differs depending on the
perspective from which it is viewed and the point of focus. For instance, teachers view
‘curriculum’ differently from educational policy makers. In the literature I reviewed,
theorists define curriculum from four main perspectives (see Appendix IV-A).
Firstly, one perspective of curriculum is that of learning events which are experienced by
students, as in Connelly and Clandinin (1988), Marlow and Minehira (1996), Hargreaves et
al (1994), Rodgers (1994) and Reid (1975). This may include the actual life experiences of
learners such as field trips, or simulated ones as in experiments and role-plays. From the
perspective of the classroom, curriculum is also what students experience in situations
through the interaction with materials that convey the learning objectives and teachers who
53
decide on the process of instruction. This view involves activities which constitute the
learners’ experiences.
Secondly, another view of curriculum is that of knowledge presented through experience.
Thus according to Elliott’s (1994) and Becher and Maclure’s (1978) definitions of
‘curriculum’, teachers represent the world (or content) to learners through teacher-selected
experiences. Curriculum as knowledge goes beyond what is prescribed or defined officially
to include learning activities encountered by students, set by teachers or recommended by
individual schools. While White (2001) does not state explicitly what view of curriculum
he adopts, his use of the term ‘curriculum experience’ to talk about curriculum suggests
that he adopts this view.
Thirdly, other theorists have a view of the curriculum as an intended plan or program of
instruction. While Galton (1998) observes that this view of curriculum is limited to early
literature, I still find it present in recent literature (e.g. Dubin & Olshtain, 2000). In my
view, this standpoint is simplistic and narrow in scope as it neglects essential aspects of
curriculum. Specifically, it does not take into consideration the process of actualising the
plan or the actual experiences that learners encounter.
Fourthly, and from a wider perspective, curriculum is viewed as a process or a framework
of processes. In this respect, the curriculum is seen as a decision-making process which
includes decisions made with regard to setting goals and objectives, content areas to be
taught, teaching methods, and evaluation of these processes. In this regard, according to
Brown (1995), the curriculum is a process rather than an inflexible product. It can change
and adapt to new conditions. Based on his definition, ‘curriculum’ is synonymous with
54
‘curriculum development’. Accordingly, several phases of the process can be identified in
his list of curriculum elements: (1) needs assessment, (2) goals and objectives, (3) testing,
(4) materials, (5) teaching, and (6) program evaluation. A wider, yet a similar view of the
curriculum is seeing curriculum as a network of interacting processes, people and objects
(Richards, 2003).
While the view of curriculum as a process is more comprehensive than the previous views,
there is no single definition in the literature which is inclusive of all views. For this reason,
I see that it is not wrong to view the curriculum as experience, for instance, since it is one
meaning among many. Also while the view of curriculum as knowledge is limited and
suggests that curriculum is a product, still, the literature reports that teachers’ view of
curriculum is often that of teaching materials. In this case, curriculum does not leave space
for teachers to focus on areas based on their observations of students’ needs, which is a
point to be taken into consideration (Breen, 2001 & 2002). Further, the view of curriculum
as a plan involves several subjects taught in the overall curriculum. However, to talk about
curriculum as a process, means to add life to an unidentified entity. Still, in each view,
something is lacking as we need to consider a holistic view of the curriculum.
Therefore, my working definition in this study is a collage of the listed definitions.
Curriculum, for me, is a network of interconnected, interdependent, continuing processes
which result in knowledge to be experienced by learners through materials presented by
teachers in the form of activities. The curriculum processes include: needs analysis, setting
goals and defining objectives, preparing materials, training and supporting teachers,
teaching approaches and techniques, and assessment of learning and evaluation of all the
above. Curriculum also includes modification of materials according to the feedback from
55
evaluation. These processes are often referred to as elements of the curriculum (Brown,
1995; Print, 1993), or steps in curriculum development or syllabus design (Kerr, 1970;
Richards, 2003; Dubin & Olshtain, 2000).
The literature also describes the difference between the terms ‘curriculum’ and ‘syllabus’
which are often confused. ‘Syllabus’ itself has two meanings, one as a list of content areas
and one as a method of organising material. On the one hand, according to Richards
(2003:2), a ‘syllabus’ is “a specification of the content of a course of instruction and lists
what will be taught and tested”. Similarly, Print (1993:xxi) defines ‘syllabus’ as “a list of
content areas which are to be taught and assessed. Sometimes objectives and learning
activities are included. A syllabus is subsumed within a curriculum”. On the other hand,
Brown (1995:5) defines syllabuses as “ways of organizing the course and materials”. As
well, Breen (1987:82) also defines syllabus as:
“a plan of what is to be achieved through teaching and learning. Such a plan, most typically, maps out that body of knowledge and those capabilities which are regarded as worthwhile outcomes from the work of teachers and learners in a particular situation for which the syllabus was designed”.
In the same vein, Celce-Murcia and Olshtain (2000) give a contrasting view of ‘curriculum’
and ‘syllabus’ whereby a ‘curriculum’ states general goals and guiding principles, and a
‘syllabus’ is seen as: “a more particularised document that addresses a specific audience of
learners and teachers, a particular course of study or a particular series of textbooks”
(Celce-Murcia & Olshtain, 2000:185). In the context of this study, I shall take the first view
of syllabus that considers it as a part of the curriculum which constitutes a list of content
areas specified in a textbook to be used for assessment. To borrow Rogers’s definition, the
language syllabus is “the selection and organisation of linguistic content to be taught”
(Rogers, 1994:28).
56
For the purpose of this study, there is a need to clarify what an ‘EL curriculum’ is. Since
‘curriculum change’ and ‘curriculum development’ are interconnected terms, I shall also
explain briefly the process of curriculum development from a foreign language perspective.
Finally, I shall consider the role of EL teachers in the curriculum and in the EL curriculum
development process.
3.2.3.1 The EL Curriculum
The language curriculum evolved from the discipline of applied linguistics and is partially
based on it (Johnson, 1994). Most theorists refer to the language curriculum as a
‘programme’ or ‘course’ (e.g. Berwick, 1994; Brindley, 1994; Brown, 1995; Burden, 1998;
Dubin & Olshtain, 2000; Graves, 2003; Johnson, 1994; Rodgers, 1994). As Johnson (1994)
concedes, the language curriculum has passed through three major phases. The first one has
focussed on methods of language teaching. The second one included aspects like needs
assessment, syllabus and materials design, and the roles allocated to teachers and learners
in the classroom. The current phase, which had started in the 1980s, views the curriculum
as a process of decision-making which goes in five interactive stages: (1) planning; (2)
specification of goals; (3) implementation of the programme; (4) classroom
implementation; and (5) evaluation. Moreover, in consideration of recent literature (e.g.
Breen, 2001; Breen & Littlejohn, 2000; Graves, 2003; Holliday, 1997, Kumaravadivelu,
2003a, 2003b & 2003c) a fourth phase can be identified in which the focus is on adapting
language methodology to local contexts and on activating the role of learners in language
learning.
57
The EL curriculum is basically a decision-making process because decisions have to be
made at every phase of the process which makes each phase a process by itself. Thus
decisions should be made with regard to the specifying of language needs, selecting
syllabus design, selecting teaching materials, the teaching approach and the nature of the
teacher and learner roles.
3.2.3.2 The Components of the EL Curriculum Development Process
‘Curriculum change’ and ‘curriculum development’ appear to be reciprocal and
interconnected processes. From one perspective, ‘curriculum change’ is a comprehensive
term as it includes development, implementation and evaluation (Ganguly, 2001). From
another perspective, ‘curriculum development’ is an intentional attempt to effect
curriculum change (Markee, 1997). This section gives an outline of the components of the
curriculum development process from an EL perspective (see Appendix IV-B for an
extensive critical account of the processes). The framework which I describe here is an
amalgamation of several frameworks described in the literature (e.g Bailey, 2000; Benesch,
1996; Coombe, 2005a & 2005b; Coombe & Hubley, 2005; Cronbach, 1985; Dalton, 1988;
Duke, 1995; Isaac, 1983; Romero, 1998).
Curriculum development is the systematic building up of curriculum. Whether starting up a
new programme or renewing a current one, an initial, and a continuous, inquiry into the
learning needs is the start of curriculum development. The results are utilised when setting
the aims, goals and objectives of the curriculum (e.g. Brown, 1995; Dubin & Olshtain,
2000; Richards, 2003). Simultaneously, the specification of how the achievement of the
outcomes of learning will be assessed (e.g. Brown, 1995; Graves, 2003) is considered.
58
These processes are followed with a decision-making process of course planning and
syllabus design, which is followed by materials writing or materials selection (e.g. Print,
1993). Then comes the process of teaching which is connected with the processes of
teacher training and curricular support (Richards, 2003). Finally, there is the process of
evaluation which takes place at all levels of the process as each of the processes is
evaluated and feedback is incorporated into the process in the form of improving aspects of
the process (e.g. Graves, 2003). Thus we have assessment of the learning outcomes, and
evaluation of materials and of teaching. While this framework may seem to be linear as it is
listed following certain steps, it is actually cyclical in nature as the processes are
interrelated and interwoven in an endless process (Breen, 2001). For a broad sketch of
essential stages in the process of curriculum change see Appendix IV-B.
3.2.3.3 Teachers’ Roles in Curriculum Development: Issues of Voice versus Power
The centrality of the teachers’ voice in the curriculum is an issue which is called for in the
literature (e.g. Berstein, 1974; Elliott, 1994; Finch, 1981; Lieberman, 1997; Markee, 1997;
Rea-Dickens & Germaine, 1998). According to Elliott (1994), curriculum development is a
process in which teachers are the central agents in the sense that they keep experimenting
with their students to develop the curriculum. Similarly, Rea-Dickens and Germaine (1998)
argue for the importance of involving teachers in curriculum development. They advocate
that teachers are the experts on how the curriculum works in the classroom and should play
a vital role as evaluators of the curriculum. The more the teachers are involved the more
effective the curriculum (also Finch, 1981). Similarly, Lieberman (1997) highlights the
benefits of involving teachers in administrative decisions as a means of promoting more
active involvement in curriculum change.
59
The degree of involvement of teachers in curriculum change has changed over the years as
teachers have become more actively engaged in the process (Finch, 1981). Berstein
(1974:206) explains that teachers have varying degrees of control over “the selection,
organization, and pacing of the knowledge transmitted and received in the pedagogical
relationship” with their students. However, Webb (2002) argues that teachers should be
autonomous in deciding to make alterations to mandated curricula as well as forms of
assessment. Teachers are aware of their students’ needs and therefore should exercise the
power to adapt the curriculum to them (also Holly, 1973).
Teachers should be consulted starting from analysis of needs to defining goals and
objectives, selecting materials and so on (Hadley, 1999). This facilitates implementation of
change and eliminates resistance (Brown, 1995; Lieberman, 1997). Involving teachers also
ensures that the intended curriculum is the taught curriculum (Finch, 1981). Several
researchers, however, report the tendency of policy makers to impose change on teachers
rather than involving them (Barrow, 1984; Gibbs et al, 1999; Hadley, 1999; Holt, 1986;
Richards, 2003).
Young (1979) explains that teachers’ involvement in curriculum decision making is
feasible at the school level but difficult at the district level when considering the teachers’
daily obligations. The school culture itself in relation to the wider context of educational
institutions as well as the perceived lower position in the educational hierarchy compared to
administrators make teachers detached from other educators. Moreover, teachers tend to be
alienated from their peers within the school due to their classroom orientation. When
sharing is missing, curriculum decision-making at the district level is logically ruled out.
60
Overall, the organisation shapes the teachers’ perceptions of their professional duties
(Young, 1979). Therefore, Richards (2003) raises a broader issue of whether teachers are
considered professionals or simply treated as employees. This is also echoed in this quote:
“the basic predicament of teachers is that they are treated as passive consumers within their
own organizational structure. They are acted upon rather than acting.” (House, 1974, in
Young, 1979:117-118).
Barrow (1984) asserts that most plans for curriculum change are poor and tend to be
authoritative taking a top-down approach. He advocates a model for dissemination of the
curriculum based on teacher involvement which starts from schools moving upwards. Holt,
(1986), on the other hand, asserts that teachers are not trained to think of themselves as part
of the curriculum. They only need to be encouraged to get involved for them to take up
their role as change agents.
Basically, EL teachers have specific roles in the EL curriculum that are dictated by the
language teaching methodology adopted. Since this is a study which focusses on teachers’
perceptions of curriculum change and their role in the curriculum development processes
rather than in the curriculum per se, I shall not discuss it here. However, for the readers’
convenience, I included this in appendix IV-C which is based on literature in this area (e.g.
Breen, 2001; Chamot, 2001; Dubin & Olshtain, 2000; Kumaravadivelu, 2003a).
3.3 STUDIES ON CURRICULUM CHANGE
In this section, I shall present a review of selected studies that I found close to my topic of
research. It is divided into three parts. There is a review of international published research
61
in the first part and of studies from Arabic-speaking contexts and the UAE in the second.
The third part rounds up the discussion with a critical account of the methods of
investigation used in the reviewed empirical works.
3.3.1 International Studies on Curriculum
International published research covers a wide range of studies which are relevant to this
study albeit from various perspectives of handling the topic. They are grouped here
according to the themes they cover. Hence there are studies of EL teachers’ perceptions of
curriculum change; EL teachers’ roles in curriculum development and Teachers’
perceptions of curriculum change. I shall summarise each one of them and present the most
important findings.
3.3.1.1 EL Teachers’ Perceptions of Curriculum Change
McGrail (2005) explored English language arts teachers’ perceptions of introducing
technology in the classroom in Atlanta, USA, using a qualitative methodology. Adopting a
similar approach to my study, the researcher used a collective case study in which recorded
interviews, with open-ended questions, were conducted with teachers, transcribed and
analysed inductively. According to McGrail’s findings, the psychological effects of change
were apparent in the participants’ perceptions of themselves. Teachers felt unqualified and
expressed their need for on-going training and support on the required skills. They were
obliged to use the new technology in their instruction without having the power of choice,
which highlights the issue of powerlessness during top-down curriculum change. Another
major finding is that the teachers perceived that their most important responsibility was to
62
make the students master the curriculum material. Understanding the rationale for change,
according to McGrail, facilitates adaptation as teachers seem to be cooperative when the
reasons underpinning change are known to them.
Burns (1995) reveals similar findings with regard to the psychological effects of change.
She emphasises the challenging nature of change in requiring teachers to replace their
developed practices with ones they are not familiar with, thus affecting teacher identity. In
her study, however, these challenges had been eliminated by the fact that teachers were
“being given an explicit basis for course planning, teaching and assessing” (Burns, 1995:6).
The findings are derived from a collaborative action research study which was carried out
by 30 EL teachers in Australia. Its main focus was the change in the Australian Adult
Migrant English Program. Other findings are related to teachers’ classroom concerns with
regard to the content, teaching techniques and time constraints as well as their perceptions
of a mismatch between their beliefs and their practice. The study implies the need for a
long-term process of curriculum development which includes teachers’ participation in all
processes of preparing, planning, implementing and evaluating the curriculum.
A note on Burns’s methodology needs clarification here. I agree with her that action
research is a valuable tool both for evaluating and developing the curriculum. However, I
think that the claimed approach used for investigating the topic does not reflect actually
what was done and should be referred to as ‘collaborative research’ rather than
‘collaborative action research’ while the curriculum change was in action. I base this
inference on two grounds. First, Burns uses two different titles to refer to teachers on the
one hand, and participating teacher-researchers on the other hand, suggesting that teachers
63
were used as research ‘participants’ who kept documented data needed for the research and
suggested solutions to problems from their perspective. This is clear in her declaration that
the purpose of the research was to “investigate the impact of the curriculum initiatives on
teachers’ course design and classroom practices” (Burns, 1995:6). The term ‘assessing’
implies ‘discovering’ issues which support or impede classroom practice and course design
rather than ‘introducing’ any form of ‘intervention’, which is the basis of action research.
Thus curriculum change was already taking place and the investigation was an ‘evaluation’
of the stages of change rather than an ‘intervention’ in the change and an evaluation of that
intervention. This argument will be pursued in (3.3.3).
A similar evaluative study, albeit from a different perspective, is a case study by Karavas-
Doukas (1998). It investigates factors which impede the implementation of the English
language secondary school curriculum innovation in Greece. One of the factors was the fact
that change to the Communicative Approach had not affected the participants’ beliefs.
Unlike Burns’ (1995) study, this included classroom observations which were taped and
analysed with regard to teacher behaviour. For investigating the factors that affect
implementation, Karavas-Doukas used a Likert-type attitude scale, a questionnaire and
interviews. This was done over a three-month period on the fourth year of the
implementation.
Another approach was adopted in a multi-site case study by Roelofs and Terwel (1999) in
researching a similar topic. The purpose of the investigation was to evaluate the extent to
which teachers in the Netherlands abided by a change in recommended EL pedagogy. The
study revealed a mismatch between teachers’ and students’ perceptions of the pedagogy
used. The researchers found that the new constructivist pedagogy for English was not
64
widely adopted since the innovation demanded major changes in teachers’ roles, and
certain work conditions, such as restructuring of reschedules, which were not catered for.
This is similar to the findings of Karavas-Doukas (1998) that teachers did not abide by the
change in teaching techniques and that they used their old ways of teaching in delivering
the new activities that required communicative teaching techniques.
3.3.1.2 EL Teachers’ Roles in Curriculum Development
Context, voice, professional development and changing perceptions are basic issues in
curriculum development according to the studies reviewed in this section (Beattie and
Thiessen, 1997; Elliott et al, 1999; Gibbs, 1998; Ling, 2002; Nunan, 1988; Sharkey, 2004).
The first study that reflects these findings is Sharkey (2004). It is a qualitative study that
describes the process of curriculum development in Millville, USA, in which EL teachers
were involved. It reports the first year of a 3-year-study in which EL teachers worked on
defining and planning the curriculum project. The researcher, as a facilitator for the
teachers, took the role of a participant observer. The data collection methods consisted of
field notes, descriptions of meetings, transcriptions of two curriculum workshops,
questionnaires and interviews.
The findings revealed that teachers’ knowledge of context was helpful in the curriculum
development process; as it enabled them to handle issues of defining needs and dealing
with political factors which had been affecting the work of teachers. Sharkey reports the
tension that teachers felt while working within the context and against it, and how the
context shaped their work. She concedes that if curriculum consultants are not familiar with
the context or do not acknowledge its impact on teachers’ work, their contributions are
65
useless. The context, in her view, includes not only the classroom and the school but also
political decisions and laws. Further, the participants in her study were critical of the
political factors which impacted on their work in the curriculum project, which she
interpreted as a sign of professional voice struggling and negotiating standpoints. The
teachers in the study also critiqued the fact that they were excluded from chances of
professional development which were government-funded. The findings indicate that the
notion of power- that they had a say in the matter- affected the teachers’ work.
The same notion with regard to teachers’ voice in the curriculum is reflected in Beattie and
Thiessen (1997) who found that collaborative curriculum planning and design, and
engaging teachers in reflective discussions help in implementing change and improving
teaching practices. Theirs had been a case study of a secondary school in Toronto, in
Canada, that had been participating in government-funded innovative projects. The school
was taken as a model of a secondary school which had been attempting to create a link
between structural and curricular change. The researchers have documented the curriculum
which was planned by three teachers and three students. The purpose of the study was to
understand change as it was experienced by teachers and students during a restructuring
process in which curricula were developed. The researchers conducted individual and group
interviews with teachers and students. They also observed classrooms and conducted
document reviews. Based on their data, they concede that the planned curriculum from the
point of view of the teachers was different from that which was experienced by their
students.
Similarly, Nunan (1988) reports a study of teachers as curriculum developers within the
Australian Adult Migration Education. This national study was set to investigate the
66
transfer from a centralised curriculum to a learner-centred one. It discusses the type of
problems encountered by teachers as their role changes and aims to find solutions to the
problems, and identify the personnel who should be included in eliminating problems in the
curriculum.
As the findings reveal, teachers identified effective teacher development as a major factor
contributing to curriculum development. The study concludes with the general finding that
lack of curricular support was found to be one of the obstacles in dealing with curriculum
change.
Training, according to Nunan (1988) is essential during curriculum change. However, as
Gibbs’s (1998) research findings reveal, it has to be relevant to the context. Gibbs found a
mismatch between the content of training and the actual skills needed in the classroom that
lead to teachers’ inability to carry out the implementation of the curriculum in the way
intended. The descriptive case study that Gibbs (1998) reports investigated the development
of the English Curriculum in New South Wales, Australia. While there is nothing said
about how the data were collected, document reviews and reflections of the researcher
being an insider might have been the basis for data collection. The change, according to
Gibbs, was not planned appropriately and failed to abide by recommendations for
successful curriculum change implementation which resulted in various drawbacks. For
instance, teachers have been excluded from the planning stage of curriculum development.
Like the case in Gibbs’s study, Elliott et al (1999) report low-level teacher participation in
curriculum change that hindered implementation. The degree of involvement was related to
how encouraging the atmosphere was in the schools. This empirical large-scale quantitative
67
study was about teacher participation in curriculum leadership in Queensland, Australia, in
which they used mailed questionnaires to collect the data. Overall, the findings reflected
low levels of teacher engagement in curriculum leadership as compared to administrators’
involvement. The researchers also found that teachers believed that there were certain
aspects of the school context which hindered their engagement in curriculum leadership.
The factors were related to the availability of resources for curriculum support, networking
facilities, and administrative encouragement of teachers to engage in curriculum-related
initiatives. A very important finding is related to teachers’ negative perceptions of
themselves that the study failed to pursue, due to the limitations of the selected
methodology (see 3.3.3).
The change in perceptions of teachers during curriculum change is reflected in a qualitative
longitudinal study on teachers’ responses to curriculum reform in Hong Kong in Ling
(2002). The study was carried out over a five-year period, and included observing two
teachers. Ling explains that there were four phases to the development in teachers’
perceptions. The first phase was marked by the teachers’ negative response to change, as
they did not recognise the need for the new curriculum and they expressed fear of change.
The other phases included change in management structure. As a consequence, in the
second phase, the teachers perceived that they had gained experience on how to deal with
the curriculum due to the supportive management and the collaborative culture within the
school.
The study shows that teachers’ perceptions of curriculum do change over time due to
professional development. A detailed analysis of the change which occurred in perceptions
of two veteran teachers is given, highlighting how they experienced change differently.
68
While one teacher was encouraged to experiment with the new methodology in the
curriculum by reflecting on her action, another was encouraged to do the same through her
involvement in committee work and administration.
3.3.1.3 Teachers’ Perceptions of Curriculum Change
Studies in other disciplines that investigated teachers’ perceptions of curriculum change
also reverberate issues of power and voice, recognise the mixed reactions to change that
capture the feelings of uncertainty during change, and emphasise the importance of
training. To begin with, Webb (2002) contends that teacher power is based on “professional
expertise, action research, and pre-service teacher education…professional organisations
(which) are major sources for teacher power” (Webb, 2002:58). Webb contends that
conducting teacher education at both pre-service and in-service levels empowers teachers to
express their voice. He also interprets participants’ adjustments of curricular and
assessment directives as exercising power. The interpretive case study reported is of an
elementary school in Washington, in the USA. It explored teachers’ autonomy related to
their instructional beliefs during curricular change. Data collection was carried out over
almost three years. There were six participants in the study, five teachers and a school
principal. The sample constituted various teaching levels and varied ranges of experience.
Data collection methods included participant observation and semi-structured interviews.
Jacob and Frid (1997), on the other hand, report research findings on secondary school
teachers’ and graduate students’ perceptions of curriculum change in mathematics in
Australia, and the impact that curriculum change had on teaching and learning. The
researchers also found that teachers had mixed reactions to change. They also report that
69
teachers were critical of the fact that their voice was not respected which resulted in the
inability of the change in curriculum to reflect students’ needs. Such findings with regard to
teacher voice are also echoed in Allfrey (1990) who reports four interpretive case studies of
change promoted in schools and colleges in the UK. The case studies addressed different
aspects of the teachers’ work: “the adaptation of an existing curriculum, the introduction of
a new one, the deployment of new technologies and approaches and the incorporation into
practice of the broad concept of quality of opportunity” (Allfrey, 1990:135). Her findings
reveal that models of change are far more idealistic compared to the actual experience of
change that teachers encounter. She highlights the hierarchical authoritative relationship
which teachers perceive in their relationship with their schools, and calls for teacher
involvement in curriculum planning. Methods used for collecting the data were documents
that had been prepared by teachers and in-depth interviews.
3.3.2 Studies on Curriculum in Arab Countries and the UAE
Unlike the direct relevance of the reviewed international studies to my investigation,
studies in this section are partly relevant in terms of focus but reflective of characteristics of
the local context. There are also no comprehensive local studies that took the same
perspectives of the current study, neither in the Arab World nor locally, with the exception
of Loughrey et al (1999), that aimed at evaluating the EL curriculum in the UAE. In this
section, I review four studies from selected Arab countries: Bahrain, Oman, Egypt and
Jordan. I also review studies from the UAE that have the most relevance to my study.
70
3.3.2.1 Curriculum in Arab States
With regard to teacher training and evaluation Abbas (2005) found that a few teachers are
sent for training programmes as a result of the annual appraisal (also Alwan, 2000).
Likewise, the general attitude towards appraisal is unfavourable among teachers (also Al-
Nayadi, 1989). This quantitative study of the system of performance appraisal of EL
teachers in Bahrain aimed at investigating whether the results of the teacher appraisal
system were used to determine training needs for teachers in public schools. To collect the
data, the researcher used questionnaires with teachers and senior teachers and semi-
structured interviews with school principals, curriculum specialists and subject advisors.
The analysis was descriptive and inferential.
Similarly, findings of Harrison’s (2000) in Oman resonate with local findings in the UAE
with regard to teacher practices which had not been affected by change in the teaching
materials (Loughrey at al, 1999). This study explored change in student attainment as a
result of curriculum change. However, one of its drawbacks is that it diverts from primary
data sources. For instance, while the study’s purpose is to explore the development of the
pupils’ oral skills in all types of data, rather than seeking data from teachers or students, the
researcher derived his data from supervisors, documents and videoed lessons that he had
not participated in their preparation. Basically, the study does not appear to be an
evaluation of the implemented curriculum, as it claims to be; rather it is an attempt to focus
on one aspect of the curriculum without first describing an overall picture of the change
effected.
71
The findings of Gahin and Myhill (2001) in Egypt also echo within the UAE context. This
study on Egyptian EL teachers’ beliefs and attitudes towards the Communicative Approach
in language teaching employed the collection of quantitative data using an attitude scale
questionnaire with a priori categories, and of qualitative data using interviews. The
researchers point out that more attention was paid to the development of materials rather
than to the training of teachers on how to adopt them (also Ghareeb, 1996).
Likewise, Amro’s (2001) findings in Jordan mirror local findings that teachers use
traditional teaching techniques, teach to the test and use Arabic most of the time to ensure
that students understand the content that was to be tested (Loughrey et al, 1999). The study
investigated the contextual factors which influence EL teachers’ choice of instructional
techniques. The researcher used a questionnaire with 27 EL teachers in four secondary
school teachers in Jordan.
3.3.2.2 Curriculum in the UAE
To the best of my knowledge there are no studies on curriculum change in the UAE.
However there is research related to single aspects of the curriculum. This section is
divided into four parts according to the focus of the studies reviewed. The first part reviews
two studies on curriculum evaluation and the role of teachers in curriculum change
(Loughrey et al, 1999; Alwan, 2003b). The second part deals with studies that investigate
teacher training (Alwan, 2000 & 2001; Azzari & Mansour, 1998; Badri, 1991; Ghareeb,
1996), and teacher evaluation (Al-Nayadi, 1989; Alwan, 2003a), as elements of the
curriculum. The third part reviews studies around teaching methodology in the UAE
(Alwan, 1995 & Gardner, 1995). The final part discusses a study conducted at the tertiary
72
level to investigate learner needs (the UAE Institute of Nursing in 2001- the Nursing
Institute Study henceforth).
A. Curriculum Evaluation and Roles of Teachers in Curriculum Change in the UAE
Loughrey et al (1999) conducted a collaborative large-scale evaluative study of the EL
curriculum in the UAE. It was based on questionnaires and group interviews with teachers,
materials reviews as well as quantitative measurement of students’ achievement against a
range of external criteria. In addition, a needs analysis investigation was carried out in
which prospective employers were interviewed to find out the language needs for joining
the various employers and higher education institutions.
The major findings in the areas related to this study are those on teachers’ roles and their
position in the curriculum which reveal that teachers were not involved in curriculum
decisions as their views had not been incorporated into the development of the curriculum.
For instance, the researchers attest that the surveyed teachers were not aware of the aims of
the curriculum, and many of them were ignorant that a curriculum document existed. This
indicates that the objectives of the curriculum were not communicated to teachers. Hence
evidence of involving teachers in other curriculum processes other than teaching and testing
is a point of controversy.
A study in which I piloted the topic of this dissertation revealed findings on teachers’ roles
in the curriculum. In Alwan (2003b) I investigated teachers’ roles in the management of
change when introducing innovations. The case study adopted an emergent research design,
and part of it was on teachers’ roles in curriculum change. It included repeated interviews
73
with a school principal on which an open-ended questionnaire to teachers was constructed.
The findings can be summarised in that participant teachers’ roles in the curriculum was
found to be limited to teaching, and there was no follow-up or evaluation of curriculum
from the managing authorities. Another important finding was the affective aspect of
introducing innovations that change managers needed to consider. Change affected the
participant teachers’ morale to a far extent raising issues of restricted teacher voice.
Teachers had not taken initiative due to preserving one’s dignity as a teacher, as
participants in the focus group interview concurred.
B. Teacher Training and Teacher Evaluation in the UAE
In this section, I shall provide a synopsis of studies on two aspects of the curriculum which
are teacher training and evaluation. The number of studies reviewed here indicates that the
issues of teacher training and teacher evaluation have received extensive evaluation in the
country. To begin with, in Alwan (2000 & 2001) I investigated the effectiveness of in-
service training and general perceptions among educationists regarding the introduction of
self-directed teacher development activities to EL teachers. The findings reveal that teacher
training in the UAE is ineffective and unsystematic.
Likewise, Ghareeb (1996) found that evaluation of training was lacking and was
illuminative in identifying teachers’ training needs. The study investigated inservice
provision in the UAE in an attempt to find out attitudes of teachers and trainers towards in-
service teacher training of EL teachers. The same drawbacks in teacher training were
echoed in a quantitative study by Azzari and Mansour (1998) which investigated
74
educational supervision in the UAE and was based on a case study of Sharjah Educational
Zone.
In a quantitative study, Al-Nayadi (1989) reports findings on the perceptions of
administrators and teachers concerning one aspect of the curriculum which has to do with
the teacher evaluation system. The researcher used a questionnaire to survey a random
sample of 60 administrators and 400 teachers from all educational zones in the UAE. A
major finding is that the teacher evaluation system in the UAE had generated suspicion and
mistrust in schools, and that the process used in evaluating teachers did not accurately
measure the competence of the teacher. Another similar qualitative study was conducted by
Badri (1991) who investigated EL secondary teachers’ perceptions of supervisory practices
in the UAE with regard to their contribution to professional growth. The sample included
all 300 EL teachers in 60 selected schools in all educational zones, of which 175 teachers
responded. The most significant findings that resulted from this study contradict the
findings of Al-Nayadi’s as most teachers held positive perceptions regarding the effect of
supervision on improving instructional effectiveness.
A meaningful indicator that teacher evaluation continues to be a point of controversy in the
UAE is that several attempts have been made to improve the practice. While there is a
study of relevance to this topic (reported in Alwan 2004b & 2005), it is partially irrelevant
to this study in terms of its orientation. Therefore, I shall only report the findings which are
of relevance to this study in Chapter 5.
75
C. EL Teaching Methods in the UAE
The local literature reveals that teachers have also been subjects of research from a different
perspective: teaching techniques. In Alwan (1995) I investigated the teaching techniques
used by EL teachers in several schools including both genders. While my position as an
administrator, who was responsible for performance evaluation, might have affected the
findings, the findings connote otherwise since participants were not reserved about their
actual practice due to anonymity. The majority of the teachers admitted that they did not
use basic communicative techniques, which was the methodology adopted by the EL
curriculum at the time.
The same finding is asserted by Gardner (1995) whose study is a descriptive case study of
the teaching force in the UAE, which used, beside interviews, official documents as well as
press releases and commentaries in daily papers. While the use of daily papers as data
sources reduces the credibility of his study, I agree with him that the press can be
considered the major official outlet for documents or announcements of policies in the
UAE, in a culture where published research is relatively scarce (Shaw et al, 1995). The
study revealed that the UAE depends mainly on teachers from other Arab countries who are
inclined towards using traditional ways of teaching and that provision of training is limited.
D. Studies on Learner Needs in the UAE
Another stream taken by the local literature is the investigation of student needs. At the
public education level, the study of Loughrey et al (1999), which was reviewed earlier,
included evaluation of learner needs (see 3.3.2.2 - A). In addition, a project was carried out
76
to define the EL curriculum objectives in which teachers and supervisors were required to
consider a priori list of objectives based on the findings of Loughrey et al (Development of
the English Language Curriculum, 2000). The study had not been documented and the
mentioned details here on the method used are based on my personal knowledge as I
participated in this study (see 1.1.1). The findings of both studies confirm the findings of
the Nursing Institute Study (2001) which was conducted at the tertiary level. In this study,
the researchers used six questionnaires, discussion groups and analysed samples of
students’ work as methods of data collection. Different questionnaires were given to EL
teachers, nursing tutors, students, doctors, head nurses and practising nurses who had been
on the programme. Clearly, the findings of this study indicate that speaking was the greatest
weakness among learners. The researchers attributed this partly to lack of practice in public
school, since traditional methods were used by public school teachers to teach English.
There were also notable weaknesses in the use of the language as students reported making
a lot of mistakes in English since the majority of the students considered themselves weak
at using English for communication. Other areas of weakness include spelling and incorrect
use of vocabulary.
E. Teachers’ Work Conditions in the UAE
Altraifi (1999) investigated teachers’ perceptions of their work conditions. She found that
teachers use their own funds to spend on curriculum requirements of supplementing the
teaching materials. She also found that the school libraries lacked useful resources and were
under-equipped. Further, she refers to the intensity of the curriculum materials that were in
mismatch with the time allotted to teaching. A point of weakness in the study is the
quantitative approach that the researcher took to investigate the psychological construct of
77
teachers’ perceptions, and that she used questionnaires with a priori list of perceptions
which led to restricting the respondents’ choice. This leads to the issue discussed in the
proceeding section which is the choice of methodology for investigating teacher
perceptions and curriculum change.
3.3.3 Reflections on the Methods Used for Researching Teachers’ Perceptions and
Curriculum Change
It is essential, when researching curriculum change, or teacher perceptions, to ensure that
the research methodology adopted is suitable for the purpose of the study as wrong choices
contribute to insufficient understanding of the phenomenon and undependable inferences
(Maxwell, 1996; Mykut & Morehouse, 2001). With reference to the methodologies adopted
in the above studies, I would like to point out that I have avoided certain pitfalls. First,
some studies above seem to have unsuccessful choice of methodology or data collection
instruments. Second, some researchers have adopted techniques which are incompatible
with their philosophical standpoints. And third, some studies advocate sound methodology
but I will explain why they do not fit the current purpose of my study.
In the first place, as theorists assert, the investigation of teachers’ perceptions, or
curriculum change, requires a qualitative approach rather than a quantitative one (e.g.
Gatbonton, 1999; Golombek, 1994 & 1988; Hedgcock, 2002; Janesick, 1994; Johnson,
1999). Some of the researchers above were successful in selecting the methodology which
is most appropriate for their research (e.g. Alwan, 2003b; Allfrey, 1990; Beattie &
Thiessen, 1997; Burns, 1995; Gibbs, 1998; Ling, 2002; McGrail, 2005; Webb, 2002).
78
Conversely, some researchers took a quantitative orientation in researching these topics
(e.g. Al-Nayadi, 1989; Altrifi, 1999; Badri, 1991; Elliott et al, 1999; Gahin & Myhill,
2001). From another point of view, in some studies, the quantitative methodology might
have benefited from a qualitative element in data collection and analysis (as in Jacob &
Frid, 1997; Karavas-Doukas, 1998; Nunan, 1988; Roelofs & Terwel, 1999) such as Al-
Nayadi (1989) and Badri (1991). Both researchers used a priori statements expressing
potential teacher attitudes in their questionnaire. The limitation of such an approach is that
the respondents might have had other perceptions that the data collection instruments failed
to capture. Similarly, Elliott et al (1999) reached findings that their methodology failed to
pursue later on, as their sole dependence on questionnaires prevented this.
Another issue is the perspective of the researcher’ role in the research as an insider or an
outsider, and his or her informants’ relationship to the population of the study. Insider-
research achieves more transparency in data collection and reaches better inferences (e.g.
Maxwell, 1996; Radnor, 2002). This criterion appears to be a limitation in some studies
(e.g. Azzari & Mansour, 1998; Harrison, 2000 and probably Nunan, 1988). As for Nunan
(1988), while the researchers have successfully employed multiple methods for data
collection, the description of the methodology does not show what part the researchers
played: outsiders or insiders. Further, the period of actual involvement in the research plays
a vital part in promoting the trustworthiness of the research. For instance, Webb (2002)
conducted only twelve interviews over three years which implies limited involvement with
the research participants. In addition, nothing was said about validating the findings
through member-checking, which also requires involvement with the participants, or other
means of validation as is the tradition in qualitative research. Since researching teacher
perceptions requires direct involvement with teachers rather than asking outsiders about
79
teachers, only teachers should be consulted, contrary to what some researchers attempted to
do. This limitation can be found in Harrison (2000) and Nunan (1988) who used indirect
data sources, such as administrators, supervisors and non-teacher-generated documents, to
collect information about teachers.
Another drawback in the methodology in some of the studies above is that some researchers
spoke with authority and generalised from qualitative case studies (e.g. Gardner, 1995;
Ling, 2002), or insufficient qualitative observation (e.g. Karavas-Doukas, 1998; Sharkey,
2004), which is not accepted in the qualitative research tradition. For instance, Ling (2002)
recommends that teachers experience different school cultures to improve their
performance. This generalisation was based on the finding that one of her participants
achieved professional development as a result of taking an administrative post in a different
school. A similar drawback is that some researchers generalised from unreliable
quantitative data due to sampling errors which refute the claims of representativeness
required for generalisation (e.g. Amro, 2001; Abbas, 2005; Al-Nayadi, 1989; Alwan, 1995,
2000 & 2001; Azzari & Mansour, 1998; Badri, 1991; Elliott et al, 1999; Ghareeb, 1996;
Loughrey et al, 1999).
Second, some researchers stated a certain conceptual framework but diverted from it. For
instance Jacob and Frid (1997) analysed data quantitatively in their supposedly interpretive
research. Similarly, Gahin and Myhill (2001) claimed that they adopted an interpretive-
constructivist conceptual framework but included quantitative analysis of data. In both
cases, the approaches are not in accordance with the constructivist ontology (see 3.1).
80
Finally, Burns (1995) commends collaborative action research for curriculum development
and curriculum change evaluation for its role in making the developed curriculum
responsive to classroom needs. Although there is a misrepresentation of her work since it is
a collaborative research rather than a collaborative action research, still, I agree with her
assumptions about action research. She considers action research “a powerful means of
understanding the nature of curriculum change as well as supporting its implementation”
(Burns, 1995:15). In addition, she recommends it for curriculum evaluation. However,
while action research stems from a social constructivist epistemology, I think it is suitable
for developing and evaluating the curriculum. I have not considered action research in this
study as its epistemological springboards are not in accordance with mine (see 3.1). When
researching teachers’ perceptions, action research is not an option since it implies
intervention (see also 4.2).
The present chapter has provided explanations of the basic concepts of this study. The next
chapter details the methodology adopted, revisits its philosophical underpinnings and
explains how data were collected and analysed. The description of an audit trail is also
supported by providing evidence on how the study should be considered trustworthy.
81
CHAPTER IV
METHODOLOGY
INTRODUCTION
This chapter is a detailed description of the research methodology adopted. It explains the
research design that was selected in consideration of the research questions and the sample.
Then it proceeds to give a detailed report of the methods of data collection and data
analysis. In an attempt to provide clear details, I shall be citing evidence of trustworthiness
of this study. I shall also talk about the ethical considerations that I observed when
carrying out this inquiry as well as the limitations of the study.
4.1 Research Design
Research questions that address curriculum and innovation are suited to qualitative inquiry
(Janesick, 1994). Therefore, a suitable approach to investigate teachers’ perceptions of
curriculum change, according to the literature, is an explorative one (e.g. Gatbonton, 1999;
Golombek, 1994; Hedgcock, 2002; Johnson, 1999). Looking back at the research
questions, one can see clearly that the issues to be investigated require the selected
approach (see 1.3).
82
I planned to use an emergent research design to be able to reach an understanding of
teachers’ perceptions of curriculum change by collecting sufficient data about the situation
under investigation (Lincoln & Guba, 1985). An emergent research design is one which
enables researchers to adjust their research plans in accordance with their learning as their
studies unfold (Robson, 2002; Schwandt, 2001). At the beginning, I had in mind individual
interviews as a sole data source. I believe that interviews provide an outlet for teachers to
reflect on their action -or in many cases lack of action in the case of earlier curriculum
change that has often gone unnoticed by them. Reflection on action is the best way to
understand teachers’ perceptions (Gatbonton, 1999; Golombek, 1998; Hedgcock, 2002;
Johnson, 1999). Later on, as the study unfolded, I included informal member-checking
throughout the investigation and formal member-checking as part of the design. In addition,
I reviewed my research questions as the tradition of qualitative research (Denzin & Lincoln,
1994). As Holliday (2001:8) asserts, “the rigour in qualitative research is in the principled
development of strategy to suit the scenario being studied”.
As I carried out data collection and analysis of data simultaneously, I was able to make
decisions with regard to the design of the study. Simultaneous data collection and analysis
is recommended in this type of research (e.g. Guba & Lincoln, 1989; Holliday, 2001;
Maxwell, 1996; Silverman, 2001). Inductive data analysis revealed themes that had to be
pursued further. Accordingly, throughout the inquiry, I had to revise the research questions
and conduct additional interviews when the participants focussed on issues raised in the
analysis or those which were closely related to the topic of the study that I had not thought
of before.
83
4.2 Theoretical Rationale for Choice of Current Research Method
The choice of methodology is guided by the philosophical stance of the researcher (Crotty,
1998; Shulman, 1988). As argued earlier, interpretive researchers see knowledge as
personal, and therefore encourage the involvement of the researcher with the research
participants to capture the uniqueness of the context without attempting to change it (see
2.1). I opted for interpretive research as it suits my purpose for learning about curriculum
change in the UAE more than any other method.
Burns (1999:13) advocates using collaborative action research for curriculum development.
She declares that: “Collaborative action research processes strengthen the opportunities for
the results of research on practice to be fed back into educational systems in a more
substantial and critical way”. At the first stage of the action research cycle, however, “the
researcher treats the context as it occurs naturalistically and no attempt is made to control
the variables operating in the context as these may be the very sources of unexpected or
unforeseen interpretations” (Burns, 1999:22). Burns emphasises the importance of
collecting ‘rich’ data and providing ‘thick’ descriptions, as in interpretive research.
Therefore, in the case of my research, from Burn’s (1999) perspective, I am working on the
first phase of an action research project. While I do not intend to intervene at this stage,
paradoxically, I may carry out another phase of research later in which intervention is
expected to improve the contextual problematic factors related to curriculum change. As
research, which is a form of developing human knowledge, is a cycle, intervention in future
phases of the research process is not ruled out. Meanwhile, this interpretive research is
expected to bring up issues which can be pursued further later whereby intervention is
84
possible. That is, research at a later stage of the cycle may require a different approach
according to the purpose of the inquiry. At this point, however, my aim is to generate ideas
and discover issues of importance in curriculum change in the UAE.
4.3 The Sample
The research population of this study encompassed EL teachers in the UAE public
secondary schools in the ten educational zones. On the other hand, the sample included
female secondary school teachers of English in one educational zone who had previously
taught the previous secondary school curriculum and who had been teaching the new one
during the year when the data were collected. I aimed to focus on a case of one educational
zone using multiple sites to be able to capture any differences that could enhance the
description.
I selected the sample on two grounds, purposiveness and accessibility. Purposive sampling
refers to deliberate selection of individuals for participation in a study (Silverman, 2001) to
achieve variability in the data (Lincoln & Guba, 1985), and to the selection of cases on the
basis of access (Burton, 1996). In the context studied, it was easy for me, as a female
researcher, to access girls’ schools and work with female teachers without restrictions.
Unfortunately, it was not viable for me to access boys’ schools, as I could not work with
male teachers for contextual reservations. As Shaw (1994) contends, methodologies should
be sensitive to culture. Therefore, it is acceptable to modify them to fit into the culture
where the study takes place. In addition, the selected female schools had an advantage for
me as I did not need time to establish rapport with the participants or the schools which
already existed due to my previous involvement with the sample in all three sites selected.
85
In the past nine years, I had a previous experience with the selected schools, as I had
supervised these teachers several times till two years before the study was conducted.
Sixteen out of eighteen teachers who fitted into the specified sample characteristics
participated in the study. Two teachers (from two different schools) expressed their
willingness to participate but due uncontrolled circumstances, they were not available for
interviews. One teacher was hospitalised for the whole period of the study as she had a life
threatening illness and had undergone a major operation; and the other one had to leave the
school after giving her lesson to attend to an elderly parent throughout most of the initial
period of data collection.
The consent of the teachers to participate was an implied consent as they did not sign an
informed consent form. According to Berg (2001), the informant’s permission to record an
interview is an implied consent to participate in a study. This is also helpful in maintaining
anonymity and therefore confidentiality of data sources.
The participants in this study had varying years of experience in teaching within the UAE
and in their own countries. They come from 5 different nationalities: Egypt (n=5), Jordan
(n=4), Palestine (n=3), 2 Syria (n=2), Tunisia (n=1) and the UAE (n=1). They had a
varying range of years of teaching experience in the UAE, from 8 to 22 years. They had all
taught the former curriculum; and at the time when this study was carried out, they had
taught the new one at least for a few months. When quoting the participants, I shall be
using pseudonyms like (T1), (T2), …etc to refer to them.
86
4.4 Gaining Access
I went through the formalities of seeking consent for participation from the school
principals directly rather than from higher authorities (see Appendix V). In my case, it was
not necessary to go to the research department in the MoE to ask for permission to do the
research as I was not using questionnaires. Only researchers using surveys in public schools
need to obtain permission for public investigations (Alwan, 2000), otherwise, it was left for
the discretion of individual schools.
Taking into consideration the purposes of the study stated earlier in Chapter 1, I consider
myself a participant researcher from two standpoints: a materials’ writer and a regional
supervisor. During the course of the study, these two parts were advantageous too in terms
of the participants’ willingness to talk. I understood the limitations of the supervisors’ job
with respect to authority and its effect on research informants (see limitations below); but
also it had its advantages as supervisors in the UAE function as a channel for conveying the
teacher’s opinions to the EL Curriculum Department (Ghareeb, 1996; Badri, 1991). A
participant researcher has the advantage of being involved with the research participants
and developing trust, which makes them cooperate with the researcher rather than conceal
or fake information.
Initially, I had concerns that the teachers might feel obliged to participate because they
were ex-colleagues, or may say what they thought I wanted them to say in the interviews,
being a former supervisor and a co-author of two of the textbooks. To address these
concerns, I conducted initial staff meetings to explain what the research was about (see
Appendix VI) and to encourage them to speak for themselves. In piloting the interview
87
schedule, I was relieved as the teachers talked freely without reservations. I was not on the
job during the time of the investigation and was able to exercise ‘technical detachment’
(Holliday, 2001:178), a strategy that enabled me to observe ‘reflexively’ from a close
distance. In writing this report of how I conducted the study, I managed to employ what
Holliday (2001:179) calls ‘cautious detachment’. I had the stance of a stranger who saw the
familiar as strange (Holliday, 2001).
4.5 Data Collection
As Burton (1996) explains, methods of data collection in social sciences are governed by
the selected sample and characteristics of the research participants. Similarly, Shaw (1994)
contends that methods are culture bound. Additionally, as Shulman (1988) asserts, they are
underpinned by the researcher’s commitments. As I argued earlier (see 3.1), intensive
‘involvement’ with the research participants when researching teacher perceptions is a
decisive issue for the effectiveness of the interpretive inquiry since the researcher seeks to
understand teachers from their own perspectives (Golombek, 1994; Johnson, 1999). In
consideration of my prior work experience with the teachers, and the acceptable length of
time that the data collection took (about six months), I see that I meet this criterion.
Overall, data collection in interpretive research is collected in its natural setting (Guba &
Lincoln, 1989; Holliday, 2001). Several theorists consider the interpretive researcher as the
data collecting instrument, since the researcher’s personality and his or her interaction with
the research participants shape the description of reality (e.g. Altheide & Johnson, 1994;
Huberman & Miles, 1994; Olesen, 1994; Shaw, 1994). To me, the researcher is the catalyst
or the filter through which the findings are processed.
88
Qualitative researchers have to tolerate ambiguity (Glesne & Peshkin, 1992) and be willing
to accept the demands that this type of research requires. For example, there is no limit to
the amount of data to be collected since it is left to the discretion of the researcher who
decides to stop collecting data when reaching a point of saturation (Radnor, 2002).
According to Maykut and Morehouse (2001:62): “to fully understand the phenomenon of
interest, ideally, we continue…to gather information until we reach the saturation point,
when newly collected data is redundant with previously collected data”.
4.5.1 Document Reviews
To collect the data related to curriculum, it was inevitable to review curriculum documents
and other curriculum related materials. The documents reviewed for this study were
primary sources. These included the old and new curriculum documents; the circulars to
schools and other curriculum related records (see Appendices I & III). Although I was
familiar with the teaching materials, I studied them analytically to be able to handle any
discussion with the participants (see Appendix II). The purpose of reviewing curriculum
documents was to understand aspects of the context in depth. In a sense, however, I
considered this as part of the literature review rather than a means to triangulate the data
(see 4.8.3). When doing so, I have been observing Lincoln and Guba’s (1985:239) view in
referring to these as non-human instruments and rejecting their use in grounded theory.
Such documents are not grounded themselves, as they do not “reflect the constructions of
the respondents, but only the instrument maker”.
89
As for triangulation, some theorists consider triangulation a violation of the constructivist
ontology (Denzin & Lincoln, 1994- see argument in 4.8.3) I am with the interpretive
researchers who appreciate the rich descriptions obtained through variety of sources which
contribute to trustworthy conclusions and inferences (Tashakkori & Teddlie, 1998).
Nonetheless, with regard to using multiple data sources around teachers’ perceptions, I was
interested only in sources which were produced by the participants as those only might be
informative about their perceptions. Yet despite reviewing curriculum materials that the
research participants had produced, I cannot claim that they contributed much to the
findings. For triangulation, I depended heavily on member-validation (see 4.8.3).
4.5.2 Interviews
I used interviews as the major data collection technique for carrying out the investigation.
According to Radnor (1994:13), the interview “is an active encounter in which someone
seeking information is supplied with it by another”. It is a suitable data collection tool for
understanding perceptions, as explained earlier (see 4.1). Interviews are least demanding on
participants and teachers are normally willing to speak more than put their thoughts in
writing (Best & Khan, 1989). They are effective in gaining acceptance to participate,
obtaining co-operation of respondents (Burton, 1996), and encouraging people to disclose
confidential information (Rossman & Rallis, 2003).
Basically, I used repeated face-to face semi-structured interviews and member-checking
group interviews. The sample size was manageable, and the nature of the research
questions informed my interviewing (see Interview Schedule in Appendix VII). Brown and
Dowling (1998) concede that semi-structured interviews are better than structured ones
90
when the primary purpose of the investigation is to describe the phenomenon from the
perspectives of the interviewees. This form of interview combines structured components
but at the same time makes room for probing and free interaction (Brown & Dowling,
1998) as well as more relevant issues to be developed (Holliday, 2001).
As a quality control procedure, I designed the interview questions in a way that addresses
the research questions (Anfrara et al, 2002). The interview schedule contained open-ended
questions to encourage the informants to talk about the topic freely without restrictions or
concern for the interviewer’s interests (Taylor & Bogdan, 1984) and to obtain deeper
responses (Best & Khan, 1989).
In semi-structured interviews the researcher determines the questions to be asked and
elaborates on responses (Robson, 2002; Rossman & Rallis, 2003). I prepared the interview
schedule to use as a guide but the sequence of the questions depended on the development
of the informant’s responses. I began the interview with a topic of general interest and
avoided leading questions which implied specific answers. Glesne and Peshkin (1992: 32)
emphasise assuring the research participants that there is no right answer to the interview
questions and that “they cannot be wrong”, as I did.
It is noteworthy to mention that the interviews in this inquiry were conducted in English as
both I, the interviewer, and the participants are fluent in English. It is an acceptable
tradition in the context of the UAE to find EL teachers conversing in English. Rossman and
Rallis (2003) affirm that it is ideal to conduct interviews in the language which is
considered most comfortable for both parties.
91
I conducted the first set of interviews in December, 2003 and the other in March, 2004. A
qualitative analysis of data from the first round of interviews informed the questions of the
second round. Within the first round of interviews some questions were designed to check
for responses to other questions. The questions sought the interviewees’ perceptions of
curriculum change and were informed by the research questions as well as the initial
literature review. To achieve spontaneity, I did not stick to the same order of questions but
adapted the order according to the responses of each interviewee. The second round of data
collection was guided by the initial analysis of the data which I collected in the first round
as well as by the fact that I wanted to clarify or pursue further issues based on responses of
individual informants. All sets of interviews went well as the interviewees indicated interest
in the study and enthusiasm about voicing their views even if this was merely for research
purposes. To verify the data during interviews, I paraphrased the respondent’s talk as a
means to seek more information. Ruane (2005) refers to this technique as verbal mirroring
and commends it as a way to convey that the interviewer is actively listening. Further, at
the end of the interview, I asked if the interviewee wanted to add anything for which I had
not asked a question or whether she had more points to add to any of the earlier questions.
Most of them thought that the questions were comprehensive and some of them stressed
previous points.
I recorded all the interviews after seeking the informant’s permission before each interview.
Recording interviews is recommended as depending on note-taking is distracting, and
relying on memory may affect the credibility of the study (Taylor & Bogdan, 1984).
Although Taylor and Bogdan (1984) warn that the use of the tape recorder may affect what
people say, they also acknowledge that the participants are aware that what they will say
will be used to inform the research and that taping the interview might not be as
92
threatening. In addition, recording interviews is essential if the researcher wants to focus
not only on ‘what’ the interviewees say but also on ‘how’ they say it (Brown & Dowling,
1998). Recording interviews has helped me maintain the flow of the conversation, remain
alert and know when to probe in responses (Bell, 1995; Burton, 1996). I was able to capture
the exact words of the participants and thus preserve the meaning in the words that the
interviewees used (Oppenheim, 1996). Recorded interviews also have the advantage of
being examined by other people too (see Appendix VIII: Sample Transcripts of Interviews).
There are key issues in interviewing. Interviewers need to establish rapport and develop
interviewing skills (Best & Khan, 1989). It goes without saying that interviewing was part
of my job as a supervisor. As a researcher, I had also conducted several studies based on
interviews (e.g. Alwan, 2000, 2001, 2002 & 2003; Loughrey et al, 1999). I am also aware
of the drawbacks of bias in interviews and tried to eliminate it. Biased interviews result
when the interviewer has a priori expectations of what the respondents would say. In my
case, the interview schedule guided the interviews but since I used open-ended questions,
participants were free to explore other issues related to the topic under discussion.
4.6 Procedures
I piloted the interview schedule with a colleague first then with two of the research
informants. Piloting made me refine the interview questions (Glesne & Peshkin, 1992),
eliminate redundancy, and omit factual questions which could be answered by some
participants without repeating them with others (such as the question on who prepared
exams).
93
I went to each school once a week. On every visit, I was greeted warmly by whoever was in
the staffroom. While I was waiting for the teacher to be interviewed according to a prior
appointment, I would normally sit in the staffroom having informal conversations with the
teachers while they were checking their planning, marking their students’ written work or
resting in between lessons. I was rarely left alone as teachers would initiate general
discussions which I was invited to join in; at that point, I also took advantage to pursue
more data.
At the time of the scheduled interview, I made sure that the teacher interviewed had
sufficient time to rest after class before accompanying her to a different room to conduct
the interview in privacy. After completion of each interview, I escorted the teachers and
took notes to record whatever data were relevant to the research topic that emerged in the
conversation on the way. Ruane (2005) refers to this type of data collection as an informal
interview. Besides establishing rapport, this technique is a valuable tool for follow-up of
the research topic from the participant’s perspective.
After the interview, I would escort the teacher back to the staffroom only to be received
warmly by others who had been busy teaching for the morning. During recess, there was
much chatting and the teachers made me feel one of them. I was touched by their
expressions of welcome, and their hospitality in keeping me entertained was truly
outstanding. Sometimes I left directly after the interview when I saw that my presence was
distracting them and I felt guilty about it.
I continued to interview the teachers on the basis of initial analysis and went back to
interview the participants on further issues based on initial analysis and to validate their
94
previous responses, as I explained earlier. The subsequent interviews were shorter. When I
reached the point of saturation (see 4.5), I conducted group interviews as a formal member
checking procedure in each school. Hence, I had observed the variety of timings
recommended for data collection. To quote Woods (1999:3): “research methods have to be
sensitive to the perspectives of all participants, and must sample across place and over time
as perspectives may vary accordingly”.
4.7 Data Analysis
Interpretive research has a heuristic nature. The researcher adopts an inductive approach in
analysing the data which are recorded without prior knowledge or conception of the
phenomenon under investigation. Therefore, interpretive research is hypothesis generating
through the discovery and description of patterns (Seliger & Shohamy, 1990). Interpretive
researchers begin by understanding each individual’s interpretation of the world around
him or her. Therefore, theory is said to be emergent, as it emerges from data taken from a
particular situation (Cohen & Manion, 1995). Theory in qualitative research is developed
directly from the data (Strauss, 1987). The conclusions reached are not seen as established
knowledge; rather, they are regarded as possible hypotheses for further research (Seliger &
Shohamy, 1990).
The common adage that describes theory in interpretive research is: “theory is neither
explanation nor prediction…it is interpretation” (Glesne & Peshkin, 1992:19). Hence
generating hypotheses is a major characteristic of qualitative research. Consequently, I used
some techniques from the grounded theory approach by presenting the findings in
categories (Denzin & Lincoln, 1994; Glesne & Peshkin, 1992; Holliday, 2001; Stake,
95
1995). Grounded theory is a form of qualitative analysis in which the researcher makes
constant comparisons, codes similar data and develops theory out of the data (Strauss,
1987; Merriam, 1998). Devised by Glaser and Strauss (in Merriam, 1998), this method
requires researchers to begin with a particular incident in the data and compare it with
another instance in the same data. These constant comparisons lead to categories which
later on lead to formulation of theories (Merriam, 1998).
As I mentioned earlier, I began to analyse the data while collecting them. I agree with
theorists who contend that simultaneous data collection and analysis is advantageous in
gaining more depth as the researcher is able to pursue issues raised by the data early in the
research (Radnor, 2002; Holliday, 2001). However, as Maxwell (1996) reports, some
theorists contend that this may make the researcher biased when collecting more data. But
I was aware of this drawback and worked to eliminate its effect. While transcribing the
interviews directly on the word-processor, which proved to be an excellent way to become
immersed in the data, I kept notes of the recurring themes. I used these as headings for
sections in a document on the computer that I used as a draft for analysis. I cut and pasted
each part of the interview that fitted into each initial category based on the research
questions and categories based on recurrent themes. Some parts indicated more than one
meaning, so I pasted copies in places where they fitted. I did this every time I transcribed
an interview.
Initially, the resulting themes were affected by the research questions at this point. This had
been the preliminary data analysis that I kept aside for two weeks while working on the
literature review during the end of semester exam. The rationale behind this was to let the
data ‘incubate’ for a period of time (Rossman & Rallis, 2003). I also went to see the
96
participants during the exams to maintain involvement all the way and verify their opinions
about the exam that they singled out as a major drawback in the curriculum. After that, I
refined the categories and established new ones when I went to consider the data for a
second phase of the analysis. A week later, during the mid-year holiday, I read whole
transcripts of individual interviews and worked out extra themes and noted down further
questions to be used in the second round of data collection. After obtaining the second set
of data, during February, 2004, I divided them into the established categories. I also worked
out sub-categories. Throughout the analysis process, I used to go back to the schools for
member-checking (see 4.8.1). During the second half of April, 2004, I worked out a
summary of the findings and interpretations that I used as a basis for the final member-
checking. I had given a copy to each participant beforehand to reduce the demands on the
teachers’ time during the working hours. In summary, I ‘lived’ with the data throughout the
period of the research (Rossman & Rallis, 2003).
4.8 Authenticity Criteria: Provisions for Trustworthiness
Trustworthiness is a set of quality criteria for judging interpretive research, which is also
known as ‘authenticity criteria’ (Guba & Lincoln, 1989 & 1994; Lincoln & Guba, 1985;
Schwandt, 2001). The decisive measurement of the trustworthiness in qualitative research
is “whether we believe the findings strongly enough to act on them” (Maykut & Morehouse
(2001:147). The procedures taken in qualitative research establish trustworthiness of the
research (Johnson & Saville-Troike, 1992). Nonetheless, establishing trustworthiness in
qualitative research cannot be proven but can only be strived for (Guba & Lincoln, 1989).
In this regard, qualitative research theorists advise researchers to explain what precautions
they have taken to enhance the trustworthiness of the findings of their studies (Linclon &
97
Guba, 1985). In this account, I shall give an overview of three trustworthiness criteria:
credibility, transferability and dependability (Guba & Lincoln, 1989; Lincoln & Guba,
1985).
4.8.1 Credibility
To establish credibility, the researcher strives to make the constructed realities in the
interpretation of the data match the constructed realities of the research participants (Guba
& Lincoln, 1989). This is achieved when the researcher provides information on the
methods used for collecting the data and justifies them (Robson, 2002). I took into
consideration the establishment of the criterion of ‘credibility’ from the start. First, as a
researcher, I think I fit into the requirement of prolonged involvement that theorists
recommend to ascertain credibility (e.g. Guba & Lincoln, 1989; Tashakkori & Teddlie,
1998). I selected the research setting from the wide context which I have been working in.
My previous work experience within the context (about nine years) and with the research
participants (from three to nine years with each one of them) helped me establish the
rapport necessary to gain access as well as build the trust which is necessary for uncovering
the participants’ constructions of reality. Although the period for conducting the research
was about six months (December 2003 to May 2004), with varying degrees of involvement
from one day each week in every school to partial involvement during April (the time when
I prepared a summary of my interpretations to give to the participants), I still feel confident
that I have taken precautions to establish credibility from the point of view of involvement.
As Robson (2002) asserts, involvement over a period of few weeks or months is usually
accepted.
98
Second, I also took steps to establish credibility through another procedure recommended
by Lincoln and Guba (1985) which is peer debriefing. Although one debriefing session is
not as effective as many, it has contributed to enhancing self-reflection. My colleagues,
who have been doctoral students too, were supportive and critical at the very beginning
when I informed them of the plan of the research and the initial findings that the pilot
interviews revealed in December, 2003, the first month of the fieldwork. The questions
raised during the session defined biases at an early stage of the inquiry, and contributed to
exploring certain aspects in the inquiry which I had not considered at the beginning (e.g.
the issue of authority in curriculum change) and to improving the quality of my
interpretations of the data (Lincoln & Guba, 1985).
Third, and last, theorists also recommend member-checks as part of the quest for
establishing credibility (e.g. Guba & Lincoln, 1989; Holliday, 2001). Member-checking is
the process of seeking feedback on data analysis from the research participants depending
on early analysis. This technique helps to find out whether the realities constructed by the
researcher reflect the realities perceived by the research participants (Guba & Lincoln,
1989), and guards against researcher bias (Robson, 2002). Accordingly, I tested the
interpretations and refined the categories with the participants throughout the period of the
inquiry. To verify the data, I provided each informant with her interview transcript and they
all confirmed that the record of the interview was accurate (Punch, 1998). I checked the
analysis with each of them in subsequent visits to the schools when I talked to individual
participants about my initial categories and interpretations. I tested my interpretations with
the research informants throughout the course of the study as this is an approved informal
procedure (Guba & Lincoln, 1989). In addition, I had a formal member check with each
group in the three schools in the end as a round off. Both informal and formal member-
99
checks proved useful in confirming the data and collecting additional evidence to clarify
certain points. Thus the study is credible to the research participants.
4.8.2 Transferability
Transferability is a consideration that the conclusions reached in a study can be transferable
to other similar contexts or settings (Punch, 1998). As Schwandt (2001:258) concedes,
transferability deals with:
“(T)he issue of generalization in terms of case-to-case transfer. It concern(s) the inquirer’s responsibility for providing readers with sufficient information on the case studied such that readers (can) establish the degree of similarity between the case studied and the case to which findings might be transferred”.
The rationale behind not considering generalisations is that interpretive researchers study
multiple realities and focus on the uniqueness of the context. However, transferability of
hypotheses generated may be claimed by providing sufficient detailed accounts of the
context investigated (Davis, 1992).
To check for transferability, there are three aspects of the research which need to be
focussed upon: (1) theoretical sampling; (2) thick descriptions of context and (3) the degree
of abstraction of the concepts in the data analysis (Guba & Lincoln, 1989; Lincoln & Guba,
1985; Punch, 1998). In my view, the findings based on the setting under study may be
reflected elsewhere in the context of the UAE based on the diversity of characteristics that
the sample represents, the detailed description of the context, and the level of abstraction in
the data analysis.
100
4.8.3 Dependability
The criterion of dependability in qualitative research denotes that the data are stable and
that any changes can be tracked by the public by providing a clear account of changes in
research design (Guba & Lincoln, 1989). Schwandt (2001:258) defines dependability as
“the process of the enquiry and the inquirer’s responsibility for ensuring that the process of
the inquiry was logical, traceable, and documented”. In this study, I used an emergent
research design and explained any decisions made during the course of the study. In
addition, I also considered triangulation, through member validation and diversity of
research settings, as a means towards achieving dependability.
Triangulation is also known as ‘parallel mixed analysis’ (Tashakkori & Teddlie, 1998:128).
However, I depended on member-checking as a main validating procedure to enhance the
trustworthiness of the investigation more than on triangulating the data sources to include
non-human informants (see 4.5.1). In addition, I believe that by selecting three schools I
have achieved triangulation in terms of the diversity of settings studied (Denzin, in
Maxwell, 1996).
It is worth noting that Guba and Lincoln (1989:162) show how triangulation has a positivist
implication but still accept it as a way of doing research. They explain that when qualitative
elements are mixed with traditional positivist methods to illuminate the data, the inquirer
does not “move away from the basic belief system of positivism” but capitalises on “the
putative synergistic effects of multimethods”. According to Tashakkori and Teddlie
(1998:91): “Many qualitative theorists and researchers do not triangulate because they do
not believe that there is a single reality that can be triangulated”. Similarly, Denzin and
101
Lincoln (1994:482) declare that: “there can be no single, or articulated truth”. Nonetheless,
as I argued earlier, there is virtue in variety (see 4.5.1). Triangulation improves “the quality
of inferences” (Tashakkori & Teddlie, 1998:169) and contributes to trustworthy
conclusions.
As noted earlier, to Lincoln and Guba (1985), only documents which are prepared by
participants are grounded in the data and contribute to grounded theory. Maxwell (1996)
also concedes that there is also danger in selecting methods which have the same self-report
bias such as interviews, questionnaires and documents. I had this in mind and did not widen
the scope of the study to include questionnaires. Rather, I depended heavily on member-
checking in the research design. I think that teachers are the only human informants who
can better express their perceptions. Including other human informants would have defeated
the aim of the study. However, as I explained above, I used documents as data sources to
explain the background and answer the research questions that are of factual nature. In
summary, member-checking and variety of settings were the only form of triangulation
used that were found to suite the purpose of the study and fit into its conceptual framework.
Thus, in my view, I have striven to maintain a dependable inquiry.
4.9 Ethical Considerations
In the light of the established codes of ethics, the researcher has responsibilities to the
research informants. Qualitative researchers believe that there is no such a thing as bias-free
or value-free inquiry (Janesick, 1994). Therefore, it is extremely important to observe
ethical standards in research that involves human participants in schools (Nunan, 1997).
Overall, data collection is governed by the code of conduct that the consequence of
102
participating in a study does not harm the respondents in any way (Fraenkel & Wallen,
2000; Oppenheim, 1996). In this research I have taken the following steps to safeguard the
research participants:
A. The researcher should communicate the aims of the research to those participating
in the study (Glesne & Peshkin, 1992; Radnor, 2002). Observing this code of ethics,
I conducted an initial meeting for the purpose of explaining what the research was
about (see Appendix VI). I also explained the purpose of the research briefly before
each interview.
B. In doing research, the right of the respondents to refuse participation should be
respected (Glesne & Peshkin, 1992; Maxwell, 1996; Punch, 1998; Silverman,
2001). I explained to the participants that their participation was valuable but
depended on their agreement to participate willingly. I had contacted the
participants directly and not through the school principals for fear that they might be
coerced to participate. As Ruane (2005) concedes, the principle of informed consent
is violated if any hint of coercion exists. Basically, all the teachers who participated
in the research did so voluntarily and they knew that they could avoid answering
some questions if they wanted (Burton, 1996; Ruane, 2005) or that they could
withdraw at any point without offering any explanation (Frankael & Wallen, 2000)
(see Appendix VI; see also 4.3 above for teachers who were not included).
C. In an attempt to minimise place threats, I conducted the interviews privately with
each teacher in a convenient vacant room in each of the schools: in a multi-purpose
room in one school, the meetings room in another and the English Club in the third.
103
As Fraenkel and Wallen (2000) assert, some places of data collection may influence
the responses, and are seen as a ‘location threat’. Therefore, I avoided using the
staffroom when other teachers were present. Such a setting is also viewed as
unpleasant (Oppenheim, 1996) and threatening to confidentiality (Berg, 2001;
Brown & Dowling, 1998).
D. Recording interviews without taking permission of the participants is unethical
(Maykut & Morehouse, 2001). Therefore, I sought permission to tape interviews
from each participant. I also stopped it according to their wishes when they reached
issues that they considered confidential. I only resumed the recording when the
topic was over. This preserved their right to decide that some of the data were not to
be used if they asked for this (Frankael & Wallen, 2000).
E. Interviews that are rushed or that are conducted when the interviewer is tired may
affect the outcome of the study and this is known as ‘instrument decay’ (Frankael &
Wallen, 2000). I conducted the interviews on different dates, at a time convenient to
each participant (see 4.5.2 & 4.6).
F. The identities of the participants were protected so that they would not be
identifiable (Burton, 1996; Glesne & Peshkin, 1992; Punch, 1998). In my initial
meeting with the teachers in each school, I promised to keep the participants’ names
and the school names confidential. I also explained that I would not disclose any
part of the raw data or findings to a third party including supervisors and principals.
To respect this confidentiality, I avoided any citation that would disclose the sites in
the study (Glesne & Peshkin, 1992; Ruane, 2005; Taylor & Bogdan, 1984). While
104
the zone, my work place, and the schools may be identifiable as there are only three
secondary schools for girls in this zone, I did not divide the participants in groups
according to their schools so as to disguise their identities. In the interest of
preserving anonymity, the interviews are annexed in random order and I used
pseudonyms with quotations from interviews.
4.10 Limitations of the Study
Best and Khan (1989:37) explain that “limitations are those conditions beyond the control
of the researcher that may place restrictions on the conclusions of the study and their
application to other situations”. It is essential to avoid or eliminate sources of error
throughout the research process. The current study had the following limitations that I made
my best to eliminate their effects and I hereby acknowledge them:
A. My previous work as a supervisor of the participant teachers might have had an
effect on the responses. Although I recognise this factor, its tacit effect on the
responses could not be identified or eliminated.
B. The fact that I have co-authored two sets of materials for the secondary stage might
have affected the teachers’ views in some ways. Although the teachers have
criticised those two levels that I have co-authored (for Grades 10 and 11) as well,
the potential effect of this factor on the teacher’s responses could not be overlooked.
Had this been an evaluative study of the textbooks, this would have been a negative
factor affecting the conclusions of the study.
105
C. The research was conducted with female teachers, male teachers’ views could be
different from the ones the study has revealed about teachers’ perceptions of
curriculum change and their roles in the curriculum, and could have enriched the
data. Nonetheless, the reasons for not including male teachers were inherently
cultural.
D. The research was conducted in one educational district. Its findings may not
conform to perceptions of teachers in other districts. However, transferability of
findings to similar settings or contexts is not totally ruled out as a result of this
limitation (see 4.8.2).
E. The period of data collection began towards the end of the first semester. Teacher
perceptions might have been affected by the tension known to occur around final
examinations. A history threat may be considered applicable here too as there could
have been unforeseen influences on the participants’ perceptions during the period
of the study. However, on-going member-checking might have eliminated this
factor. Purposely, I conducted follow-up interviews with the participants
individually, at a time in February that was considered stable. I also obtained their
opinion on the analysis of the data throughout the course of study. I asked them
extra questions that needed to be clarified depending on the on-going analysis and
requested clarification on other points at times that were the least stressful at the
beginning and throughout the second semester. The group interviews have helped
also in checking my inferences and enhancing the trustworthiness of the data in this
regard.
106
F. The scope of the study was limited to interviewing as a data collection instrument
besides document reviews. The use of questionnaires might have provided breadth
and could have served to enhance the trustworthiness of the data. However, the
focus on perceptions as constructs of beliefs or constructions of reality (see 3.2.1)
cannot take the form of a pre-established set of beliefs as would be required in a
questionnaire. Also, from my own experience, teachers tend to fill in questionnaires
cooperatively. Furthermore, the use of questionnaires does not fit into the
framework of the study but should, nonetheless, be recognised as a limitation in
terms of breadth.
In the Chapter 5, I shall present the findings of this study supported by actual quotes from
interview transcripts. In addition, I shall back up the findings with research findings from
the literature.
107
CHAPTER V
FINDINGS AND DISCUSSION
INTRODUCTION
This chapter is a presentation and discussion of the findings derived from the data backed
up with quotes from interviews and findings in the literature. It is divided into three
sections according to the major research questions. Within each section, I provide answers
to the research questions as well as categories that emerged from them.
5.1. TEACHERS’ PERCEPTIONS OF CURRICULUM CHANGE
This section attempts to answer the first major research question: How do English language
teachers in public secondary schools in the UAE perceive curriculum change? As I explain
below, overall, participants considered the ‘books’ to be the curriculum and ‘curriculum
change’ as having a new set of materials to teach. There are, of course, a few teachers who
expanded their views of curriculum to include other aspects. Still, when referring to the
curriculum, they used the word ‘book’.
108
5.1.1 “Curriculum is the books”
In answer of the research question (1.a): What do EL teachers understand by ‘curriculum’
in the UAE context? Analysis of the data revealed that most of the participants had a view
of the curriculum as solely the materials. Others included extra–curricular activities in their
definition of curriculum and a few gave a wider definition that included evaluation; while
one participant mentioned human elements like students and teachers. Consider, for
instance, the remark: “Curriculum is the books; it is the content that we teach” (T11). This
perception of curriculum also centres on the teaching materials regardless of their source:
“The curriculum includes the whole set of books, the book, the workbook, tapes…possibly
magazines, newspapers,…things that can be brought into the classroom in order to make
the students take the language from different sources” (T13).
Still other participants had been aware that the curriculum is a wider concept but their
views of it revolved around the materials to be taught. As one teacher explained:
“Curriculum should cover textbooks, activities to be done in class; extra–curricular
activities... Things that I do inside the classroom and things students should do. It is not just
the textbook” (T2). A similar view was conveyed by another teacher, who mentioned that:
“Curriculum means teachers, students, books, cassettes, media, teaching aids” (T1).
Nonetheless, although these teachers gave a wider definition of curriculum, their use of the
term in response to the questions mirrored the meaning of the term ‘curriculum’ among all
the participants in the study. A similar view has been found in the local literature. For
instance, Loughrey et al’s (1999) findings echo the same perception of curriculum: “[I]t
appears that in the view of those working in the system the curriculum is in practice the
course books. Most teachers and many supervisors are not familiar with any other
109
curriculum or syllabus besides the books they use in their teaching” (Loughrey et al,
1999:26). Loughrey et al go even to the extent of stating that although there is an official
curriculum document, there is no English language curriculum in public schools in the
UAE. While this is an extreme view which is not supported by the data in the mentioned
study, it is reflective of the narrow view of the curriculum in the UAE as the materials only.
In an attempt to explore the rationale behind this perception, I would like to refer to Apple
(1997:346) who maintains that: “the fact that the textbook became the major organizing
element of the curriculum…was the complicated result of …the politics of …
bureaucratization in the schools and the teachers’ responses to it”. In other words, the
hierarchical structures of educational institutions lead to this narrow perspective of the
‘book’ as the ‘curriculum’. The textbook is the product which reaches teachers or those
who are at the lower end of the hierarchy.
This perception of curriculum as the teaching materials has a domino effect on the other
aspects of the curriculum. Some elements of the curriculum, like teaching, learning and
testing seemed to be affected by this perspective. There is no doubt, for instance, that this
perception of the curriculum as a ‘product’ rather than a ‘process’ has implications for the
way the participant teachers dealt with the materials. This perception also denotes stability
whereby the textbooks are to be taught, as they are, regardless of the students’ needs. The
finding that the textbooks are not usually modified (see 5.2.1.2) serves to promote this
perception of an inflexible curriculum. As the findings reveal, all the participants reported
difficulties in adapting the materials to the students’ needs (see 5.1.2.6). Moreover,
examinations also centre on the content of the books.
110
5.1.2 Curriculum Change: A change of books
This section answers the research question (1.b): What do EL teachers understand by
‘curriculum change’ in the UAE context? As I shall argue, the findings reflect the general
perception of the curriculum as solely the materials taught. Hence a change of textbooks
was seen as a change of curriculum. The same theme encompasses different categories
related to teachers’ perceptions of curriculum change which I shall be discussing too within
this section.
5.1.2.1 “When we say curriculum change, the books are changed”
As a result of the perception of the books as the curriculum, all the participants gave one
meaning for curriculum change, which was having a change in the books they teach. They
asserted that when the MoE changes curricula in public schools in the UAE, the overall
concept is that the books are changed. The following statement supports this case: “Here,
when we say curriculum change, the books are changed” (T7). This same view was held by
all the participants in the study. However, two of the participants mentioned that change
should not be limited to ‘books’ but should include teaching approaches and tests.
When I asked them how far they considered the change in the curriculum to be a real
change compared to the former curriculum, some participants saw that the ‘books’ had
improved but some recognised this as a ‘partial’ improvement. When asked what aspects of
the curriculum made it new, participants explained that only the ‘books’ were new. They
explained that the test had not changed. As some teachers asserted: “Just the books, nothing
else is new” (T13), and “We can say that just the books have been changed and nothing
111
else. The tests, of course, have not been changed” (T16). However, a few participants
reported a slight modification in one type of questions in the exam specifications. Take for
instance the response: “The part of the test that has changed is how to make questions”
(T7). Conversely, another participant remarked: “Exams are still the same, what changed
with the textbook is the marking scheme whereas we expected that they would change the
way they examine students” (T2). Similarly, another declared: “Even the exams have not
changed. Still, they are based on memorisation of the book” (T1). In summary, the nature
of the exam remained the same save for a change in one of the instructions in the exam
specifications. Why some teachers had conflicting views in considering this a change or not
may be due to the fact that the nature of the exam remained the same as in the former
curriculum in spite of the slight change in rubric used (see section 5.1.2.5).
Since curriculum development is an aspect of curriculum change, I pursued the topic to see
how teachers perceived curriculum development. With reference to the interview
transcripts, the research participants fell into three categories with regard to their
understanding of curriculum development, two of them had been underpinned by the
perception of the ‘book’ as the curriculum. The first view was held by two of the
participants who defined curriculum development as teachers trying to make the given
curriculum better in terms of teaching the material in innovative ways. The second group
saw curriculum development as improving the materials by constant modifications based
on feedback from teachers. This group talked about what should be done and not what was
happening in reality. The third perspective was taken by one participant who understood
curriculum development as following steps starting from surveying needs to setting
objectives, preparing and piloting materials, to teaching, testing, and modifying materials.
However, this participant admitted that that was what happened in an ideal world, which
112
was not the case in the UAE. What is evident is that their responses were justified by the
realisation that what came out of the curriculum development process were mainly new
textbooks.
Similar contradictory views were held regarding the aspects that changed in the curriculum
in accordance with the teaching techniques, the teaching materials, the adaptability of
materials to students’ needs, and testing, as mentioned above.
5.1.2.2 Stability in teaching techniques: A point of controversy
Although most participants asserted that only the ‘books’ had changed, they gave
contradictory responses with regard to whether the teaching techniques had changed or not.
Some of them had not recognised any change in this aspect of the curriculum at all, while
others had. Meanwhile, some teachers who recognised the change in teaching techniques
attributed it to individual preferences, personal efforts or personal initiatives and did not
consider it as part of the overall change in the curriculum. For example, (T6) affirmed:
“Even the teaching techniques, you can say that they remained the same except for teachers
to use new ways on their own”. Further, a few participants attributed the change in
techniques to change in the type of tasks in the textbooks. This view was shared by (T3),
who asserted: “The techniques are different because of the different tasks in the workbook”.
In consequence, another finding indicates that despite the change in textbooks, some
participants had not changed their teaching techniques. Although several participants
ascribed the change in teaching techniques to the change of tasks in the teaching materials,
they still resorted to traditional ways of teaching. This did not prevail in every lesson. On
113
the contrary, they tried to be creative in teaching the materials. However, it was common to
use more traditional techniques during times of pressure, like the time when the first round
of data were collected for this study, as schools were approaching the final exam for the
first semester. All the participants pointed out time as the main constraint which forced
them to resort to traditional teaching methods. As one teacher pointed out:
“Yes, they [teaching techniques] have changed as a result of changing the types of tasks in the book…The tasks require a lot of group work… But I think it is not appropriate because of the time required for this task because if we do them in the way they should be done, this will have an effect on the other material. We will run short of time if we do them the way they have to be done” (T13).
In this vein, some participants explained that there had been change in teaching techniques
that were not part of the current change in curriculum but a result of the change in the
resources available and their personal initiatives; others credited the change in teaching
techniques to personal efforts. Consider, for example, this view:
“The books are completely different and they require different work. With the old curriculum, we didn’t have the present technology of computers. My lessons are now different from those five years ago; I am not teaching in the same way…Yes, my teaching techniques have been changed completely. Before, I used to depend on drawings, gestures and realia. That was what we had then as I didn’t have a computer at home” (T10).
Likewise, another participant attributed the change in teaching techniques to personal
efforts rather than considering it part of the change in curriculum. This can be understood
from her remark: “We are developing our teaching techniques depending on the seminars
we attend. So, we have been renewing our teaching techniques for the previous books, this
is something we do for our own development…it has nothing to do with the books” (T2).
While it is not directly stated in the materials, the curriculum adopts a task-based approach.
According to the findings above, there are three points to consider. First, all the teachers did
114
not see the change in teaching techniques as part of the imposed change in the materials.
They perceived it as an inevitable development as a result of their self–directed endeavours
in professional development, and their willingness to use up-to-date technological teaching
aids in teaching that required change in teaching techniques all the way. Second, some
participants rationalised why they resorted to old techniques despite the fact that they
believed in task-based learning. They had given various reasons to justify their actions. And
third, although several participants explained that they welcomed change and liked it, their
actual teaching techniques remained unchanged. This paradox between perceptions and
actions is also echoed in forthcoming findings (see 5.1.2.6 & 5.1.3).
In response to the interview question: What is the overall approach in the curriculum?, all
the participants explained that the teaching material was organised around themes. Some of
them approved of the organisation of the textbooks but others found faults in it. All of
them, however, refuted any aspect of gradation in the materials. Further, some teachers saw
no clear approach adopted in teaching the materials and explained that the curriculum did
not state what good ways of teaching were. Nonetheless, all the participants recognised that
the tasks required student–centred techniques, as explained earlier. Paradoxically, some
participants did not recognise that there were suggested teaching techniques in the teachers’
book, while others, who asserted that there were suggested teaching techniques, had some
critical comments about the recommended ways of teaching.
Furthermore, some teachers expressed their belief that they could not judge whether what
they were doing was good teaching or not. As (T4) criticised: “We do not know what is
right and what is wrong…We teach the material in the way we think suitable”. Based on
my view of the teaching materials, I think that the teachers’ perceptions in this respect are
115
justified. The teaching materials did not seem to have a distinct identity with regard to
teaching methodology. They seemed to be composed of scattered unrelated units where
language gradation was not considered.
In a similar vein, Loughrey et al (1999) contend that teachers in the UAE are working in
isolation and are not able to form a clear perception of a coherent curriculum. This is not
exclusive to the UAE as, according to Fullan and Pumfret (in Barrow, 1984), it is common
to find some teachers who cannot identify the features of the curriculum they are dealing
with. This explains why aspects of weak teaching might still prevail in the UAE public
schools (Loughrey et al, 1999). On the other hand, Hacker and Rowe (1998) argue that it is
not essential that curriculum developers recommend teaching strategies since materials
convey implications of the recommended teaching strategy. Although this reflects the case
at hand, in my opinion, I would argue otherwise. Having a clear statement of the teaching
methodology ensures that the ‘experienced curriculum’ is in accordance with the ‘planned
curriculum’. This should also clear any misconceptions associated with perceived stability
of any element of the curriculum during curriculum change (the argument is pursued in
5.1.2.6).
5.1.2.3 The Teacher’s Book: A neglected innovation I was surprised to find that some of the teachers of the second secondary book (Grade 11)
not only did not own a teachers’ book but also did not know that the new curriculum had a
detailed teacher’s book. Whilst some participants said that they had no idea that it was
available, others explained that they preferred to teach in their own ways. Surprisingly, only
one teacher reported a change in having a detailed teacher’s book as in the former
curriculum this was not the case. She said: “There is also a teacher’s book in this course, in
116
the past we had a general teaching guide which we did not refer to. The teacher’s book
gives brief suggestions of how to deal with each lesson” (T2). Within the course of the
interviews, however, I found that not all the teachers who owned a teacher’s book read the
recommended teaching procedures in it. They also differed in how they viewed the
teacher's book in terms of how often they used the suggestions. However, they agreed that
most of the recommended procedures were monotonous and inadequate. As (T8) stated: “I
usually follow the procedures that I feel useful and skip the procedures that I do not find
convincing”. Those who did not use the teacher's book asserted that it was not helpful:
“You don’t know what is the mind of the writer...you don’t get the idea. Sometimes it gives
you broad guidelines that do not help… there is no creativity” (T7).
Consequently, the majority of the teachers admitted that they neither read the suggestions in
the teachers’ book nor used them. Surprisingly, some of them did not own one at all. In my
opinion, the reason why teachers had not been encouraged to follow the suggestions is
underpinned by the issue of routine. Teachers had not have a detailed teacher’s guide in the
past and they continued to work in the same way based on the premise adopted formerly
that teachers have a wide range of expertise and should not be restricted with a teaching
manual (1994 Curriculum Document). Evidently, all the teachers continued to do what they
used to do before the change in curriculum regardless of the presence of a teacher's book.
5.1.2.4 Adaptability of Teaching Materials: “We have to teach every point”
As the findings revealed, all the teachers needed to supplement the textbooks in areas
where linguistic items required recycling, as the materials were lacking in this aspect.
Further, some units of the materials needed to be taught in several lessons which
117
necessitated the presence of teacher-prepared worksheets that bound the content together
and made it coherent. In this respect, the participants had different perceptions with regard
to the adaptability of the new teaching materials in terms of modifying the current content
and preparing materials of their own to cater for students’ needs.
As the interview responses revealed, participants had contradictory perceptions of the new
teaching materials. Some found them flexible but others commented on the rigidity caused
by the content–bound exam format which forced them to teach the content in ways that
were compatible with the exam. Participants also had different perceptions with regard to
the rationale behind adaptation. While some said that the materials needed to be adapted to
meet the needs of the students, some teachers suspected these intentions. They believed that
the teachers’ initiatives were mainly to show off in their teaching portfolios which were
used as tools in the teacher evaluation scheme. On the other hand, all the teachers expressed
their dissatisfaction with the inflexibility of the materials in most cases.
In the first place, the dominant role of the ‘book’ as the centre point of the curriculum
manifests itself in the finding that teachers perceived the available material as having the
priority over anything they wished to add. This is clear in this declaration:
“It limits me. It limits my freedom. I cannot change the content. I cannot just give another lesson from my own because I do not like it. I can’t. But in other areas, like structures, I can really add, extend things when this is for [the students’] benefit. But for the topics, the lessons themselves, I can’t do this” (T8)
Comments like ‘limiting’ and ‘restricted’ were repeatedly used by some participants to
describe the ‘books’ as the major component of the teaching materials. However, they gave
various reasons to rationalise the need for adaptation. On the one hand, the procedures
suggested in the textbook were monotonous and repetitive, so they needed a sense of
118
change; and on the other hand, some lessons seemed above the students’ levels and they
needed to be simplified. As one participant explained: “There are lessons that are really
hard to present as they are complicated and full of new words” (T10). Another rationale for
adaptation was the perceived monotony of the lessons. For instance, one participant was
satisfied with the fact that there was a variety in the topics discussed in the book, as the
themes on which the language content was based were varied. However, she expressed
discontent with the repetitiveness of the book by saying: “There is a variety in the topics
and we do not need to prepare extra material in that respect…But still … every lesson has
the same procedures in it. The tasks are repeated” (T16). In addition, some participants
pointed out that there was a need to prepare extra materials to meet students’ needs.
Another rationale behind the need for adaptation is the feeling of satisfaction that some of
them gained when adapting the materials. (T13)’s remark that she was happy with
supplementing the textbooks as it made her “feel creative”, for instance, implies that she
derived a sense of joy when she exercised her creativity by manipulating the teaching
materials to make them suit her students’ needs.
Teachers commented also on the type of adaptations they did which included preparing
worksheets with some lessons and changing the sequence of lessons. They all agreed,
however, that although they supplemented the ‘book’, teaching what was in the ‘book’ was
on the top of their agenda. This is clear in the remark: “I can change the way I teach the
lessons, their sequence but I cannot change the texts… Unfortunately, we cannot change
what is in the book” (T7). This shared perception of the teaching materials as limited was
repeatedly highlighted in the interviews. Participants cited several reasons why they felt
that the materials were limiting. One of the reasons is the final exams as they would be
based on the contents of the books (see 5.1.2.5). Another reason is the amount of content as
119
the books are satiated, as they pointed out earlier. Further, the tendency of the students to
be exam–oriented is also limiting. As a teacher emphasised: “We cannot replace or cancel
any part because the tests are based on the book. We have to teach every point, everything,
every single word” (T1).
This finding is in accordance with Tantawi’s (1995) observation of the intensity of the
curriculum in the UAE. I think that teachers are justified in their view with regard to the
restrictions that made teaching all the material inevitable. Although some parts were
repetitious, as they all asserted, they could not overlook anything in the light of the word–
for–word book–bound nature of the final exam (see 5.1.2.5, and Appendix III).
Jacob and Frid (1997) use the argument that during curriculum change the teachers are
concerned about the negative effect of prescribed assessment methods. According to Al-
Sadan (2000), assessment systems in the Arab Gulf States underpin aspects of the
curriculum such as educational aims, teaching methods and emphasise the importance of
covering the teaching materials on which assessment is based. Al-Sadan makes the
observation that the main focus in this case is on the number of students who pass the
exams. In justification of the above emphasis on coverage, Hacker and Rowe (1998) concur
that it is typical for a mandatory curriculum to create a need to cover more curriculum
content. In case of public schools in the UAE, not only the textbooks are prescribed but also
the exam is content-based. This encourages memorisation and defies any claims for
linguistic aims in the curriculum.
120
5.1.2.5 “Testing is the same old traditional way”
As explained earlier, assessment in the curriculum had not changed. All the participants
emphasised that the tests remained the same as before and did not change in the format with
the change in textbooks. According to them, there is a strong relationship between the
content in the teaching materials and the basis of the final exam.
Exams, as participants explained, are content–based and are prepared by individual teachers
assigned by supervisors. These should be administered to all schools within the same
educational zone for Grades 10 and 11, and to all schools state wide for Grade 12. Final
exams are external ones and are prepared by selected teachers who deal with the same
level. Although this finding is not a result of curriculum change, it is a continuing result of
stability in assessment, which was not considered in the curriculum change agenda which
had been implemented. Many participants recognised this stability in several elements of
the curriculum in spite of the current change in teaching materials that signified the major
aspect of change in the curriculum.
Therefore, I pursued the topic further to find out how they perceived the effect of stability
of the testing regime. Commenting on the relationship between what was taught as opposed
to what was tested, (T4) remarked: “These are closely related. This was also the same case
with the previous book”. In consequence, all the participants admitted that they focussed on
what might appear in the exam paper. However, they claimed that they did not do this out
of choice. They regretted that instead of focussing on language proficiency and linguistic
skills, they were teaching to the test, as (T15) confessed: “Actually, we are teaching them
for the exam rather than to be able to use the language”. However, some participants tried
121
also to focus on the language despite the time pressure. The second effect of this close
relationship between the exam and the text was the constant pursuit for coverage, which
was of course at the expense of mastery. The third result of this close relationship is that it
limited adaptation of the materials to the students’ needs. Although all the teachers
supplemented the books with worksheets, they perceived that they did not have the choice
to supplement the books in the way that satisfied them. Fourth, as a consequence also, some
teachers were left worried to speculate about the nature of the exam in the cases where they
perceived the books as lacking in essential structural points. Fifth, there were even
problems as a result of this when correcting exam papers since students were expected to
produce the same content in the ‘books’, as (T6) asserted: “When we correct the exam
papers we need to check the answers against the book”. The final effect of the close
relationship between the materials and the exam that continued with the new curriculum is
that the students had become exam-oriented too, as the participants admitted. So they were
seen by a teacher as “just interested in collecting marks…not interested in developing their
language [and] keep asking whether what they learn is coming on the exam or not” (T11).
Therefore they “ask for models to memorise”, and become “scared” (T7) if their teachers
do not cover parts of the book.
According to the participants, the consequences of the close relationship between the test
and the materials were harmful when considering mastery of the language. As (T9)
affirmed: “I do not think that this is sensible, because we are just looking for the main goal
which is just passing the exam, not mastering the language”; and with her agreed (T2) who
explained the situation: “We are testing memorisation. For instance, we do not test free
writing because in the exam composition should be related and within what is covered in
the book. We do not test comprehension because comprehension should be related”. In this
122
case, participants suggested several remedies to combat the dilemma. For instance, one
teacher suggested that teachers should be provided with the recommended language
objectives to enable them to select their own materials to eliminate memorisation. Another
suggestion given was to make the composition topics not based on topics covered in the
textbooks.
While it is stated in older literature (e.g. Mann, 1983) that the exam should follow the
curriculum and not determine it, it seems that, in the UAE, things are still done in the old
way. According to all the participants, the exam is a central determining factor in the
curriculum which affects what is to be taught. This perception resulted in that all the
teachers made it a main concern to prepare their students for the exam. Coombe and Hubley
(2005) discuss the same negative washback effect of testing on teaching and learning
whereby both teachers and learners focus on what would appear in the test. According to
Coombe (2005b), this washback effect can only be avoided when involving teachers in
designing test specifications. She concedes that involving teachers in this endeavour is
expected to control the negative effect of exams on teaching, and lead to developing
assessment in the curriculum. It is obvious that all the teachers had been following the same
mediation strategy in the former curriculum. Had they been consulted when developing the
new curriculum, their dissatisfaction with this problem would have been the core for
changing the exam specifications. This issue of unheard teacher voice will be revisited in
later findings (see 5.2.2.3 , 5.2.2.4 & 5.2.2.5).
123
5.1.2.6 Teachers’ Strategies to Cope with Curriculum Change
As the analysis of interviews revealed, the participants faced various difficulties with the
current change. To cope with these obstacles, they explained that they managed to solve the
problems following certain strategies they found helpful. In the course of the interviews,
they explained their mediation or ‘survival’ strategies in their attempts to cope with the
main stressful issues in this change: The content and the demands of the final exams. There
are various strategies that teachers adopted in order to cope with the stressful amount of
content and the demands of the exam. There are also other strategies developed to combat
the students’ weaknesses and the perceived common learning style of being spoon-fed.
Survival strategies were clearly stated by teachers of Grade 12, specifically, as they were
facing the change for the first time.
As participants admitted, they faced the huge amount of content and limited time by
speeding up lessons and skipping activities which were not expected in the exam, such as
speaking and listening. They also translated the reading texts, and adopted more frontal or
teacher-controlled teaching techniques. Some of them gave models of written paragraphs,
prepared intensive worksheets that covered more content and joined classes together,
borrowing classes from teachers of other subjects who had completed the syllabus by the
end of the first semester.
The teachers had their own ways of overcoming limitations related to the unannounced
approach in the new curriculum. For instance, some of them used interpretation into Arabic,
124
others used a teacher-oriented approach. One participant described this situation with the
recently introduced materials for Grade 12:
“We started using student–centred learning but as the course proceeded, we faced many problems. There are too many tasks to be carried out, so many activities to be done… Now, because of lack of time, I teach using translation. I know it is useless, it is forbidden but I have no choice. I was forced to use a method I am not convinced with” (T2).
Participants, however, expressed their frustration with aspects of the ‘book’ which were in
conflict with the recommended teaching procedures. Despite the task-based approach
hinted at in the teacher's book, the teachers explained that the amount of content and the
weaknesses of the students restricted them from giving the tasks in the way they should, in
a student-centred way of teaching.
A crucial finding at this point was the way they got through the mentioned difficulties
within the context of an exam-driven curriculum in that they resorted to ways to cover the
materials and at the same time help their students get better scores in exams. As participants
remarked: “The speaking in fact can be well utilized for grading the students” (T8); “I give
them a model as an example right away to stick it in their books [and] I skip many
skills…,… it is a translation lesson” (T5), and “I .. skip the activities that may not appear in
the exam” (T2). Radnor et al (1995) assert that teachers may resort to strategies to help
students score well on tests. However, Gatbonton (1999) construes the use of translation as
a need to develop rapport with the students. Research on code-switching in multi-lingual
classrooms shows that it is used as a facilitative strategy (Martin-Jones, 2000). Teachers
resort to code-switching not only to signal transitions but also to get their points across as
well as to incorporate learner preferences. This also tends to occur in teacher-dominated
classrooms. Studies show that teachers tend to accept the learner’s use of the first language
125
to encourage contribution (Martin-Jones, 2000). According to the literature on teacher
thinking, teachers’ perceptions dictate how they teach as it influences teaching behaviour
(e.g. Freeman, 2002; Graves, 2003; Pajares, 1992; Williams & Burden, 2000). Participants’
perceptions revealed that they saw their students’ language proficiency as low and hence
they resorted to translating the content to them and providing them with models to
memorise. By following these strategies, they also managed to combat the perceived
lengthy materials and the limitations of time allotted for coverage. Commenting on the role
of contextual factors in forming teachers’ perceptions, Beijaard and De Vries (1997)
contend that the perceptions which teachers form about their students are based on
dissatisfactions during classroom situations. They also assert that when teachers do not like
innovations, they tend to attribute the underpinnings of their behaviour to external factors.
This finding supports previous research findings that traditional teacher-dominated,
transmission styles of teaching like lecturing, doing pattern drills and translation are still
common in the UAE (e.g. Al Nuaimin, 1991; Balfakih, 2003; Shaw et al, 1995). Dreyfus
and Mazouz (1989) found that reasons that teachers give to explain why they did not use
certain ways of teaching are pupil-related ones which may be imagined or actual. In
general, teachers claim that the needs and abilities of learners dictate the use of certain
techniques. Shaw et al (1995) also criticise the dominant style of teaching in the UAE
which is based on transmission and teacher’s control of the learning situation. However,
they attribute this style of teaching to ineffective teacher training rather than to contextual
factors (also Amro, 2001).
The teachers’ remarks, with regard to resorting to their old techniques, raise the issue of the
‘planned curriculum’ as opposed to the ‘experienced curriculum’. To quote Breen and
126
Littlejohn (2000:9) “the teacher’s interpretations of a syllabus and reasons for classroom
decisions are usually covert…the compromised syllabus is essentially the teachers’
creation”. Dreyfus and Mazouz (1989) argue that the gap between the planned curriculum
and the enacted one is mainly due to perceived feasibility from the part of the teacher.
Furthermore, several researchers found that change in classroom behaviours does not meet
the expectations of curriculum developers and is sometimes opposite to what they expect
(e.g. Gahin & Myhill, 2001; Karavas-Doukas, 1998; Newman, 1998). Dreyfus and Mazouz
(1989) emphasise that while the role of the teachers is to convey the planned curriculum in
the form of classroom activities, it is impossible to impose certain techniques on them,
which leads to the inevitable result that makes the experienced curriculum different from
the planned one.
Researchers assert that teachers’ methods remain the same in spite of curriculum change
since change is normally directed towards the practice without an attempt to challenge the
teachers’ beliefs or change contextual factors which affect teacher practice (Collinson &
Cook, 2000; Cooper & McIntyre, 1994; Galton & Isaac, 1983). Similarly, Borg (1998b &
1999), attributes the use of traditional techniques in teaching to the influence of teachers’
beliefs on their instructional decisions. Paradoxes between beliefs and practice on the other
hand are cited in Campbell et al (2001). These researchers found that there is a paradox
between teachers’ perceptions and their choice of teaching techniques. Karavas-Doukas
(1998) declares that it is a rare occurrence to find curriculum innovations implemented as
anticipated. As his findings indicate, teachers usually claim that they changed their
practices according to the requirements of the curriculum but their practices show that they
continue to work in the way they are familiar with, as in the following quote: “[T]eachers’
attitudes have been identified as context-specific, influenced by the values and philosophy
127
of the educational system of which the teacher is part … and by the attitudes and norms
held by others in the teachers’ working context” (Karavas-Doukas, 1998:31). From Hayes’s
(2000) point of view, the success of change implementation depends on the type of change
required of behaviour that teachers need to trade off. Likewise, Fullan and Hargreaves
(1992) explain that teachers choose their behaviour when they are aware of the need for
improvement depending on their own observations of the learning outcomes and on
training. While there is no doubt that teachers’ beliefs influence their classroom decisions,
I think that contextual factors have to be taken in mind when considering change in
teaching methods. For instance, Freeman (2002) argues that context is a foremost issue in
teacher education. Therefore, teacher educators must appreciate the complexities which
face teachers in their classroom and in the context in which they work. According to
Sharkey (2004:296) contextualisation “is a form of teacher praxis; it is an articulation of the
theory-practice dynamics”. By acknowledging these contextual factors, we can understand
the reasons for the paradox between the teachers’ articulated perceptions and their
mismatching classroom behaviour reported in this study.
5.1.3 Affective Issues in Curriculum Change
This section answers the research question (1.c): How do EL teachers feel about
‘curriculum change’ in the UAE context? Teachers’ feelings towards curriculum change
discussed were a recurrent theme in the data. Findings in this section are not only taken
from teachers’ responses to direct interview questions but also from their responses to other
questions around curriculum change. The overall interpretation of data revealed that
participants perceived change from various perspectives. Therefore, they expressed a
128
paradox in their feelings towards change depending on the stance from which they
considered curriculum change. I will be arguing here that participants developed mixed
feelings during curriculum change. I will also be explicating how the teachers’ feelings
evolved with the passing of time as familiarity with the new curriculum was enhanced.
5.1.3.1 Mixed Feelings
As the data revealed, some teachers had contradictory feelings as a result of change in the
curriculum. In addition, they seemed to express hard feelings that came as a result of
reflecting on their role in the process of curriculum development. In the first place, some
teachers expressed indifference to change or stability; others said they experienced fear
while some participants were contented. Consider for instance these two quotes: “My
feelings are neutral. I am not much excited seeing the change” (T3) and “Sometimes, I feel
frightened,… But I accept it anyway” (T11). There are also individual cases which show
‘contradictory’ feelings towards change. For instance, three participants teaching Grade 12
had conflicting feelings towards change. While they claimed that they welcomed change,
they had not started teaching levels where they had the new curriculum in previous years.
Rather, they kept observing their colleagues’ experiences with change for two years and
waited till it reached Grade 12, till there was no choice but to face change. This shows that
some teachers were contented within the comfort zone of familiarity. Take this teacher, for
instance, who claimed that she welcomed change and notice her expressed contradictory
behaviour:
“I haven’t taught book 10 or 11. I was so lucky not to experience the two other books. It gave me lots of time to see my colleagues … going through the experience… I could say that I was lucky or may be unlucky. I should have taught the three books one after the
129
other. I think if I had taught the first two books, I might have felt more comfortable with the third one…It would have been better if I had gradually followed the books” (T13).
Specifically, participants took a positive stance when they considered that change in
curricula was justified by the fact that the old curriculum was in schools for ten years
without any considerable modifications. As one teacher remarked: “There are factors that
make us accept change especially if there are faults in the old curriculum” (T11). In
addition, they also welcomed curriculum change when they viewed it as learning
opportunities for themselves. According to the same teacher: “Curriculum change is a big
experience, it requires effort from the teacher … when you teach, you learn” (T11). This
finding supports Ganguly’s (2001) assertion that the teacher is more of a co-learner during
curriculum change than a facilitator.
Some participants saw change in curricula as challenge and displayed positive feelings
towards it from this perspective. Consider this statement: “change… is challenging.
Having to deal with a new curriculum means that you do not repeat yourself.” (T9).
Likewise, some participants saw the change in the curriculum as the end to the repetitive
teaching habits: “Change … means breaking the routine of the old curriculum”, as (T7)
admitted.
On the other hand, some participants had incongruous thoughts. While they accepted the
current change, they saw future change as a threat in terms of effort. Thus they considered
further change ‘a big burden’ and ‘tiring’. Several participants declared that the mere
rumour that the curriculum might change again affected their current contribution to the
new curriculum, as they anticipated it would later be a ‘dead curriculum’. As data revealed,
change implied effort and required leaving the comfort zone established with familiarity
130
over time. For instance, two of the participants, (T8) and (T1), admitted that they enjoyed
the familiarity of teaching a textbook for two consecutive years and said that they planned
to teach the same level in the following year. As (T1) remarked:
“I don’t know whether I want to teach another new book next year. May be I won’t…I know this book very well now that it is the second year for me to teach it. I do not need any preparation at home. I can give the lesson without looking at the pages of the book”.
These paradoxical feelings during change are also reported in Lieberman (1997), who
found that teachers experience excitement with one aspect of change but also they are
disturbed by other aspects of the same change.
Another important finding is that teachers tend to have low self-concept (see 3.2.1), and
appear to be powerless when considering their role in the process of curriculum
development. They project an image of themselves as being “at the bottom of the pyramid”
(T1), “out of the circle” (T1), “obedient slave[s]” (T6 & T7), “prisoners of the exam” (T5),
and teachers of the “Holy Book” (T4 & T9). A discussion of these metaphors is drawn
when considering teachers’ roles in developing the curriculum (see 5.2.2.3).
Obviously, the fact that teachers were not included in curriculum development affected
their morale negatively. So, some participants had low self-concept, they felt they were
alienated and unappreciated as in: “I am being faced with so many frustrations…We are not
free to do things the way we would like them to be done” (T2). Their motivation to
contribute to the curriculum waned because of feelings of learned-helplessness and external
locus of control. They saw that their previous contributions to the former curriculum in
terms of feedback were not answered. Therefore, they assumed that if they took the
initiative in expressing their views, they would be rejected: “From my previous experience,
131
I do not think that my views will be taken into consideration seriously” (T9). Teachers
appeared to have external locus of control as they saw that they did not have a hand in the
way they were performing their role: “It is out of our hands” (T9), and “There is a
hierarchy. Everybody is controlling the ones below” (T7). Teachers seemed to devalue their
role in the curriculum in saying: “I am just the teacher…teachers should do whatever they
are asked to do… Teachers are victims” (T1). Dissatisfaction was also voiced: “I am not
happy about my role because I am the obedient slave. I have to do what I am told to do; I
have to do what I am required to do” (T6). There is also a sense of despair and pessimism
as suggested in the declaration: “I don’t think I will play any role in future change…May
be just a passive part…Because we are asked to do things and we do them in the way we
are asked to” (T9).
Al-Araj (1999) found that teachers in the UAE exhibited psychological problems, including
feelings of job insecurity. According to Shatat (1995), until recently, teachers have enjoyed
a high status in the Arab societies. The teacher’s dignity has been declining and this has
resulted in undermining the teachers’ self-concept. White (2001) reports that self-
perceptions of teachers are affected by the criticism of the media. Consequently, they tend
to hold low images of themselves as a result of the undermined status. Feelings of
uncertainty, frustration, anxiety, as well as having internal conflicts are common
discomforts associated with change (Fullan, 1993 & 1999). As Fullan (1999:28) declares:
“the change process is so nerve-wracking”. This is true with regard to the feelings that are
associated with change since they are inevitable. Conversely, feelings associated with
teachers’ perceptions with regard to their contribution to the curriculum are not
unavoidable. These, in my view, could be improved with better teacher involvement in the
process.
132
5.1.3.2 Tacit Resistance to Change
Teachers’ responses to interview questions related to various issues revealed their feelings
towards curriculum change which suggest tacit resistance towards it. This tacit resistance
was embodied in their expressed dissatisfaction with all aspects of the new curriculum
without exception. In general, participants focussed on drawbacks in the materials and
talked extensively about other aspects with scrutiny. In addition, they resorted to traditional
techniques despite the suggested change. Although they had a teacher's book, for instance,
they did not consult it. Further, teachers claimed that they did not know what good teaching
was according to the curriculum. In general, they were mostly critical of every aspect of the
current change.
As I see it, participants’ responses conveyed tacit resistance to change, in that they focussed
on finding faults with the materials more than on the positive aspects. In an earlier finding
(see 5.1.2.3) participants criticised the teacher's book to justify why they resorted to their
old techniques although some of them had not looked at the teaching suggestions at all.
This notion of tacit resistance is also recurrent in the data. For instance, the fact that they
undervalued the improvement in the content of the books also implies resistance to change.
5.1.3.3 Teacher Change Cycle: From Excitement to Frustration to Confidence
A recurring theme in the data is how the feelings of the participants evolved with time. In
this respect, I identified three main phases in the evolution of the teachers’ feelings that
reflected change of perceptions in their receptivity to change.
133
Overall, the feelings towards curriculum change were varied. However, initial feelings were
those of happiness and enjoyment as the participants welcomed change. But they
progressed in dealing with the course materials, the feelings changed. As (T2) remarked:
“When I first got the book, I was very thrilled… to teach the first few lessons…. As the
course proceeded, I discovered that there is too much to be done in a short time. I cannot
cope”. While the initial feelings were positive, the demands of the change in the curriculum
created feelings of discontent, loss, uncertainty and frustration. The second period was
characterised by work pressures and errors in teaching plans that created tension in having
to meet the requirements to cover the syllabus before the end of semester exam. Consider,
for instance the following quote in which the tone of uncertainty is revealed: “Sometimes
texts and questions do not match…There are so many incomplete ones. You as a teacher
have to look, search and give the students feedback. Students are also lost. Search for what,
what is the definite thing that we should search for I do not know” (T2). The participants,
who had experienced change in the past two years, reported that their feelings became
increasingly positive when they started teaching the ‘book’ for the second time. They were
more able to manage their time to cover the syllabus, prepare more supplementary materials
or simply cope with the difficulties by following certain survival strategies.
Ling (2002) also reports similar research findings regarding transformations in teacher
feelings during curriculum change. In her study, teachers’ feelings changed from
frustration during the first phase of curriculum change to confidence when finding
themselves articulate in adaptation. Similarly, Marlow and Minehira (1996) discuss this
emotional development of teachers during curriculum change. They identify four stages
which teachers go through during curriculum change. In the first stage, teachers develop
134
awareness of the change in curriculum. Secondly, their comfort level rises as they
participate in staff development activities or begin to collaborate with colleagues. Thirdly,
they develop an acceptance of the required change and attempt to modify their practice. At
this point, they are in a position to modify aspects of the curriculum. Finally, in stage four,
there is full acceptance as familiarity with the curriculum increases.
Similar findings, albeit concerned with change in assessment in the curriculum are reported
by Burns (1995). She concedes that curriculum change challenges familiar practices but
with the passing of time that brings familiarity, initial concerns are normally dissolved. In
my opinion, the familiarity which came with experience as the time passed was the factor
that helped in reshaping the teachers’ perceptions of the change and contributed to
improving the teachers’ feelings. This could be what happened to the teachers in the study
as their initial perceptions of change in curriculum evolved over time and this change in
perception was reflected in their feelings.
5.2 TEACHERS’ ROLES IN CURRICULUM CHANGE
This section answers the second major research question: How do EL teachers perceive
their role in the process of curriculum change? As I explain below, overall, participants did
not perceive themselves as having any significant role in the curriculum development
processes. The argument in this section revolves around the issue of power and suppressed
teacher voice. Involvement of teachers in curriculum development is argued for too.
135
5.2.1 Teachers’ Roles in Developing the Curriculum
To answer the research question, How do EL teachers perceive their role in developing the
curriculum?, analysis of the data revealed that all the participants perceived that they had
not played any role in the process of curriculum development. Rather, they perceived their
role as mainly to deliver the materials. Curriculum plans, as participants asserted, were not
disclosed to the public, to the extent that the teachers normally left for their annual holiday
without knowing whether there would be a new set of ‘books’ for the following year or
whether the old ‘books’ would stay in use. In response to the interview question on what
teachers knew about the new curriculum plans, some participants explained that the plans
of the MoE were usually unannounced. A teacher reported this by saying: “They say that all
these books will be cancelled and they will use a new series. I do not know when this will
happen, God only knows” (T2). Other participants speculated about some rumours that the
books would change the following year, proving that they were ignorant of the plans. As
(T11) remarked: “Every year we hear rumours. For this year, they say that next year there
will be a general change in the curriculum”. In sum, this finding indicates that teachers
were not informed of any curricular plans and that change is mostly mandated. In the
following sections, there is more evidence that teachers are alienated as I will be
considering needs analysis and curriculum evaluation to see what roles teachers play in
them.
5.2.1.1 Needs analysis: “I wasn’t part of it.”
Needs analysis is an essential component of curriculum development (see Appendix IV-C).
Materials writers have to be familiar with the needs of the learners they are preparing the
materials for, as well as the teachers who are to deal with them (Dubin & Olshtain, 2000).
136
To understand the teachers' roles in curriculum change, I asked the participants specific
questions related to their roles in the process of curriculum development.
In response to the interview question: “What sort of needs analysis was carried out before
preparing the current materials?”, respondents explained that they had never been asked
about the needs of the students. As (T4) remarked: “I haven’t heard about such a thing. I
do not think they make any needs analysis”. Moreover, participants expressed their
concerns with regard to the way needs had been specified in the curriculum, as this was
completely unknown to them. Some of them speculated that curriculum experts might have
depended theoretically on their experience and made up a list of curriculum objectives that
they assumed matched the students’ needs. Other participants assumed that teachers
elsewhere had been consulted but that none of them had been involved. As (T8) asserted:
“May be they consulted the opinion of some teachers, I don’t know but I wasn’t part of it”.
Obviously, the general view was that if anyone had been consulted then it was not them,
‘the teachers’. As (T2) declared: “Maybe they asked supervisors because they are our
channel. When we complain about the books, we normally complain to supervisors.” (see
also 5.2.1.2 below).
As a review of the materials revealed (see Appendix I) the general goals for every level are
listed in the introduction of the teacher's book. Nonetheless, some teachers saw that the
realisation of the goals of the curriculum in the teaching materials did not seem to be clear.
This excerpt summarises the situation:
“When we teach, we don’t see really what they aim at. We don’t know whether they want the students to master English to communicate, or to pass an exam or to know the structures well or to know the functions. We don’t know what they really expect from us to do with that material. We really feel confused. What I mean is that the goals don’t seem to be that clear” (T13).
137
Another comment: “Well, certainly they do not seem to be based on real needs” (T3),
represents a common concern among teachers. Overall, participants agreed that the needs
addressed in the curriculum did not represent actual needs of the students. Some of them
had identified a gap in the teaching materials. According to (T16): “there is… a big gap
between Grade 10 and Grade 9… I do not know how they identify the needs for every
level”. To sum up, participants explained that the goals of the curriculum were not clear
and that needs analysis was not carried out; not only because they were not involved, but
also because the goals did not answer current students’ needs. Brown (1995) explains that
this can be the case in certain circumstances; as despite systematic needs analysis,
theoretical estimation of needs is inevitable. Richards (2003:53) concedes that foreign
language teaching in many countries “is based on what curriculum planners consider best
for students to study at school”. Thus curricula are based on perceived needs and potential
needs which may be unrecognised.
In my view, the UAE is a young country and the attempt to adopt a perceived view of needs
is not a crime. A more systematic investigation of students’ needs, however, might ensure
more satisfactory learning outputs. On the other hand, the curriculum should be interactive
to accommodate the changing language needs of learners (Brown, 1995). While estimation
of needs is not wrong at the beginning, it should not continue to be the rule in which things
are done. Teachers, and students, have to be consulted continuously and their feedback
should inform the statement of objectives according to the expressed needs.
While the general goals are stated in the 1994 Curriculum Document, this document is not
available to the public including teachers. Participants explained that they had never seen
138
the curriculum document and even did not know what a curriculum document was.
Responses like: “The curriculum document? I don’t have any idea about it” (T7), and “I
can’t remember seeing or hearing about anything as such” (T16), were common among the
participants. Some of them were even sarcastic about my question. Consider, for instance
(T2)’s response: “What’s that?... [laughing] another question, please!...Who am I to see
it?”. Only (T1), who had a previous work experience at the Curricula Development Centre,
reported having seen it but admitted that it had not been used as a basis for preparing the
new textbooks by saying: “I doubt whether it has been the basis for any of the books in the
new curriculum” (T1).
Davies (1993) discusses the importance of the curriculum document for teachers but admits
that it is uncommon for them to report that they have seen the curriculum document or its
guidelines. In the case of the 1994 Curriculum Document, the document has not been
formally published. It is true that the general goals for each level are listed in the teacher's
book of that level; still a comprehensive document would be helpful for teachers. Since
schools in the UAE are divided into levels, the fact that teachers do not know what is taught
in the lower educational levels makes their job in understanding the students’ needs
somewhat difficult. The remark: “Who am I to see it?” (T1) conveys a recurrent issue in the
findings that has to do with powerlessness versus authority that seems to be the basis for
most issues related to teachers’ perceptions of curriculum change.
5.2.1.2 Curriculum Evaluation: “If nobody listens, why should we speak?” In response to interview questions related to materials evaluation, all the participants in the
three schools declared that they had not been asked to voice their opinions on the new
139
materials since their introduction in the past two years, and the same thing applied for the
current year. According to participants, they “have never seen any of the curriculum
people…Nobody has ever come to ask …about the curriculum” (T12) and “there is no type
of evaluation” (T9).
The participant who had worked at the Curricula Development Centre confirmed the other
participants’ observation of lack of materials evaluation for the new curriculum: “As for the
books in the secondary stage, nothing is done about them” (T1). In the former curriculum,
however, teachers cited a few incidents where they received feedback forms, as (T3)
remarked: “Not with this book. In the past, they used to send us questionnaires that we had
to fill in. This was all what they did”. In addition, one participant cited her participation in
the former curriculum evaluation project (see 3.3.2.2 a), whereby she was a member of the
group of teachers interviewed. Other than this, all participants agreed that no attempts have
been made to evaluate the new English Language curriculum in the secondary stage.
Nonetheless, participants recalled no real modifications in the textbooks other than
correcting misprints.
Overall, participants agreed that the only channel for conveying feedback to the Curricula
Development Centre was through supervisors. As (T13) remarked: “Whenever we meet
with our supervisors, we draw their attention to the things which we really suffer from”. It
was surprising for me to realise that even supervisors had not formally collected feedback
from teachers, since according to (T10): “You are the first one to ask us about our
opinions”. Nonetheless, one participant stated that supervisors might not be the right people
to talk to. As (T13) realised: “We expressed ourselves but maybe not directly to the people
who are in charge”. To clarify this point, I asked them to explain the type of feedback they
140
had given to their supervisors. It appeared that most feedback was “Just oral feedback”
(T13), and that they “normally write the comments when (they) are asked to” (T10) only.
Consequently, to check for the utilisation of teachers’ feedback in improving the materials
in the past, I asked the participants to talk about the degree of response to written feedback,
in consideration to the forms supplied to them, on the previous curriculum. They replied
with: “the same book without modifications…Even the printing mistakes stay as they are
for several years till they are changed” (T1). The case, as participants conceded, was not
different in the new curriculum either. With regard to on-going modifications, it was clear
from the interview responses that this point was an apparent defect in the curriculum, as
materials were not normally modified save for printing errors.
Seeing that the Curricula Development Centre has not taken any measures for curriculum
evaluation of the new textbooks, as participants reported, I asked them to explain the
reasons for not taking initiative in sending feedback since there had been a general
discontent with the current ‘books’. They explained that they had not taken the initiative
because they feared rejection, and they thought that their opinions would be undervalued.
Consider, for instance (T3)’s argument: “Will they be interested?... If they don’t ask me for
my opinion it means that they are not interested in it”. Other participants also thought that
their feedback was not sought because their opinions were not respected; therefore they had
not taken the initiative to convey their evaluation of the books. Several declarations sum up
the overall perceptions of those participants, such as: “They don’t care for what teachers
say” (T1); “They look at the teacher as someone who is not important” (T4); “It seems that
they do not respect the opinions of teachers” (T3) and “I do not feel that they really
appreciate our views” (T9). In addition, participants lacked initiative because they feared
rejection. As (T8) complained: “Someone must ask me to give my opinion otherwise, who
141
would care for it?” Also they believed that their efforts would be futile, as (T16) declared
“Giving feedback takes time and effort. If nobody wants to listen, why should we speak?”
In addition, teachers did not claim their place in the curriculum by participating in the
evaluation process because they sought to maintain their self–respect, as (T4) remarked:
“We have to wait for them to ask us. If we tell them our opinion without being asked to say
it, they will say it is not our business. They must have the initiative, not us”.
Curriculum theorists agree that periodic evaluation of the components of the curriculum
assists in monitoring the curriculum to overcome any gaps and carry out the necessary
corrections. (e.g. Beattie & Thiessen, 1997; Brown, 1995; Cronbach, 1985; Ganguly 2001;
Popkewitz, 2000; Richards, 2003; Sheldon, 1988; Tribble, 2000). Notwithstanding this,
according to local research findings which back up this finding, Shaw et al (1995) also
assert that empirical evaluation of curriculum is lacking in the UAE. This finding also
confirms Ghareeb’s (1996) finding that evaluation in the UAE is not systematic, and
depends on impressionistic remarks, and that where evaluation forms are used, these are
merely routines. This also confirms my previous research findings (Alwan, 2003b) that
follow-up is lacking in the curriculum, and communication channels for passing feedback
had not been established in public schools. Similar to the case under investigation, where
incidents of feedback questionnaires were cited, teachers singled out printing errors as the
only modifications in the materials.
5.2.2 Teachers’ Roles in Implementing the Curriculum
In answer to the research question: How do EL teachers perceive their role in implementing
the new curriculum? Analysis of the data revealed that teachers perceived their role to be
142
restricted to teaching the materials. They disputed whether their role has changed as a result
of curriculum change or not. They also explained that they had no authority in curriculum
change. On the contrary, they admitted that they would like to claim a more active role in
the curriculum if only they were involved.
5.2.2.1 “I am just the teacher”
Several recurrent remarks from the participants as well as direct responses to the interview
questions revealed the finding that the teachers felt that their only role was to teach what
they were given. This highlighted their perception that they were passive receptors of
change rather than active participants in the process. Remarks like: “I am just the teacher”
(T14, T15 & T5); “A teacher only” (T6); “just… a classroom teacher” (T3); “my role is just
teaching” (T15), and “It is definitely teaching the book” (T13) are indicative of the
teachers’ perceptions of themselves as performing a limited role in curriculum
development. Some teachers indicated that they were satisfied with this role: “I am satisfied
with what I am doing… I like teaching” (T10), and “We as teachers play an important role
in teaching the materials” (T12). On the other hand, several participants were not satisfied
with this role and some felt that they had been excluded from the process of curriculum
change. The following excerpt is an example of this: “I am only teaching the book.
However, I should be playing a more active role. Currently, I don’t feel I am part of the
process. I just have to teach, follow the required procedures” (T11).
More often than not teachers are viewed as technicians who should follow the prescribed
curricula that are usually dependent on tests. The same circumstances apply to the UAE
context, as explained earlier, since the whole curriculum is seen as materials that are to be
143
taught to meet the requirements of the final exam. According to Young (1979), teachers
prefer to carry out their instructional role more than participate in any other aspect of the
educational processes. But I do not think that they would refuse participation in other
processes when they realise that their contribution would benefit their students too. As
Marlow and Minehira (1996) entertain, the perspective which teachers hold of the
curriculum is a ‘micro perspective’. They assert that teachers perceive the curriculum from
the perspective of what they do for learners in the classroom.
As the findings indicate, participants had different perceptions concerning whether their
role has changed with the change in the curriculum. From one perspective, some
participants saw that their role in the new curriculum had changed. In the past, as they
explained, they used to deliver the materials in the same way they were presented in the
textbooks. In the current curriculum, however, they modify the materials according to
students’ needs by preparing worksheets or bringing in their own teaching aids. As they
remarked: “My role has changed” (T12); “The books are completely different and they
require different work” (T10), and “I think that there is a change… There is more challenge
in the new book” (T16). From another perspective, analysis of data strongly suggests that
some participants view their role in the curriculum as stable despite the change. The
following excerpt supports this finding: “It is the same, nothing has changed. I am a
teacher, nothing has changed. Can you change me, give me materials that will. I am doing
the same tasks; I am preparing exams, marking them, teaching students, doing exercises
and giving homework. What has changed? Nothing” (T10).
This view was underpinned by their perception that they considered themselves just
teachers of the materials. The remark: “As a teacher, as someone who is teaching the book,
144
I am the same” (T10), explains why they perceived their role as stable despite the
differences in contributions to the materials.
Although some teachers reported other roles associated with the role of teaching the
materials, the roles did not appear to be new as a result of curriculum change. For instance,
as they came into close contact with their students, teachers felt that their job included other
aspects such as following-up students’ results. As teachers, their role encompassed a broad
spectrum of tasks such as those found in this excerpt:
“As a teacher, I do everything. I am a prompter, I explain the materials, I prepare my own aids. I prepare my OHTs, CDs with PowerPoint presentations. I do everything the curriculum needs. I play the role of an examiner. I have to prepare my own exams, according to the rubrics specified. I am a facilitator, trainer, coach, everything. I have to do everything in class…And outside the classroom…I am responsible for a class. I have to collect all the grades…for all subjects. I have to revise them and prepare report–cards. I have also to supervise outside activities in the school. I participate for celebrations on special occasions. I have a duty once a month to watch the girls at the end of the school day” (T6).
The above roles, however, were not the result of change. They contain the same tasks that
were required of teachers in the former curriculum. This explains why some teachers
viewed their role in the curriculum as stable. Blake et al (1996) also report their findings
that teachers manage to balance various roles inside the school but these roles are
interconnected with their instructional role. In my view, when we consider the teachers’
role from this perspective, it does not seem to change with curriculum change. Al-Sadan
(2000) also found that the role of the teachers in the curriculum in Saudi Arabia is to teach
the prescribed materials without being involved in curriculum development. He concurs
that this is a sign of weakness in the curriculum and calls for active participation of teachers
in the process of curriculum development which according to them leads to better pupil
performance.
145
According to Elliott et al (1999) teachers are more active in teaching and testing roles than
in any other part of the curriculum. However, Brown (1995) argues that most roles that
teachers carry out are self–imposed ones. A crucial finding here is that all but one
respondent seemed to underestimate their roles. This indicates that many teachers had low
self-concept (see 5.1.3.1).
Roelofs and Terwel (1999) report research findings that teachers’ roles change during
curriculum change due to the change in demands. Conversely, Karavas-Doukas (1998)
reports that teachers view stability in their role in spite of curriculum change. Similarly, in
the current study, the role of teachers had not changed with the change in curriculum.
Seeing it from the broad perspective of the process of curriculum development, the role of
the teachers remained as the end receptors of the product.
5.2.2.3 Teachers’ Perceptions of their Roles in Curriculum Development: Implications
of Teacher Metaphors
When considering their role in the curriculum, all the teachers in this study felt isolated,
neglected and undervalued. As a result, this affected their self–concept (see section 5.1.3).
Realising that their major contribution to curriculum development was limited to teaching
the materials, which they considered a peripheral role, they undervalued their role in the
process. Consequently, the metaphors that they used to describe their role in the curriculum
echoed the above issues.
146
Bowers (1992:31) defines metaphors as: “shared perceptions, captured in language through
allegory and illusion, simile and cliché”. As Inbar (in Ben–Peretz et al, 2003:279)
concedes, “metaphors rest on the mental process of selection and emphasis”, meaning that
teachers’ metaphors are expressions of teachers’ perceptions that teachers unconsciously
emphasise. Whether these images are truly representative of other teachers’ views in the
context of the study rather than personal ones needs to be investigated. However, the
literature on teacher metaphors emphasises the proposition that metaphors that teachers use
reflect their perceptions (e.g. Reagan & Osborn, 2002; Sugrue, 1997; Von Wright, 1997).
In one statement, a teacher projected her perception of her place in relation to her role in
curriculum development that came as part of the current change in curriculum. By saying:
“Where do I see myself? Out of the circle! Where am I?...If it were a pyramid, I am in the
very very far bottom”, (T2) conveyed her feelings of powerlessness, inferiority and
isolation. In essence, the metaphor is reflective of four aspects of the teacher’s perception
of her place in curriculum change: control, hierarchy, exclusion and low self–concept. As
shall be seen later, teachers reason that they have no significant role to play in curriculum
development other than teaching the prescribed materials (see 5.2.2.1).
Another metaphor about the teacher’s role is that of a teacher of the ‘Holy Book’, which
was cited by two participants. Consider these excerpts from interviews: “Well, I think we
should not deal with the book as the ‘Holy Book’ that cannot be changed” (T9); and “We
just teach the ‘Holy Book’” (T4). The concept of the ‘Holy Book’ in the Muslim culture
refers to the ‘Quran’. To use the label to refer to a school textbook, even mockingly, is
reflective of the view that the ‘book’ is the centre point of the curriculum and that the
teachers’ role is to deliver the content of the book and not to change anything in it.
147
Another metaphor that raises the issue of powerlessness and inferiority is that of two
teachers describing their roles in the process of curriculum development as that of the
obedient slaves as in the following excerpts: “For now, I am the obedient slave... an
obedient slave who does what his master instructs him to do” (T7); and “I am an obedient
slave. I have to do what I am told to do; I have to do what I am required to do” (T6). This
metaphor connotes inferiority and low self-concept as well as the passivity of the teachers’
position as mere receptors of change.
Further, there is a striking metaphor of a participant seeing teachers as prisoners of the
exam in the following excerpt: “And also we are prisoners of the exam format. How can we
change the topic for the composition? Suppose it appears on the exam. We are prisoners,
we cannot change anything” (T5). This metaphor too brings up the issue of powerlessness
when considering the teachers’ roles in curriculum change and is expressive of teachers’
feelings of helplessness.
Finally, the metaphor of the curriculum developers sitting in an ivory tower, which was
given by one of the participants depicts the perception that teachers constantly emphasised
throughout the interviews, that they were alienated: “Those who are responsible for
curriculum, they are in their ivory tower away, far away from the field” (T2). In my view,
involving teachers in curriculum processes may help overcome this problem of inferiority
and powerlessness, and improve their contribution. This argument is also pursued in the
proceeding section.
148
5.2.2.4 Authority in Curriculum Change
Deducing that the participants had an external sense of agency, that they perceived that
their contribution to curriculum was controlled by forces outside themselves (Williams &
Burden, 2000), I pursued the topic further and asked them in the subsequent interviews
whose authority they thought curriculum change was. Several participants had no idea who
had the authority but they all agreed that they did not have it. Some of them thought that the
authority lay within the hands of their superiors: curriculum developers in the MoE, the
senior supervisor and their supervisors. Apparently, there should be a close relationship
between curriculum developers and teachers and the communication gap between the two
parties needs to be bridged (Brown, 1995; Jackson, 1980).
Participants, who held a view of the supervisors as having authority in curriculum change,
explained how they used them as their prime channel for conveying curriculum feedback.
In reality, however, the status of the supervisors is not better than teachers in this regard
(Alwan, 2000; Ghareeb, 1996). According to the participant who had a previous work
experience at the Curricula Development Centre: “The Minister himself should issue the
decree to change. Even the members of the Curriculum Centre couldn’t modify a book
without a ministerial decree. At least this is what they told me when I was there” (T1). Why
teachers considered supervisors as having the authority can be explained by the hierarchical
perception of the authoritative role of the supervisor. In summary, teachers thought highly
of their supervisors. There are various reasons for this; the major one is that they are
responsible for teacher appraisal. This might also be the reason why they did not complain
when they received no training from their supervisors. However, there is a need to
149
investigate the teachers’ perceptions of their supervisors as mediators in the process of
curriculum development.
Al-Sadan (2000) asserts that curriculum development in most Arab countries is centralised
with no flexibility for teachers to participate in the various processes of curriculum
development. Overall, researchers are against centralisation of curriculum decision-making
(e.g. Fullan, 1993 & 1999; Golby, 1985; Harris, 2001; Spikes, 1992). According to Spikes
(1992), imposed curriculum change is a reality in many countries all over the world too.
Harris (2001) warns that this has negative consequences on teachers since they tend to be
blamed when the outcomes of change do not meet expectations of curriculum planners.
Along the same line of the argument, Head and Taylor (1997:121) contend that “teachers
sometimes find themselves responsible for the outcome of a situation, but without the
power to influence it”.
To sum up, when considering the authority for curriculum change, teachers perceived their
supervisors as authoritative figures. Their responses in the interviews implied that they did
not think of themselves as having any form of authority. This signifies the issue of
powerlessness during top-down curriculum change. This is similar to Hadley’s (1999) and
Barrow’s (1984) findings that teachers are normally placed at the bottom level of the
hierarchy in curriculum change. Gibbs et al (1999) recognise that teachers are aware of this
hierarchy. I see that teachers in this study had been aware of this hierarchy too but appeared
to be powerless and frustrated. They had been aware of the hierarchy in decision-making
which places them at the bottom of the scale. Harris (2001) explains that mandated change
implies bureaucracy and hierarchical ranks, and contends that teachers lose control over
what to be taught when they have mandated curriculum. White (2001) reports that teachers
150
are aware that they have a ‘low professional status’; they feel that they are not respected
and believe that their views are not appreciated. This status causes “low morale amongst
the teaching profession” (White, 2001:85). Apple (1997) recommends a power shift so that
the power goes to teachers. He concedes that those involved are not the reason for this
hierarchy. The hierarchy, as he concedes, is simply the result of the system of
bureaucratisation and the teachers’ reaction to the system which leads to this hierarchy. In
consequence, Webb (2002) and Holt (1986) recommend that teacher education should show
teachers that they have rightful power that they should exercise in the process of curriculum
change. Similarly, Radnor et al (1995) call for empowering teachers to claim their voice at
least by rejecting that which they think is not right. Waters and Vilches (2001) posit that
ownership is an essential element in accepting change. Therefore, teachers’ participation in
curriculum development enforces ownership and facilitates acceptance in the form of
implementation. In the same vein, Allfrey (1990) recommends that teachers contribute to
curriculum planning from the beginning. White (2001) contends that teachers have a moral
right to be consulted in curriculum matters and Alexander et al (1997) propose that
involving teachers in the curriculum development leads to professional renewal.
While teachers in the UAE do not tend to exercise power even in areas were they are highly
dissatisfied (Alwan, 2003a & b), several studies (e.g. Osborn et al, 1997; Radnor et al,
1995) report that teachers rebel against innovations in aspects of the curriculum when they
are unable to “accommodate the expected practice into their beliefs and the values they held
about pedagogical practice and the nature of the knowledge that should constitute the
English curriculum” (Radnor et al, 1995:335). Radnor et al (1995) encourage teachers to
feel empowered to claim their voice in educational matters that they perceive in need of
change. They posit that teachers themselves need to claim their power and the government
151
should listen to professionals in matters of educational concern. Similarly, Ganguly (2001)
recommends a change of policy in Arab Gulf States to involve teachers in the process of
curriculum change.
On the other hand, the contextual factors have to be considered in examining this
perception. The work context does not allow for teachers’ voices to effect change in any
way (also Suliman, 2000). While the majority of the teachers are expatriates who conceive
of themselves as temporary employees– and it is may be understandable why they do not
claim their voice– the national Emirati teachers do not seek to claim their voice either. It is
obvious that the hierarchical perception dominates in this context.
5.2.2.5 Teachers’ Voice in Curriculum Change: Retrospective and prospective
The findings indicate absence of coordination between curriculum experts and classroom
teachers. Due to their past experiences in this matter, participants had low expectations of
involvement in future curriculum projects as they perceived that they had been alienated. In
response to the question: "In case there were any plans, to what extent do you think you
will have a role in them?” they were sceptical and ruled out any future involvement.
Understandably, some teachers were sarcastic about their current role in the curriculum
development process as mere teachers of the textbooks (see 5.2.2.1). An important finding
at this point is that the participants construed the fact that they were not asked for feedback
as distrust in them. As one participant remarked: “May be they do not trust teachers” (T16).
152
Not all the participants were dissatisfied with this hierarchical status in terms of decision-
making in curriculum development. However, some participants were aware that they
should take action with regard to participation in other curriculum processes. As one
teacher remarked, “To be honest, we should work harder. We have to talk to the people
who are in charge” (T3). Several participants expressed awareness that they should have a
voice in the matter. In response to the question: “Who should have the authority to ask for
change?” they responded with: “The teachers are the only people who deal with the
curriculum and they know about its problems and the students’ needs. Teachers always
look for the better, so they should be entitled to ask for change in the curriculum” (T6); and
“The teachers should have the power to call for change. The people in the Ministry should
listen to them. Teachers deal with the books in the classroom. They know the students, they
cover the books, they know the problems that these books have inside the classroom”
(T15). Although they viewed teaching as their main role, many participants have voiced
their wishes to be involved in various curriculum processes. The above excerpts from
interviews show that teachers are critically aware of what their roles should be.
The reason why the curriculum experts had not contacted teachers remains a mystery.
However, according to the participant who had a previous work experience at the Curricula
Development Centre, the curriculum experts are busy with their workloads since they are
not only responsible for developing the public schools curriculum but also they are in
charge of investigating commercial teaching materials used by hundreds of private schools
throughout the country.
Although Rassekh (2001) refers to UAE report on a regional conference on curriculum
change which claims that the MoE values the role of teachers in improving the education
153
process, no proofs have been provided to support these claims. On the other hand, the local
literature calls for giving better roles for teachers in the UAE who project their demands of
getting involved actively in decision-making processes (Altraifi, 1999). Being mere
transmitters of the content of the books should not be the role that the teachers are in charge
of. Teachers can participate in other curriculum processes. While currently they find very
limited freedom in adopting the materials, they should neither be restricted by the current
intensive content nor the time demands. In addition, they should be involved in other
curriculum development processes as well. For instance, they should be surveyed
continuously to check the suitability of the current aims of the curriculum to students’
needs and adjust the textbooks accordingly. Further, if piloting materials is not feasible, the
manuscripts can be checked by panels of teachers to check their suitability. I would argue
that the effectiveness of the teaching material does not become clear till its implementation.
Therefore, further feedback should be collected and amendments to the materials have to be
carried out regularly.
One aspect that is helpful in facilitating acceptance of change is to make the local
community aware of any anticipated change plans (Fullan, 2001 a & b; Barrow, 1984). This
explains why teachers in this context had their problems in accepting the change easily
since they had not been aware of upcoming change. As Burns (1995) contends the voice of
people concerned with curriculum change should have the high priority. She argues that
teachers’ views should be explored and they should be assisted to cope with any problems
which arise during implementation. Brown (1995) also argues for the importance of
involving teachers in materials selection to win their acceptance in spite of its faults: “If all
teachers are involved in the decisions about which materials to select...they will probably
154
be much more willing to use the chosen material, even if they did not fully agree that the
selected materials were the best of all possibilities” (Brown, 1995:162-163). A similar
view is given by Collins and Waugh (1998) who posit that the higher the level of
participation in the change process the more receptive the teachers are. However, I do not
agree with this view in involving teachers as a means to gain their silence for administrative
gains. Involving teachers emerges from my conviction that their views and feedback on the
curriculum are based on solid grounds of experience. Barrow (1984) concedes that
involving teachers in curriculum development should be based on the fact that they are
change agents and are qualified to do so rather than to buy their silence. Harris (2001)
condemns some curriculum authorities which tend to create a façade of representative
teacher participation, while in reality participation is minimal. She explains that
marginalisation of teachers in the process of curriculum change leads to low morale as well
as feelings of dissatisfaction.
5.3 TRAINING AND SUPPORT DURING CURRICULUM CHANGE
This section attempts to answer the third major research question: How do EL teachers
perceive their training in implementing the new curriculum? As I mention below, overall,
the participants expressed their dissatisfaction due to the lack of training. They declared
that the current training provision was lacking in terms of orienting them with the new
teaching materials and other aspects of the new curriculum. Absence of on-going support
was also found to be another problem. While there is shortage in what they are provided
with, teachers continue to work to the best of their abilities depending on their own funds
due to the deficiencies in curriculum resources and their own initiatives in terms of
155
professional development. The issue why teachers had not complained about this
inefficiency in the provision of training and curricular support is discussed in this section.
5.3.1 Teachers’ Perceptions of Curriculum Support: “I call it lack of support”
In answer of the question: How do EL teachers perceive support during curriculum change?
Analysis of the data revealed that all the participants complained that there was no practical
support in the curriculum. However, they continued to do their work diligently depending
on their own funds.
The literature considers curricular support as an essential aspect of curriculum change. (e.g.
Ganguly, 2001; Hopkins & Reynolds, 2001; Markee, 1997; Marlow& Minehira, 1996;
Seller, 2001; Short et al 1994; Smith 1990 & 1991). However, the findings of this study
indicate that curricular support was lacking. In general, participants agreed that curricular
and administrative support with regard to the curriculum was inefficient: financially,
technically and pedagogically.
With regard to lack of finances and the teachers’ initiative in self–funding for the
curriculum requirements, I found the case to be the same in the three schools. This meant
they could not adapt the materials unless they depended on their own resources. They
complained that the basic resources were missing and that they compensated for this by
paying from their own pockets. As one participant remarked, “There are no facilities. In
this school, you have to pay for the copies that you make. We do it on our own expenses
outside the school” (T9). Where there are available resources, teachers had to pay for the
service, as appears in the remarks: “We pay them to have our worksheets and exams
156
copied” (T4) and “In the school... we pay for photocopying” (T1). So, technically,
photocopying was not available unless in some cases for exams where teachers had to type
them at home since no computers were available for their use. An exception in one of the
schools is the availability of a computer with data show equipment that had recently been
purchased using funds raised by the school for this purpose. On the other hand, in another
school, there was a computer room used as a resource centre but teachers were not allowed
into it for fear of causing technical faults, and teachers in this school depended on preparing
their materials at home.
Lack of resources in UAE schools has been admitted by the Curricula Development Centre
in its report to a regional conference. Such constraints include: “The inadequate availability
of instructional resources (textbooks, teachers’ guides, maps, wall charts, audio-visual
materials, computer based materials) is considered as the main bottleneck” (Rassekh &
Thomas, 2001:89). In gross contrast to this confession, the report mentions some sixty-nine
existing language laboratories in UAE schools. While there has been one in one of the
schools in this study, which has been there since the 1970s, the equipment was found to be
faulty, and the laboratory had been not in use for years.
As for school libraries, participants agreed that they were under-resourced, thus also
confirming Altraifi’s (1999) findings about the status of teachers in the UAE. According to
her:
“[I]n addition to fulfilling their statutory requirements, teachers are expected by administrators to prepare teaching materials to help and support (their) lessons…The ministry of education does not provide specific funds for materials such as posters, illustrations, models….for which individual schools must take responsibility…This has led to their wide spread of provision by teachers using their own money” (Altraifi, 1999:106).
157
As to why teachers resorted to this can be understood through participants’ perceptions that
their performance would be weak without supplementing the materials. As teachers
remarked, “If I don’t have the facilities I need how can I be effective?” (T1) and “How do
they expect us to do our job well if the basics are missing?” (T9). This is also in accordance
with Altraif’s findings that teachers perceived the lack of teaching aids as a sign of weak
teacher performance. She recommends proper funds given to schools to alleviate the
teachers’ efforts in trying to maintain a good standard of performance.
Similar conditions have also been reported in other Arab countries. For instance, Gahin and
Myhill (2001) found that in Egypt, the government schools lacked resources and that
teachers had to seek them outside the schools which they perceived was expensive for
them. Blake et al (1996) also report their findings of little concrete support for the teachers
in their study.
Waters and Vilches (2001) recommend monitoring and supporting teachers during
innovations so that they are given ‘trouble-shooting’ help. With regard to this type of
support, the participants admitted that it was lacking. Teachers had nobody else to depend
on when problems occur in the curriculum except supervisors who were neither available
nor qualified to deal with curricular issues as they lacked the knowledge of the curriculum
(Ghareeb, 1996). Thus pedagogical support was also limited to the supervisor’s availability,
and teachers had to depend on themselves to solve their problems. Overall, participants
voiced their dissatisfaction with regard to the quality of support they were having. They
158
asserted that in saying: “Support? It is not really support” (T13); “I call it lack of support”
(T9) and “It’s very weak” (T10).
Holt (1986) criticises the limited role of the curriculum advisors or inspectors. He explains
that they are detached from the field and if they do visit schools then there are time
restrictions to what they are able to offer. They have a conflicting role of providing
assistance in curriculum matters as well as evaluation. The same applies to the context of
the U.A.E. (Alwan, 2000; Ghareeb, 1996; Suliman, 2000).
Richards (2003) discusses the parallel relationship between quality teaching and support.
Similarly, Graves (2003) advises that in order to ensure implementation, things which
teachers identify as restrictions that cannot be changed need to be recognised; such as
absence of resources and student motivation. However, she and Elliott (1994) observe that
lack of resources may seem a constraint to some teachers but it may encourage other
teachers to be creative in utilising the available ones. Likewise, Richards (2003) concedes
that deficiencies in the materials or the resources are not an issue if we have good teachers.
As for the teachers in this study, participants did their best to make up for the lack of
support. They had become creative in dealing with ‘the book’ in their own ways in terms of
teaching aids and devising tasks. Furthermore, it is clear from the interviews that the
absence of curricular support made room for more cooperation among teachers. They
mentioned this by saying: “We shared ideas with teachers…. We exchanged teaching aids
such as worksheets. Even we exchanged PowerPoint lessons” (T16); and “In fact, I
cooperate with my colleagues here….We cooperate with teachers in other schools” (T8).
Ghareeb (1996) also reports teachers networking together to make up for inadequate
159
support; and Wright (1981) stresses support in curriculum through cooperation among
peers.
By commending teachers’ initiatives, I am not saying that I approve of the current status of
curricular support. On the contrary, I would argue that teachers’ initiatives in compensating
for lack of support may not imply only dedication to their profession as it can also be
construed in other ways. First, I would like to discuss why teachers had not complained to
the MoE given the many drawbacks in support and training. As for the participants, their
responses conveyed ‘learned-helplessness’ and the moral issue of preserving dignity. As
one participant remarked, “This is lack of support. But we cannot complain…There is no
use in complaining, nobody would listen. They would think that we do not want to work.
We prefer to be silent” (T1). According to them, any complaint may be construed as
inefficiency on the part of the teachers. This is the same reason expressed in a similar case
in Allfrey (1990).
As the local literature reveals (e.g. Altraifi, 1999; Hokal & Shaw, 1999) curriculum
resources have always been underprovided in UAE schools. On the other hand, evaluation
of teachers included the use of teaching aids as one of the criterion for effectiveness.
According to Richards (2003), to achieve quality in teaching it is necessary to generate
work environments which support teachers, and teachers should not be left to worry about
lack of resources. When teachers do other chores than teaching then this is at the cost of
their instructional duties (Brown, 1995; Richards, 2003). I agree with this view point and
add that in cases where schools are under-funded, the act of teachers’ paying for expenses
of teaching should not be taken for granted and made to pass unrecognised. While charity is
a valued act in the Muslim society and some teachers may volunteer to ‘donate’ to the
160
schools in concern for the welfare of their students, I do not think that all teachers are
driven by this noble cause although others may be. As I argued earlier, the absence of
certain teaching materials is considered a deficiency in the teachers’ performance (also
Altraifi, 1999). Within the current teacher evaluation system, the motives which drive
teachers may be the sustenance of their own welfare to secure renewal of their contracts.
Supervisors may be impressed by this humanitarian act, as who would undervalue someone
who cares enough to put professional needs over personal ones? Such acts, I think, should
be discouraged as they may interfere with the validity of the appraisal report. The only way
to discourage it would be to ensure that schools are well-funded. In cases where there is
shortage in funds, the evaluation of teachers should not include the use of teaching
materials save for those which are available to teachers. The question why teachers do not
complain may also be linked to the same issue of job security. To make my point clear, I
would like to refer to the fact that supervisors are in charge of teacher appraisal and
teachers may not complain about training since supervisors are responsible for it (Ghareeb,
1996). Therefore, complaints may threaten job security. On the other hand, since there are
no communication channels established with schools, (Alwan, 2003b), teachers’ feedback
about any issue could not be revealed without consulting supervisors, which is again a
threat to job security.
5.3.2 Teachers’ Perceptions of Training
To answer the research question: How do EL teachers perceive their training during
curriculum change? I prompted the participants to relate to this aspect in the curriculum and
how they felt about it. In response to the interview question on what training had been
received for teaching the materials, many participants responded with remarks that asserted
161
that they had not received any form of training. For example, they said: “There are no
training courses” (T13) and “We didn’t have any training” (T2). There was an exception in
two schools where teachers of Grade 10 had had a seminar to orient them with the new
curriculum materials. This is clear in this assertion: “My colleagues had training for the
first secondary on its first year, but there was nothing for the second secondary last year
and for the third secondary this year” (T14).
Another participant explained that even if there was any training for Grade 10, teachers
who taught ‘the book’ for the first time in the subsequent years, received no training at all:
“Usually there is no training except on the first year in which the book is introduced.
Anyway, even in the previous year [Grade 11] there was no training on the book. Even this
year for the third secondary, they didn’t have any training” (T7). At the level of the MoE,
the participant who had had previous work experience at the Curricula Development Centre
explained that curriculum leaders adopted cascade training. She said: “Central training was
carried out for supervisors but not for teachers. Supervisors are expected to carry out a
training course for the teachers in the zone” (T1). One participant explained that this lack of
training for two years had been a specific problem in the zone and that ‘some’ teachers in
other zones had orientation meetings for materials of grade 11 and 12. As one participant
explained: “In some zones they had meetings, at least they gave them an idea about it…We
need guidance … to show us how to deal with the materials” (T5).
Obviously, the findings indicate lack of training and this is not something to be considered
as merely a passing remark when talking about curriculum change. The literature considers
effective change synonymous with systematic teacher education (Fullan, 1993; Karavas-
Doukas 1998). Thus teacher training has a reciprocal effect on curriculum development as
162
each contributes to the other (Nunan, 1988). Unfortunately, several studies found that
training in the UAE is occasional and lacks efficiency (Al-Araj, 1999; Al Mansouri, 2001;
Al-Nayadi, 1989; Alraway, 1988; Alwan 2000 & 2001; Ghareeb, 1996). This may have
lead Shaw et al (1995) to attribute the traditional methods in teaching to the ineffective
training that teachers get. Hence they declare that the system is greatly in need of quality
teacher training programmes. Ghareeb (1996) also found that teachers wanted more
practical training. The courses which are provided do not fulfil the real needs of the
teachers. In addition, she found that evaluation of training was lacking. Altraifi (1999)
recommends holding practical training for teachers which involves actual practice on how
to teach the materials at hand rather than theoretical training, as is the case in the UAE
where training is offered.
The above findings will be discussed here from two perspectives. First, I shall deal with
them from the psychological effect of lack of training. Second, I shall discuss cascade
training and its negative effect during curricular change. In the first place, when I asked the
participants how they felt about the fact that they were not trained, they explained that it
was ‘frustrating’ for them to begin the new year with the ‘surprise’ that the curriculum has
been changed without giving them the materials in advance to review, and that they were
required to teach them from the first day of school; the same thing happened throughout the
three years of change. As one participant remarked, “We feel surprised with the materials
just as the students. Imagine starting with the students in the same condition that everything
is new to you, it is very difficult. It leads to depression. It affects the readiness for the
school year” (T14). According to McGrail (2005), lack of training during curriculum
change causes teachers to feel less qualified, which is what is implied in this remark.
163
Some participants said they were indifferent to training, some of them were confident that
their experiences were assets to them, while others were critical of the fact that exams
remained the same and declared that there was no need for training. Remarks like:
“Teachers complain, [but] they can cope anyway. They are experienced” (T1); and “I can
manage. I have experience. There is no problem” (T15) suggest that teachers with more
experience may be able to cope without training. Jacob and Frid (1997:10) found that
during the absence of training the more experienced the participants the better they were
able to cope “as they felt competent to use their own initiative to make any adjustments
they felt would be advantageous for their students”. I am not suggesting that training be
dismissed but I am trying to highlight some of the reasons why the curriculum has survived
in spite of lack of training. It could be because the teachers, being at secondary school
level, have had enough experience to enable them to cope during difficulties.
Conversely, the majority of the teachers in this study regretted that they had not been
trained. As the review of the teaching materials revealed, the new curriculum, although
eclectic in nature, required a task-based approach which teachers had not been familiar with
and had not been formally trained on how to carry out. McGrail (2005) and Dreyfus and
Mazouz (1989) posit that when teachers call for training, they seem to express a need that
should be met. Similarly, I think that teachers are calling for training because they had
sensed the difficulty in sustaining the new practice. In my view, they might not have
resorted to traditional teaching techniques if they had been trained on the new method, and
of course if the intensity of materials and the nature of exams were reconsidered.
164
As I concluded earlier, change had several psychological effects on the teachers. With the
absence of training, there was a sense of loss as expressed by the metaphor of a participant
describing herself without training during curriculum change. According to her, she saw
herself: “Like a leaf in the wind…I am left to drift with the current of the wind. I am left
without guidance to know where I am going” (T3). This loss is expressed also directly by
other teachers by saying: “I am lost. I need someone to tell me what to do with the
materials” (T5). Another point is the perceived external sense of agency when teachers saw
themselves controlled by others: “I feel bad, really. I blame them because they are guilty
for this mess that we have now” (T8). In conclusion, curriculum change without training
had negative effects on teachers’ perceptions of themselves as qualified professionals.
Gahin and Myhill (2001) observe that normally more attention is paid to the development
of materials than to training of teachers on how to deal with them. Jacob and Frid (1997)
explain that curriculum change, whether affecting teaching materials or teaching methods
create a need among the majority of teachers for assistance. They consider continuing
professional development as a factor which contributes to effective change. Training
installs feelings of confidence among teachers that they are carrying their job in a highly
professional way.
The MoE adopts cascade training as the findings revealed in this study (also Alwan, 2000;
Ghareeb, 1996). Al-Nayadi (1989:5) sums up the situation in the UAE which still reflects
the status quo: "standards of teacher training are absurdly and disgracefully low”. This is in
accordance with Hayes’s (2000) findings. Hayes defines cascade training as: “A strategy
often adopted for introducing major innovations into educational systems in the ‘cascade’
model, in which training is conducted at several levels by trainers drawn from the level
above” (Hayes, 2000:137). He found that this strategy is a regular practice in ministries of
165
education all over the world. However, studies show that the training that reaches the
teachers is far less than expected, while curricular change depends for its success on actual
practices in the classroom. He observes that although this strategy is cost-effective, it
causes “dilution of the training” (Hayes, 2000:138) since the farther down the level, the less
that reaches teachers who are normally down the cascade. He also explains that the faults
lie in the implementation of the cascade and recommends that experiential and reflective
modes of training be used to maintain the success of the cascade training.
Participants had no training with two sets of materials (Grades 11 and 12) in all three
schools and with Grade 10 also in one of the schools. Bearing in mind that cascade training
is carried out with every new set of materials, I think that supervisors have neglected this
part of their job for reasons that cannot be identified in the current study. The main reason
in my opinion, however, is lack of follow–up from the MoE. This, as well as potential
logistic problems such as funding and finding a training venue and suitable time within the
working hours (Alwan, 2000; Ghareeb, 1996), might have caused some supervisors to
overlook their duties in implementing the training. Richards (2003:105) recommends “on-
going feedback on the trainers’ performance through workshops and visits” to ensure that
training is carried out, and that trainers use appropriate training modes. As Suliman (2000)
observes, the MoE in the UAE claims that there is on–going training for all teachers and
supervisors but the reality is that training is a rare occurrence (also Alwan, 2000; Ghareeb,
1996). This finding, however, is not exclusive to the context of the UAE, as other writers
reported a similar problem elsewhere in the world (e.g. Gahin & Myhill, 2001; Hedgcock,
2002).
166
5.3.3. Self–development Activities
In this section, I report findings related to the research question: What forms of professional
development do teachers engage in in relation to curriculum change? The findings indicate
that this aspect is positive, unlike the other aspects discussed throughout the chapter. As a
matter of fact, I think that the deficiencies in training and curricular support, as well as the
obstacles encountered by teachers in the new curriculum lead them to be more active in
seeking professional development than the local research before the time of change
revealed (Alwan, 2000).
Fullan and Hargreaves (1992) argue that successful implementation of innovation lies in
teacher development. Professional development includes training but it also includes self-
directed learning. It is evident in the interview responses that the absence of training had
ignited the awareness of the need for self–development and teachers, as a result, attended
conferences and training activities organised by higher educational institutions and TESOL
Arabia – an international organisation for teachers of English to speakers of other
languages which is based in the UAE. In addition, some teachers carried out peer-
observation and staff-presentations.
An overall positive effect of self–development activities was the main finding here.
Remarks like: “It motivates me too. It makes me feel that I am doing something
worthwhile” (T9); “It changes the way I teach. I also use varied teaching aids as a result”
(T16) and “If you develop yourself, you can embrace all students” (T7), highlight the
positive outcome of self-directed teacher development. Another instance is the benefit that
teachers gained from attending conferences in that they had practically improved their
167
performance. As a participant admitted: “I apply everything I read about or I attend... this
helps in improving the quality of learning that my students have” (T6). Equally, some
teachers also commended staff presentations for their contribution to the curriculum: “I
gain so much. Staff presentations are useful in terms of learning about new aspects of
teaching and new teaching techniques. It also affects students’ motivation” (T11).
Similarly, some teachers felt themselves resourceful as a result of searching the internet.
Marlow and Minehira (1996) also report that confidence increases with development. To
quote Rowe and Sykes (1989:129) who report similar findings: “there were strong, positive
effects of professional development on teachers’ professional self perceptions, and
particularly those concerned with indicators of energy, enthusiasm, and satisfaction”.
According to Thomas (2003), these teacher initiatives in seeking development are a sign of
professionalism. Nunan (1988) posits that effective teacher development is a major factor
in contributing to curriculum development. Similarly, Elliott (1994) argues for the
importance of the teachers’ roles in curriculum development provided that they become
researchers of their practice. While researching practice is an effective development tool, I
found that it is not a familiar practise in the context of the study (also Alwan, 2000). It is
worth mentioning that none of the teachers cited research as a means of self–development;
a finding that calls for further investigations.
It is worth mentioning too that most of the self-development activities mentioned above
were related to the curriculum. For instance, peer-observation was mainly related to how
teachers delivered the teaching materials, and staff presentations dealt with how to be
innovative when delivering the curriculum as well as other educational issues. Most of the
participants reported that when going to conferences, they opted for sessions that
demonstrated teaching techniques.
168
This chapter has presented the findings of the study and discussed them in the light of the
literature reviewed. In Chapter 6, I shall summarise them, explain their implications and
suggest areas for further research.
169
CHAPTER VI
RECOMMENDATIONS
INTRODUCTION
Given the limitations of the study identified earlier (see 4.10) the findings of this
investigation are exclusive to the sample studied. However, when considering the
procedures taken to ensure trustworthiness, external transferability to similar settings at
least within the context of the UAE is not ruled out. The reader, who is familiar with the
context of the UAE, is more likely to recognise the transferability of the findings to other
homologous local institutions than someone who is not. In this Chapter, I shall summarise
the findings, point out their implications in the local context, and suggest topics for future
research within the same issues of concern.
6.1 Phases of Change
Analysis of the teachers’ responses indicates that during change, some teachers passed
through three affective stages from excitement through frustration to confidence. During the
first phase, the initial feelings that they had at the time when curriculum change was first
introduced were positive, and they were generally satisfied with their work. This indicated
that they had high self-concept and felt motivated. During the second phase, the demands of
170
the change in the curriculum created feelings of discontent, loss and frustration. In the third
phase, the teachers’ feelings became more positive; they were confident and more able to
manage their time to cover the syllabus, prepare more supplementary materials or simply
cope with the difficulties by following certain strategies. While teaching the materials in
subsequent years, teachers became more comfortable and regained their high self-concept
with regard to trusting their repertoire of knowledge gained through experience (see
5.1.3.3).
The implication of this finding is that change managers need to take affective issues into
consideration when planning for curriculum change. While teacher involvement in change
processes helps in relieving the stressful effects of change, hard feelings during change are
inevitable (Fullan, 1993, 1999; 2001a & 2001b). Training and support should be of great
help in reducing the stressful effects of change during implementation. As teachers achieve
a level of comfort, encouraging them to network with others and seek professional
development may help enhance their confidence (Marlow & Minehira, 1996).
The hypothesis raised by this finding is that a teacher responds to change at its various
stages differently and passes through the change cycle which marks out the change in
feelings that reflect changes in perceptions. Further investigations are recommended to
verify this proposition. The inquiry needs to consider teachers’ perceptions from a
longitudinal perspective. As a means of data collection, teacher journals would be more
revealing in terms of daily reactions to daily conflicts encountered during curriculum
change, although they would be new to this context.
171
6.2 Affective Issues during Curriculum Change
Teachers in this study had conflicting feelings towards curriculum change. On one hand,
they had positive attitudes, and on the other hand, they displayed, albeit unconsciously,
resistance to it and feared future change. In some respects, they took a positive stance
towards change for various reasons. First, they felt that change was justified as the previous
materials had been in circulation for a decade without significant modifications to meet the
changing needs of the students. Second, they believed that change provided them with
learning opportunities as they needed to broaden their knowledge by searching for extra
information when the topics dealt with in the materials required that. Third, some of them
perceived change as a challenge and enjoyed the process of finding their ways through
times of hardship. Last, they also perceived curriculum change as a break in the routine in
their ways of teaching. As a result, they commended change from these perspectives.
Nonetheless, they also held an antagonistic stance against change. From one perspective,
their responses carried tacit resistance to change, and from another, they expressed fear of
future change. They actually rejected any change in the near future, as their responses in the
interviews showed.
In the investigated case, curriculum change had various affective results on the research
participants. They had an external sense of agency, learned-helplessness and low self-
concept. They acted against their beliefs and appeared to hold tacit resistance to change.
The implications of this finding are similar to the one mentioned in the preceding section.
Involving teachers in curriculum development should improve their morale. Modifying the
materials and updating their content according to teachers’ feedback is the first and
172
foremost issue called for in this study. This should combat any practical problems during
implantation and contribute to improving teachers’ feelings. In addition, it should improve
acceptance based on the realisation that the curriculum is a living enduring entity through
modification rather than a dead, rigid thing through stability that is insensitive to
drawbacks. Another implication here is a need for a change in the nature of the exam from
a content-based one to one which focusses on linguistic items and skills. This may help
eliminate various problems including psychological ones and help reinforce the value of
language mastery over coverage of the materials.
Further research is recommended that takes the form of action research aiming at
investigating how teacher involvement in curriculum development affects their receptivity
of curriculum change. Another investigation could focus specifically on the development of
the English exam paper to be more valid in measuring students’ language proficiency than
it currently is.
6.3 Teachers’ Roles in Curriculum Change
As the findings indicate, teachers perceived that they had just one role to carry out in the
process of curriculum change, which is teaching the materials. Perceiving this role as
marginal, they appeared to undervalue it and some seemed to be sarcastic about it. They felt
that they were excluded from the process of curriculum change and not part of it. If there
was any part at all, then it was teaching; which they felt was low on the authoritative
hierarchy. They perceived themselves as executers of the higher commands.
173
The implication of this finding is that the MoE should highlight the value of the teachers’
role in the curriculum by involving them in other aspects of curriculum development.
Involvement, as I see it, would connote the sharing of power with the teachers. It does not
only reflect positive aspects on teachers’ perceptions with all their contributions to
improving self-concept, it also reflects positively on the curriculum. There is no doubt that
the teachers can contribute in updating the data on students’ needs and offering suggestions
on how materials can be improved. This should make curriculum development an
interactive process. It should also make the experienced curriculum reflective of the
planned one by bridging the gap between the two. This result should also improve students’
achievement to meet the planned objectives in the curriculum. Topics of research in this
area may cover any of the hypotheses stated here.
6.4 Teachers’ Perceptions of the Process of Curriculum Change
Participants in this study voiced their perceptions, which were mostly negative, of how the
various elements of the process of curriculum change were carried out. Several areas call
for further investigations. First, in the area of curriculum goals, the materials need to be
examined to find out whether this was an actual problem or that it was just an unjustified
perception. Second, in the area of students’ achievement, more studies need to be carried
out to investigate the factors behind the weaknesses and ways to remedy them. Third,
further investigations about the effect of coverage over mastery need to be carried out as
well. Fourth, further research is recommended to validate the teachers’ claims about their
students as well as to find out whether it was the exam which really affected the teachers’
practices or other factors within the context. Fifth, further investigations need to be done to
174
find out if a change in testing regime would improve the teachers’ approach to the materials
and their teaching techniques. Sixth, further research is recommended to investigate the
reasons for not carrying out continuous curriculum evaluation, and the factors which
prevent the modification of teaching materials. Finally, the reasons for lack of the provision
of training during curriculum change need to be investigated.
Overall, the implications of the findings centre on involving teachers as agents in the
process of curriculum change, and actually carrying out the missing processes such as
continuous evaluation of the teaching materials and the students’ needs. In addition,
communication channels need to be established with transparency in dealing with feedback
from teachers, as to why the data were taken into consideration or not. Teacher training
should be made more active through follow-up of those in charge of it.
6.5 Teachers’ Metaphors as Expressions of Perceptions
A finding which calls for further investigation relates to the metaphors that the teachers
used (see 5.2.2.3). On the one hand, there is a need to explore whether the metaphors used
in this study were evocative expressions of perceptions (e.g. Reagan & Osborn, 2002;
Sugrue, 1997; Von Wright, 1997) or mere figures of speech. There is a need to verify
whether these metaphors reflect what teachers think or are just clichés in the context. On
the other hand, there is a need to inspect whether these metaphors have any implications in
the context, and whether they are perceived as such by other teachers in the same setting.
For instance, the metaphor of the ‘obedient slave’ may have political implications of lack of
exercising teachers’ rights in their job as they perceive themselves as controlled beings who
carry out orders thoughtlessly. Nonetheless, more research should be done in this area too.
175
Further, the implications of the negative connotations of such expressions have to do with
improving the status of teachers by giving them voice in the curriculum, as argued earlier.
6.6 Contributions of the Study
Considering that the study is the first of its type in its comprehensive focus on the
secondary school EL curriculum in the UAE and on policies taken for changing curricula
and roles of teachers in these processes from the teachers’ perspective, the study has
contributed in various areas of knowledge. It has explored the issues and portrayed a
picture of the status quo. From my perspective the findings are transferable, and they may
be so from the perspective of many educationists who are familiar with the context.
Therefore, I shall now identify areas of further research, in addition to the ones explained in
this chapter. These can be recapitulated as follows:
1- Participants in this study have identified areas of weaknesses in the secondary EL
curriculum. Further investigation is needed in this area to validate them. These can
be summarised as follows:
a) There is a need to revise the goals of the EL curriculum to make them
compatible with actual student needs. The MoE should seek feedback from
teachers in this regard.
b) There is a need to revise the materials in accordance with emerging student
needs and eliminate redundant content. Teachers should have a major role to
play in this. They should be provided with effective communicative
channels which ensure their voice reaches the right people.
176
c) The amount of content should be suitable for the time allotted for learning.
Teaching materials need to be piloted before introducing them nationally.
Further, based on changing student needs, teachers need to be consulted with
regard to the amount of content. More attention is to be paid to the quality of
content rather than quantity.
d) Materials should not be binding and supervisors should give teachers a free
hand in the curriculum. Teachers should have the authority to manipulate the
content in ways which meet students’ needs but do not violate curriculum
goals. This should relieve the teachers feelings of being restricted by the
materials.
e) The current student assessment system should be revised. Teachers should
report the aspects of the assessment system which hinder their work and
their views should be respected. If the exam becomes independent of the
content of the teaching materials, teachers’ work pressure with regard to
time constraints will be reduced, and many of the factors that force teachers
to resort to traditional ways of teaching will be eliminated.
f) Evaluation should be integrated as part of the curriculum. The Curriculum
Development Centre should have a more active role in researching the
effectiveness of the curriculum by consulting teachers. It is expected that the
teachers’ feelings of low-self concept will be overcome when they realise
that they are playing a better role in the curriculum.
g) Materials should undergo modifications on a regular basis based on
feedback from teachers. The actual implementation of the teachers’
recommendations will also improve their self-concept with regard their role
in the curriculum.
177
h) Teacher training should be made more systematic. The MoE should follow
up the training of teachers to ensure that they get the background
information needed for dealing with the curriculum materials as well as
assessment of students based on the goals of the curriculum. Basically,
training teachers on dealing with the new curriculum should be implemented
more efficiently. Rather than having it a one-shot activity, training should be
held regularly and continuously. In cases where training is offered only on
the first year when new materials are introduced, some teachers could be
invited to carry out training in the subsequent years for their colleagues who
have missed it. This should encourage peer mentoring and make teachers
aware of the importance of support from within the school or educational
district.
i) Curricular support should be considered. The Curriculum Development
Centre should have a more active role in curricular support. Representatives
from the Centre should carry out field visits to observe the curriculum
implementation in schools in addition to feedback gathered by supervisors.
Further, schools should receive sufficient funds to cater for the requirements
of the curriculum.
j) Regular needs analysis should be integrated as part of the curriculum. The
Curriculum Development Centre should follow up on this aspect of the
curriculum by consulting teachers on the various aspects of the curriculum.
Since it would be hard for the Curriculum Development Centre to follow up
individual curricular requirements, networking among schools, at least
within each educational district, need to be encouraged. School
representatives need to report teachers’ feedback to representatives from the
178
Curriculum Development Centre, or supervisors, who need to be more active
in forwarding the feedback to the Curriculum Development Centre. When
teachers are involved in this process, they are expected to feel agents of
change rather than executers of commands. This should improve their self-
concept too.
2- The study has generated hypotheses about areas of weaknesses in the current change
attempts in general. They are:
a) Teachers’ voice in the various aspects of the curriculum should be honoured.
Teachers in this study expressed hard feelings with regard to their role in
curriculum development. Much of the hardships can be eliminated by
involving teachers in curriculum development. The curriculum development
processes which have been identified as missing by teachers need to be
made explicit for them. Teachers need to be empowered to feel that they are
important agents of change. This cannot be achieved without actual
curriculum development tasks allotted to schools.
b) More transparency is needed where top-down curriculum change is
inevitable. Teachers should be informed of any future plans. This can be
feasible if regular updates are posted on the MoE’s website. Rather than
following rumours which hinder the teachers’ work, they need to be clear
about what is ahead of them. More active communication channels need to
be established as well.
c) Evaluation of change should reach all the aspects of the curriculum on an
on-going basis. Curriculum evaluation needs to be continuous and its result
179
utilised in modifying the various aspects of the curriculum. The results of
the evaluation have to result in actual modifications of the materials or any
other element of the curriculum which proves to be causing difficulties such
as testing, for instance. Change should not only take the form of new
materials but other aspects of the curriculum should be changed too.
3- The study has raised critical issues of importance for the management of change.
They reverberate how imposed change through contextual hierarchy has an impact
on impeding actual implementation of the curriculum in ways which make the
enacted and experienced curriculum different from that which is initially planned.
Such issues like powerlessness, control and lack of teacher involvement need to be
observed and explored in depth.
The study has also contributed to my enlightenment in the issue of curriculum
development. I see the above findings as lessons for me in my upcoming career. Personally,
I believe it is dangerous to be ignorant of these lessons and even tragic to know them and
not do anything about them.
The purpose of this study was to understand teachers’ perceptions of language curriculum
change. Although the sample in this study provided many insights into understanding
teachers’ perceptions of curriculum change, it also posed several practical limitations.
Therefore, in spite of the fact that I have outlined defective aspects of the process of
curriculum change and teachers’ roles in it, additional research is needed to investigate the
process from the perspective of other stakeholders as well as the effect of these factors on
students’ achievement and teachers’ performance.
180
APPENDICES Appendix I: A. The Goals of the EL Curriculum in the UAE B. Excerpts from the 1994 Curriculum Document Appendix II: A Description of the Materials Taught in the Secondary Stage: English
for the Emirates 10, 11 and 12 Appendix III: English Test Paper Specifications in the Secondary Stage Appendix IV: A. What is curriculum? B. The Components of the EL Curriculum Development Process C. Teachers’ Roles in the EL Curriculum: A historical overview Appendix V: Letter of Invitation to Participate (School principals) Appendix VI: Address of Invitation to Participate (EL Teachers) Appendix VII: Interview Schedule Appendix VIII: Sample Transcripts of Interviews
181
Appendix I – A
The Goals of the EL Curriculum in the UAE According to the 1994 Curriculum Document, the goals of teaching English are as follows:
1. to foster the spiritual and intellectual development of the individual in accordance with the teachings of Islam, Arab tradition and the general aims of education in the UAE;
2. to promote the economic, social and technological development of the UAE; 3. to contribute to the growth of understanding and co-operation between the
UAE and other nations; 4. to give pupils the valuable educational experience of learning another
language, and to develop the discipline that this requires; 5. to qualify school leavers for higher studies through the medium of English; 6. to qualify school leavers to take up employment that requires the use of
English; 7. to introduce pupils to other cultures and to the wider world; 8. to enable pupils to acquire a basic communicative competence in English in
all the four language skills; 9. to develop in pupils a critical awareness of the ethical dimension of
language use; 10. to encourage pupils to acquire the self-study skills, including critical
thinking and other mental skills, applicable to learning languages and learning through languages”. (Curriculum Document, 1994:7-8)
The 1994 Curriculum Document also lists the objectives for teaching English in the
secondary stage, which are listed below according to the four language skills:
“ A. LISTENING
- understand English spoken at a normal pace by a variety of native-speakers; - understand a wide range of recorded texts (talks, dialogues, phone calls, etc.) - recognize accent variety of English from around the world; - decipher the gist of an incomplete oral message; - extract specific and detailed information from a spoken communication; - listen to news bulletins on radio or television; - listen to a lecture; - listen to and respect others’ viewpoints.
182
B. SPEAKING
- speak with confidence on a wide range of topics, including unfamiliar topics; - initiate and take part in a conversation with native-speakers; - take part in a role-play; - understand an incomplete dialogue by requesting the necessary missing
information; - express a wide range of emotions; - argue a logical case.
C. READING
- read a variety of text types, including narratives, descriptions, arguments, explanations, etc;
- grasp the gist of texts which include unfamiliar language; - extract specific information from a variety of texts; - use reference books (including dictionaries) and libraries; - distinguish between fact and fiction, between emotion and reason; - appreciate the value and joy of reading; - read poetry and other literature; - read silently at a reasonable level of speed and understanding; - identify key sentences and main ideas; - read at least 3 supplementary readers each year at an appropriate level.
D. WRITING
- write texts of paragraph lengths on a variety of topics; - write a lengthy report with correct spelling and punctuation; - improve their written work by writing and correcting several drafts; - write one-page formal and informal letters and other business communications; - write short essays which show a development of ideas and the presentation of an
argument; - take notes and reconstruct them as text; - make summaries; - appreciate the value of the writing skill, especially for educational progress.”
(Curriculum Document, 1994:19-21)
183
Appendix I - B
Excerpts from the Curriculum Document (1994)
Excerpt 1: (Introduction and General Principles, page 2)
This document is concerned with the English language in the general school curriculum in both
basic and secondary education. For the purposes of planning the syllabus, these two stages have
been further broken down into four levels of three years each, as follows:
1. Primary 1-3 (pupils usually aged 6 - 8)
2. Primary 4-6 (9 - 11)
3. Preparatory (12 - 14)
4. Secondary (15 - 17)
Excerpt 2: (Introduction and General Principles, page 5)
…
4. The new course will feature a balance between the communicative approach and the explicit
teaching of basic grammar and vocabulary. It is possible to find a harmony between the various
approaches. Similarly, it will incorporate a balance of all four language skills;
5. One of the most effective means of ensuring successful implementation of new curricula is to
integrate effective staff development programmes with any curricula change. The course must
take into account the nature of the teachers who will be using it, and its introduction will coincide
with the implementation of a full teacher training programme;
6. The development of materials will go hand-in-hand with the systematic collection of feedback
from the field to ensure that this course is truly appropriate to the needs of the UAE;
…
184
Excerpt 3: (Recommendations from the Needs Analysis, pages 89-91)
An Assessment of the English Language Needs of the UAE: a survey and analytical study
Ministry of Education, December, 1992
In the light of the above study and of the UAE Development Plan and the requirements of the
University of the UAE (including new ESP courses starting in 1992/93), it is recommended that the
content of the teaching materials will meet the following needs:
1. the theoretical and applied needs of higher education and professional life;
2. the need of the students to cope with international changes in technology and electronics;
3. provide learners with a sound understanding of scientific and literary biographies in the local,
Arab, Islamic and international spheres;
4. indicate the role of science fiction in arousing thinking and releasing creativity;
5. stretch the role of language descriptive writing and reading;
6. enable learners to transfer their knowledge from one field to another;
7. provide the basis for a cohesive integration of subjects in the secondary stage.
Recommendations for the New English Course
1. The course will promote the positive attitude of learners towards learning English. To help them
achieve mastery, the course will be longer and include more language, structures and teaching
techniques.
2. It is very important to show the functions of language in a graded way, both quantitatively and
qualitatively. The course will include lively, meaningful and natural use of language, and simple
self-instructional techniques.
3. The course will adopt advanced techniques and technologies in teaching and evaluation.
4. Training programmes will be designed in the light of the actual difficulties encountered by
teachers and learners, and suitable solutions suggested.
185
5. The course will take into account the English language requirements of UAE society:
a) reinforcing the relationship between the use of the English language and local values. The
contents will take this into account in the areas of the learner, local society, international
society, Islamic and Arabic heritage, health, science and technologies;
b) defining the language targets precisely so that learners can achieve a mastery that will
enable them to use the language as a tool of study;
c) specifying the language that will be used to prepare learners for higher studies and for the
labour market;
d) adapting teaching strategies and evaluation in line with the general aim of promoting the
standard of English language learning;
e) developing the professionalism of teachers with a training approach which allows for a
variety of training methods.
186
Appendix II
A Description of the Materials Taught in the Secondary Stage:
English for the Emirates 10, 11 and 12
1. Materials for Grade 10
A. The Pupil’s Book
The Pupil’s Book for Grade 10 contains eight units; four to be covered in each semester.
Each unit focusses on one theme, which is not repeated again, and consists of five lessons.
Each lesson has five steps. The steps vary in length and have corresponding activities in the
Workbook. Some of them may be covered in a part of a lesson while others may require
more time to deal with. The first step is a reading text which may take the form of a short
narrative, a letter, a review, a dialogue or a story. At the end of each unit, there is a word
list of the vocabulary items selected from the lessons which are subject for testing. The
book has coloured illustrations and consists of 108 pages.
B. The Workbook
Workbook 10 falls in 105 pages. It is divided into 8 units that correspond to lessons in the
Pupil’s Book. The numbers of the activities are not consistent in each unit; they range from
four to 11. The types of activities are listed below:
187
a. Comprehension Answering wh-, yes-no and multiple-choice questions Responding to true-false statements Filling in missing information in a given table or a report Summarising information Solving a crossword puzzle Finding reference words
b. Grammar
Making questions Rewriting sentences without changing the meaning Changing sentences into the negative Completing dialogues with missing questions Completing statements Correcting verbs between brackets Joining sentences Reordering words to form sentences
c. Functions Reading lists of expressions Writing suitable expressions for given situations Classifying expressions related to given functions
d. Vocabulary Filling in spaces with words from the list Using words in sentences Finding synonyms using a dictionary Finding antonyms Searching for words to match given meanings Looking up meanings of words in a dictionary
e. Writing
Writing a paragraph on a given topic Completing forms and dialogues Writing words using given affixes Retelling a give story from a different point of view Writing a letter/ a postcard
f. Pronunciation
Identifying homonyms g. Project work
Finding information about a given topic
188
C. The Teacher’s Book
Teacher’s Book 10 contains brief notes on how to teach each lesson as a whole. The
introduction lists the general objectives of the course in the secondary stage and gives a
brief description of the materials. Different aspects are adopted in different units which
indicates that they were produced by different writers. Some lessons contain answers to the
questions in the workbook. There is a comprehensive list of the words that are prescribed
for the exam arranged in alphabetical order.
2. Materials for Grade 11
A. The Pupil’s Book
The Pupil’s Book for Grade 11 contains six units; three to be covered in each semester.
Each unit focusses on one theme, which is not repeated again, and each Unit consists of
five lessons. The number of steps varies from one lesson to another. The steps vary in
length and have some corresponding activities in the Workbook, as in Book 10. Similarly,
some steps may be covered as a part of a lesson while others may require more time to deal
with. The first step is a reading text that has a pre-reading activity that precedes it. The text
may take the form of a short narrative, a letter, a review, a dialogue or a story, as in Book
10. In every unit, there is a pronunciation activity and a speaking activity. These activities
are new features in the course starting from this book and continuing in Book 12. There is a
word list in the Pupil’s Book 11 at the end each unit. At the beginning of the book, there is
a list of phonetic symbols and a table of contents. These, as well as an appendix of irregular
189
verbs, are new features in the course. The book has coloured illustrations and falls in 128
pages.
B. The Workbook
Workbook 11 falls in 170 pages. It is divided into 6 units that correspond to lessons in the
Pupil’s Book. There are five activities consistent in each unit which are known as practices.
There are detailed grammatical rules in every lesson; five in every unit. The types of
activities are listed below:
a. Vocabulary
Filling in spaces with words from the list/ multiple choice Using words in sentences Searching for words to match given meanings Looking up meanings of words in a dictionary Matching words and meanings Searching for words in a crosswords puzzle Guessing meanings from the context
b. Structure
Completing statements Changing words into nouns Completing a table Transformation Correcting verbs in given sentences / paragraphs Word search for given parts of speech Multiple choice questions
c. Functions
Reading lists of expressions Writing suitable expressions for given situations Matching expressions and responses Completing a dialogue with missing parts Matching statements to pictures
d. Focus on: (this section provides different focus points in every unit) Punctuation marks Spelling rules Abbreviations Gender words
190
Articles Analysing a paragraph into its constituent parts Connectives
e. Writing Critical thinking activities: e.g. writing a plan, solving problems, Writing a paragraph on a given topic Completing forms and dialogues Writing a letter/ a diary Writing a story Designing posters Retelling a give story from a different point of view Completing a diagram Writing a headline for a given news story
C. The Teacher’s Book
Teacher’s Book 11 also contains brief notes on how to teach each lesson as a whole. The
introduction is shorter but it gives a brief description of the materials and has a contents
chart which is the same as that in the Pupil’s Book. Each lesson in the Workbook begins
with the general aims of the unit, and specific objectives listing the structures and functions
to be taught in that unit. Some lessons contain answers to the questions in the workbook.
Similar aspects are adopted in different units, unlike Workbook 10. The wordlist here is
replaced by a list of irregular verbs similar to the one in the Workbook.
3. Materials for Grade 12
A. The Pupil’s Book
The Pupil’s Book 12 for Grade 12 contains six units, three to be covered in each semester.
Like the other books, each unit focusses on one theme, which is not repeated again.
191
However, more topics are covered as the theme of the unit seems to be more general.
Unlike the previous books, each Unit in Book 12 consists of fifteen lessons. The number of
steps varies from one lesson to another and there is more than one reading text in each
lesson in some cases. The steps vary in length and have some corresponding activities in
the Workbook, as in Books 10 and 11. Similarly also, some steps may be covered as a part
of a lesson while others may require more time to deal with. The first step is a reading text
that has a pre-reading activity that precedes it and comprehension questions following it.
The text may take the form of a short narrative, a letter, a review, a dialogue or a story, as
in the other books with the addition of a box containing words and their meanings. There
are other new features with regard to the type of texts in this book. There are tables,
diagrams, grammatical or functional notes, pictures, activities with spaces provided. In
every unit, there is a pronunciation activity and a speaking activity longer than those in
Book 11. A new feature that is exclusive to this book is the revision section, which contains
functions with lists of expressions and grammatical notes. There is also a summary of what
is covered in the whole unit, and a picture-dictionary. There is a table of contents but there
is no contents chart as in Book 11. Like the previous books, the book has coloured
illustrations but it is longer as it has 227 pages.
B. The Workbook
Workbook 12 consists of 181 pages. It is divided into 6 units of 15 lessons, each of which
corresponds to a lesson in the Pupil’s Book. The number of activities is not consistent in
each unit. The types of activities are listed below:
192
a. Vocabulary Writing definitions for given words or for highlighted words in sentences Filling in spaces with words from the list Using words in sentences Searching for words to match given meanings or opposites Matching words and meanings
b. Structure
Correcting statements with grammatical errors Reading to identify specific structures Rearranging jumbled statement Making up statements from a given grid Completing statements Transformation Retelling a story using a different tense Filling in sentences with correct forms of given verbs Identifying parts of speech Correcting verbs in given sentences / paragraphs Word search for given parts of speech
c. Comprehension
Answering a true-false exercise Writing answers to comprehension questions Completing tables using information from the textbook Completing word maps
d. Functions
Making up short conversations Writing a get-well card including advice Writing sentences using given expressions
e. Writing
Sentences as ideas for a given topic Answers to questions to be used as notes for writing a paragraph Writing a paragraph on a given topic Explaining given terms in short paragraphs Organising ideas for an essay Completing forms, letters and one-sided dialogues Writing letters Writing a story Punctuation marks
f. Other activities
Punctuation marks Reference skills: arranging words alphabetically Abbreviations
193
C. The Teacher’s Book
Like the previous teachers’ books 10 and 11, Teacher’s Book 12 also contains brief notes
on how to teach each lesson as a whole. In addition, it has a section that contains answers
for the workbook exercises and another one for the listening activities. The introduction
contained in this version is different and comprehensive as it supplies the underlying
principles of the course. It also contains a scope and sequence chart. The general
recommended teaching procedures are brief. Teachers are mostly given the freedom to
choose their own teaching techniques. The book has 135 pages.
194
Appendix III
English Test Paper Specifications in the Secondary Stage
The type of questions in the English examination paper as follows:
PAPER ONE
Reading Comprehension (1): The student answers comprehension questions on one of two passages taken from the prescribed book. Types of questions include:
- True/false statements - WH-Questions
Reading Comprehension (2): The students answer questions on an unseen reading comprehension passage. Types of questions include:
- Finding synonyms - Pronoun reference - WH-questions
Letter Writing: Students write a letter similar to the models given in the prescribed
materials.
PAPER TWO
Functional Writing: A choice between two tasks both are taken from the prescribed books.
Paragraph Writing: A choice between two topics ( a general information one and a story),
both are covered by the taught materials.
Structures:
A. 10 multiple-choice questions based on structural areas covered in the prescribed
books.
B. Correcting structural errors in 5 sentences.
C. Forming questions from given sentences.
Functions:
Students write responses to given situations using the language functions covered in the
prescribed materials.
195
Appendix IV-A
What is Curriculum?
(A) Curriculum as Experience
“curriculum is something experienced in situations”, in classroom where there is “a
dynamic interaction among persons, things, and processes…not any of the three in
isolation… all of these parts are in interaction.” and where experiences are interconnected”
(Connelly and Clandinin, 1988: 6-9).
“curriculum (is) not only …a collection of subjects, but …the entire set of experiences the
students have in the school” (Marlow & Minehira ,1996:6).
“the school’s curriculum…can be interpreted as the totality of the experience of pupils as
they learn and develop, as a product of school, home and life in the community”
(Hargreaves et al, 1994:85).
“curriculum is all those activities in which children engage under the auspices of the
school” (Rodgers, 1994:26).
“a set of activities involving teachers, learners and materials, and that these activities are
provided through permanent institutions” (Reid,1975:247).
(B) Curriculum as both Experience and Knowledge
“(representation) of knowledge for the purpose of teaching. …(It is what) the languages
teachers employ to talk about things and events in the world and …(it) impl(ies)…a point
of view about the use of the mind in relation to these things and events… . The curriculum,
as the language of education, not only refers to things in the world, its content, but also
marks the stance the teacher is to adopt towards the use of the child’s mind in relation to
them” (Elliott, 1994:49).
“A curriculum is the offering of socially valued knowledge, skills and attitudes made
available to students through a variety of arrangements during the time they are at school,
196
college or university…the school curriculum embraces many organized forms of learning
beyond those prescribed…(it includes) extra-curricular activities…Some of the school’s
activities are common to all; but for the most part the curriculum consists of combinations
of essential and optional programmes and activities, some chosen by the pupil for himself,
others chosen for him by the school.” (Becher and Maclure, 1978: 12-13)
(C) Curriculum as a Plan
“the broadest contexts in which planning for language instruction takes place, either on the
national level or for a community’s schools” (Dubin & Olshtain, 2000:3).
“A curriculum contains a broad description of general goals by indicating an overall
educational-cultural philosophy which applies across subjects together with a theoretical
orientation to language and language learning with respect to the subject matter at hand. A
curriculum is often reflective of national and political trends as well” (Dubin & Olshtain,
2000: 34-35)
“A document of an official nature, published by a leading or central educational authority in
order to serve as a framework or a set of guidelines for the teaching of a subject area…in a
broad and varied context” (Celce-Murcia and Olshtain, 2000:185).
(D) Plan and Process
“Curriculum: All the planned learning opportunities offered by the organisation to learners
and the experiences learners encounter when the curriculum is implemented” (Print,
1993:xvii).
“a process of assisting learning informed by a background of knowledge and experience”
(van Lier, 1997:3)
“the philosophy, purposes, design, and implementation of a whole program” (Graves,
2003:3).
“Curriculum…involves a number of separate elements: needs assessment, goals and
objectives, testing, materials, teaching, and program evaluation” (Brown, 1995:ix).
197
“Curriculum …include(s) all the relevant decision making processes of all the
participants…The products of these decision making processes..(are) policy documents,
syllabuses, teacher- training programmes, teaching materials and resources, and teaching
and learning acts” (Johnson, 1994:1).
“…includes the establishment of goals for the entire educational program, the selection of
subjects through which the goals can be achieved, and the identification of intended
learning outcomes and, possibly, content that comprise the unique contribution of each
subject. It also encompasses dissemination of the curriculum, planning for implementation
of the curriculum, and evaluation of both the curriculum itself and the processes that
produced it.” Young, (1979:115).
“curriculum …covers all the learning which is planned and guided by the school. It should
comprise several interrelated components-precise statements of objectives for each area, the
knowledge and learning experiences most likely to achieve the objectives, and the means of
deciding the degree to which the objectives are being achieved (‘evaluation’)” Kerr,
(1970:57)
“a network of interacting systems involving teachers, learners, materials, schools,
administrators, and curriculum planners…choices at one level affect other elements in the
system. Thus a choice of a particular curriculum philosophy or ideology implies a particular
model of teaching.” Richards (2003:215).
198
Appendix IV-B
The components of the EL Curriculum Development Process:
A Critical Account
Curriculum development is a framework of processes that should be seen as spiral
procedure rather than a linear one (Holliday, 1997). Its processes have been explained
extensively in the literature (e.g. Bailey, 2000; Brindley, 1994; Brown, 1995; Dalton,
1988; Dubin & Olshtain, 2000; Graves, 2003; Isaac, 1983; Kerr, 1970; Print,1993; Rea-
Dickens & Germaine, 1998 Richards, 2003 Rodgers, 1994 White, 1985). However, this
account is a synthesis of the frameworks described by the mentioned theorists.
1. Needs Analysis
Needs analysis or needs assessment, as it is also referred to, includes gathering information
about what the students already know and what they still need to learn (Brown, 1995) and
learning about contextual constraints (Holliday, 1997). It also includes exploring the
context in which the EL programme is planned to be introduced (Holliday, 1997). Needs
analysis is conducted before, during, or after a language programme (Richards, 2003). A
thorough examination of the learning needs within the context is a basic requirement of
curriculum development (Print, 1993; Richards, 2003). People involved in the needs
analysis are not only the needs analysts but also the target group. This includes students, as
well as the audience for the needs analysis such as teachers and supervisors, and any group
of people who have useful information about the target group (Brown, 1995; Richards,
199
2003). There are needs expressed by learners and needs perceived by teachers. The most
common instruments used for data collection may be questionnaires, interviews or students’
performance assessments (Brown, 1995). In addition, Holliday (1997:195) asserts that: “the
whole range of activities in English language education, from syllabus design to project
management, needs to be led by a deeper understanding of the social forces acting on the classroom,
which a culture-sensitive approach hopes to provide”. He refers to the process as ‘ethnographic
means analysis’ (Holliday, 1997:206) to which he recommends ethnographic action
research as a framework for curriculum development. As well, Benesch (1996) calls for a
critical approach to needs analysis to guide curriculum development.
The process of needs analysis is only an attempt to understand the context in which
language is taught. This understanding is coloured by the perceptions of the people who
carry out the analysis (Brown, 1995). The results of the needs analysis are important since
understanding the weaknesses and strengths of the existing curriculum can result in
producing an improved one (Dubin & Olshtain, 2000). However, the process of needs
analysis has been criticised as its results tend to be impressionistic regardless of the
approach taken in conducting the investigation (Benesch, 1996). According to Richards
(2003), needs are subjective interpretations rather than objective facts. Further, a needs
analysis does not automatically imply that the curriculum will change (Richards, 2003).
According to Brown (1995), language needs analysis is a situation that is unlike needs
analysis for other disciplines. It involves discourse analysis as well as text analysis. The
pattern of language that is used in the society should be sought for (Dubin & Olshtain,
2000). If the teachers of the language are non-native speakers, Dubin and Olshtain (2000)
recommend evaluating their knowledge and ability to use the language. Needs analysis
200
serves many purposes. It identifies the skills that the learners need to communicate in the
foreign language. It also identifies areas of potential weakness with some learners to
address them in the course, and points out the gaps between students’ current abilities and
the target ones (Richards ,2003). In this regard, I agree with Brindley (1994) who considers
needs analysis as an aspect of formative evaluation, and Richards (2003) who views needs
analysis as a continuous process. Both writers propose that learners’ needs should be
investigated continuously throughout the life of the language curriculum. From this
standpoint, teachers have a dual role. From one perspective, they are required to explore the
needs of the learners and meet them accordingly. From another perspective, the changing
needs of learners should be communicated to curriculum developers when there is a central
body in the institution responsible for this.
2. Curriculum Intents: Defining Aims, Goals and Objectives
Gathering information about the students’ current proficiency and difficulties they have
with the language helps in shaping learning objectives (Brindley, 1989). Therefore, needs
analysis yields data that are to be analysed and employed in generating the goals of the
curriculum (Brown, 1995; Dubin & Olshtain, 2000); As Brown (1995:75) concedes:
“the process of converting perceptions of students into goals and objectives provides the basic units that can in turn be used to define and organize all teaching activities into a cogent curriculum …objectives provide the building blocks from which curriculum can be created, molded, and revised”.
The intents of the curriculum are normally stated in a curriculum document. Aims, goals
and objectives take a hierarchical form according to their degree of specificity
(Brown,1995; Print, 1993) whereby educational aims reflect societal expectations; goals
address general concerns and objectives are specific outcomes of courses outlined in a
201
syllabus. Goals guide materials development and objectives serve as a guide for teachers
and learners (Dubin & Olshtain, 2000). The objectives are linked to its goals and affect the
language content and the outcomes (Dubin & Olshtain, 2000). These outcomes should not
be binding (Elliott, 1994). Apparently, the goals of the curriculum should display
continuous sensitivity to student needs.
Theoretically speaking, teachers should participate in setting curriculum intents. While this
might be feasible in individual institutions, it is rather difficult to achieve in state schools
whereby the curriculum is developed centrally. However, still teachers should have their
input through continuous revisions of goals. This implies that they should have access to
the curriculum document.
On the other hand, there are specific objectives at the daily level. While teachers have some
autonomy in the adaptation of the objectives to include others that are based on daily
interactions with learners, still a tension occurs between these objectives. To quote Graves
(2003):
“the time it takes to master skills or knowledge or to develop awareness may not correspond to the time allotted in a syllabus. This tension can create dilemmas for teachers who must cover and test the materials in the syllabus yet wish to ensure that students have mastered the material prior to moving on. The tension can also put teachers at odds with their students or the institution if the teacher believes that success is achieved through demonstrated mastery but the students expect coverage to mean mastery”.
Elliott (1994) criticises the situation in which curricula are driven by objectives. He posits
that their tenets are contradictory to the modern principles of discovery learning. Objectives
therefore should be illuminative rather than binding allowing more teacher input into them
on the basis of students’ needs. It goes without saying that objectives should be revised
202
regularly, especially by the end of the course to check for their reflection of real learning
needs.
3. Course Planning or Syllabus Design
For Breen (1987:82) a syllabus is “a plan of what is to be achieved through teaching”. By
definition, “syllabus design is…the process by which linguistic content-vocabulary, grammar,
notions, functions- is selected and organised” (Rodgers, 1994:28). The decision of which
syllabus to follow may be decided a priori by curriculum developers or it may emerge as
the curriculum development process proceeds.
Dubin and Olshtain (2000) cite five formats for organising the syllabus: Linear, modular,
cyclical, matrix and story-line formats. First, in the linear format, grammar is sequenced
and graded, and units have to be taught in the order of their presentation to preserve
gradation. Second, the modular format is suitable for language content that is thematic or
situational. Third, in the cyclical format, teachers and learners are reintroduced repeatedly
to the same topic with an increasing complexity. Fourth, the matrix format contains a grid
of topics and content in random order and is more suitable for situational content. Last, the
story-line format, which takes a narrative form, can be used in combination with the other
formats.
While there is no model curriculum that adheres to these designs, there is a tendency in
recent practices to have a negotiated syllabus between teachers and learners. Initially,
language objectives can be negotiated with learners and modifications or manipulation of
the structure of the teaching material may be carried out as the course progresses (Graves,
203
2003). It is doubtful however that this can be feasible to teachers who have inflexible or
prescribed materials. However, while the teachers’ role in the negotiated syllabus is that of
active involvement, their role in implementing other forms of syllabus may seem passive.
Yet feedback on the practicality of the design cannot be decided without consulting
teachers.
4. Curriculum Content: Preparation or Selection of Instructional Material
Materials serve as a resource for teachers and learners in terms of classroom activities.
These include books, lesson plans, audiovisual aids and the like (Brown, 1995). They are
the basis for language input and practice in the classroom (Richards, 2003). They also help
guide new teachers and serve as a reference for language-related items such as grammar
and vocabulary. While some teachers depend exclusively on published materials, others
may supplement them with teacher-made materials that meet students’ needs (Richards,
2003). A key issue in materials selection or preparation is that materials should be well
organised, easy to use and lend themselves to adaptation (Brown, 1995).
Brown (1995) gives an overview of ways of organising materials. Firstly, a structural
syllabus focusses on sequencing and grading grammatical forms. Secondly, a situational
syllabus focusses on organising content on the basis of common situations. Thirdly, a
topical syllabus organises the material around themes that are perceived to be of
importance. Fourthly, a functional syllabus is organised around general notions or concepts.
Fifthly, a skills-based syllabus organises content around academic skills. Lastly, a task-
based syllabus organises the materials around tasks that are essential for language
performance. While most published materials claim one aspect or the other, there are
204
mostly mixed-syllabuses in which writers mix a syllabus with one or more types of
syllabuses (Brown, 1995).
Dubin and Olshtain (2000) offer guidelines for writers to consider when preparing materials
among which are: providing a focus and adequate preparation for learners before asking
them to produce anything. In addition, motivational factors have to be considered. Further,
the manner in which a curriculum proposal is presented in the form of materials is a core
issue in curriculum development (Barrow, 1984). Essentially, the textbook is the main
determinant of the validity of the curriculum among teachers and learners (Dubin &
Olshtain, 2000). To maintain this validity, materials need to be reviewed continuously as a
means of monitoring their effectiveness. Brown (1995) argues that the materials should be
reviewed annually.
While some institutions credit the choice of materials to teachers, more often than not
teachers are given a prescribed set of materials to use. Usually, the choice of materials is
guided by several factors of which to what extent they meet the objectives of the
curriculum and the needs of the students are two major determinants (Graves, 2003).
Overall, piloting materials is an issue of great importance too.
5. Training and Support: Providing for Effective Teaching
Bailey (2000) observes that curriculum development and teacher development are
interconnected issues. Having a new curriculum implies that new approaches need to be
adopted which calls for retraining of teachers. Without exception, teachers should receive
sufficient orientation of the materials as initial training, which should be given before
205
teachers begin using the course books, affects their perceptions of the course (Brown,
1995). Furthermore, there should be on-going curricular support for teachers especially
during curriculum change. However, teachers should not expect to receive ready solutions
and they have to take an inquiry stance towards the curriculum (Dalton, 1988).
Curriculum development should be a cooperative process. It is of importance that teachers
should not be left without training or support as this would affect their main task of
teaching. It is true that deficiencies in the materials or the resources are not an issue if we
have good teachers (Kerr, 1970; Richards, 2003) but to achieve quality in teaching it is
necessary to generate work environments that support teachers (Richards, 2003).
6. Evaluation
Evaluation is a process that should accompany each of the above curriculum development
processes. It is also an integral part of the curriculum itself. Evaluation focusses on the
objectives of the curriculum and to what extent they have been achieved (White, 1985) in
an attempt to improve it (Cronbach, 1985). Evaluation of the curriculum includes
evaluating learning, teaching and the materials in use. Curriculum evaluation is conducted
for three purposes: (1) formative, as part of the curriculum; (2) illuminative, to develop an
understanding, and (3) summative, to make decisions about the effectiveness of the
curriculum (Richards, 2003). Therefore, it is important to have continuous evaluation as
part of the curriculum by integrating evaluation into curriculum development (Brown,
1995; Print, 1993; Rea-Dickens & Germaine, 1998). Evaluation is illuminative in nature,
can be utilised in shaping policy and contributes to curricular decision-making.
206
One of the forms of evaluation in the curriculum is the measurement of students’
performance. Gathering data on students’ performance takes the form of tests which are
normally prepared by teachers (Print, 1993; Brown, 1995; Elliott, 1994; Romero, 1998).
Test design is guided by principles of “validity, reliability, practicality, washback, transparency,
security and usefulness” (Coombe & Hubley, 2005:3). Test specifications are normally
developed to provide a blueprint that guides the teachers in designing tests (Coombe,
2005). While testing is one of the apparent processes in which the teachers’ role is clear,
Brown (1995) advises curriculum developers to be involved in testing in as much as
teachers are.
Evaluation of the curriculum also involves the evaluation of teaching. The basic assumption
behind teacher evaluation is the attempt to improve education (Duke, 1995), as the quality
of the curriculum depends on the quality of teaching (Cronbach, 1985). Outcomes indicate
that teacher evaluation helps to recognise training needs and improves teaching (Richards,
2003).
Evaluation of the materials is also part of curriculum development. There is no such thing
as a perfect set of materials. To maintain the effectiveness of the material, it has to undergo
regular evaluation to match the change in students’ needs. Criteria for textbook evaluation
include stability, flexibility, adaptability, theoretical orientation and the teaching approach
(Richards, 2003). There are issues to be considered in curriculum evaluation. These include
evaluation from insiders and outsiders alike to promote precision. Qualitative as well as
quantitative measurements should be considered when conducting the evaluation.
Evaluation should be accompanied by on-going improvement based on the findings
(Brown, 1995; Richards, 2003). It goes without saying that teachers should play a major
207
role in evaluating the curriculum materials and the extent to which they meet the
curriculum goals and objectives. Such insights cannot be obtained without consulting those
who are directly involved in dealing with students.
The more the curriculum is viewed as a process the better it lends itself to revision and
modifications to cater for the specific needs of the students that are unstable. The view that
the curriculum is a finished product makes it difficult to change. The materials are best to
be viewed as unfinished. This makes on-going development of the curriculum possible. The
materials can be checked for their compatibility with the needs, goals, tests and any other
component of the curriculum (Brown, 1995).
208
Appendix IV-C
Teachers’ Roles in the EL Curriculum: A historical overview
Since this study investigates perceptions of teachers with regard to curriculum change, the
teacher’s role in implementing the curriculum and possible contributions to curriculum
development had been discussed in the thesis. However, the role of teachers inside the
classroom is a pivotal issue that readers consider understanding. This account includes a
brief overview of how the teachers’ roles in the classroom have changed with the change in
foreign language teaching methodology. In addition, the role of learners in the modern
teaching methodology will be considered.
The teacher’s role in the classroom has changed to parallel the changes that occurred in
methodology (Dubin & Olshtain, 2000; Kumaravadivelu, 2003). For instance, in Grammar-
Translation, the teacher’s role was to explain the content. In the Audiolingual Approach,
the teachers’ roles changed radically into being models for their learners in drilling content.
In the Communicative Approach the teacher took the role of the director as he or she
worked on facilitating the students’ parts in playing their roles in their own learning. In this
approach, the teacher was a resource person who supplemented the prescribed materials
with ones that matched students’ needs within the given curriculum.
The eclectic method preceded the communicative approach. In this method, it was agreed
that teachers should utilise the most successful techniques from all the known methods. The
209
decision of which method suited the language purpose was based on areas of strengths that
each method was successful at.
Currently, language teaching methodology continues to receive criticism for its
insensitivity to context. Kumaravadivelu (2003:32-33) refers to this as the post-method era
that marks the “search for an alternative to method rather than an alternative method”. This is
also known as the Post Communicative Language Teaching movement. It calls for using
methodology that is appropriate to the culture (Holliday, 1997; Kumaravadivelu, 2003a).
The approach that Holliday recommends is that language teachers should research the
context ethnographically to arrive at the most appropriate method for the context. In this
view, teachers are more autonomous in selecting their teaching methods based on their
repertoire of experience as learners.
Viewed from a different perspective, roles of teachers fall into three aspects: technicians,
reflective practitioners and transformative intellectuals (Kumaravadivelu; 2003). As
technicians, teachers are conduits of knowledge who derive their knowledge from empirical
research of experts and their own proficiency. Their main goal is to maximise content
knowledge through activities that are prescribed by experts. As reflective practitioners,
however, teachers are facilitators who obtain knowledge from guided action research in
addition to their own personal knowledge and professional knowledge. Their goal is to
maximise the students’ learning potential by devising problem solving activities.
As transformative intellectuals, teachers are considered change agents. They derive their
knowledge from self-exploratory research besides their personal knowledge. According to
Kumaravadivelu (2003), the role of the teachers as a reflective practitioner encompasses the
210
role of the teacher as a technician, and the role of the teacher as a transformative
intellectual is holistic and encompasses aspects of all. Thus the three roles can be seen as
hierarchical.
In a process syllabus design, the teacher mediates between the learning needs of the
students and the requirements of the syllabus (Breen & Littlejohn, 2000). The syllabus that
reaches the students is filtered through the teacher based on his or her prior experience with
the students. For instance, Smith (2000) explains her approach to teaching in a process
syllabus, which is grounded on learners’ views. She explains that even objectives need to
be changed to match the students’ needs. Breen and Littlejohn (2000) concede that
negotiating the curriculum with learners is more feasible when it is not prescribed by a
higher authority as prescribed curricula constrain teachers’ and learners’ freedom of choice.
Obviously, the above roles are limited to the classroom, whereas teachers are considered
agents of change (Fullan, 1993, 1999, 2001a, 2001b). They should be involved in the
various curriculum development processes.
The roles of learners have also changed within these approaches. In the Grammar-
Translation Approach, the learners carried out reading, writing, translating and
memorisation of texts. In the Audiolingual Approach, the learners carried out mechanical
repetitions and guided practice. In the Communicative Approach, the learners were
encouraged to participate in pair and group activities. The current philosophy is that
learners should have an active role in their learning (Breen, 2001). According to Chamot
(2001), while language learning strategies have been proved to be decisive in successful
211
language learning, there is a possibility to develop them to make them more effective. This,
according to her depends on the teacher’s expertise and intervention skill.
212
Appendix V
Letter of Invitation to Participate (School Principals) (see translation below)
بسم اهللا الرحمن الرحيم
: اليوم 2003 نوفمبر: التاريخ
الثانوية / ............................................... األستاذة الفاضلة مديرة مدرسة
تحية طيبة و بعد،،و . أشكر لكم تعاونكم معي طوال فترة عملي معكم آموجهة لمادة اللغة اإلنجليزية في األعوام السابقة
آما تعلمون فإنني في الوقت الحالي أقوم بالتحضير للحصول على درجة الدآتوراة في التربية من عن عملية اللغة اإلنجليزيةعلماتم حول انطباع و ستكون األطروحة. جامعة اآستر بالمملكة المتحدة
اءة الطاقم التعليمي و لعلمي بكف. التغيير في مناهج اللغة اإلنجليزية بدولة اإلمارات العربية المتحدة .لديكم أتطلع إلى مشارآة معلمات اللغة االنجليزية بمدرستكم في البحث الميداني
أرجو السماح لي بإجراء مقابالت مع معلمات اللغة االنجليزية الالئي لديهن خبرة في تدريس و لذا واجدة في المدرسة في أيام مع العلم بأنني سأآون مت.منهاج اللغة اإلنجليزية القديم و المنهاج الجديد
إلى 2003من شهرديسمبر ) 2004-2003(معينة من آل أسبوع؛ وذلك خالل العام الدراسي الحالي . ، بما ال يتسبب في عرقلة أي من أنشطة المدرسة2004نهاية شهر يونيو
من وراء سوف أقوم بعقد اجتماع للمعلمات لعرض الهدففي البداية : و ستكون خطة البحث آالتاليو ستتم إجراء المقابالت مع المعلمات الراغبات .البحث و خطة البحث وستكون المشارآة اختيارية
ثم سأقوم بعقد اجتماعات مع المعلمات . بالمشارآة وذلك في أوقات ال تتعارض مع التزاماتهن التدريسية .زاماتهن المدرسية آذلك و بما ال يتعارض مع التالحقا حسب ما يتطلبه البحث و تحليل البيانات
بما في ذلك اسم سريةمع العلم بأنني سأحرص على أن تظل أسماء جميع من يشارك في هذا البحث
. المدرسة .أشكرآم على تعاونكم معي و أتمنى لكم دوام التوفيق
و تفضلوا بقبول فائق االحترام و التقدير،،،،فاطمة علوان/ أختك
)قا و الطالبة بجامعة اآستر بالمملكة المتحدة حالياموجهة اللغة اإلنجليزية ساب(
Translation:
In the Name of Allah, Most Gracious, Most Merciful. Date: November, 2003 Dear (principal’s name),
213
Thank you for your wonderful cooperation with me throughout my career as a supervisor of EL teachers your school. I am currently working on my doctoral studies at the University of Exeter in the UK. The topic of my dissertation centres around issues relates to teachers’ perceptions of curriculum change. As I have a prior knowledge of the high level of professionalism that the EL teachers in your school have, I would like to seek their participation in my study. I am writing to seek your kind permission to grant me access to your school to be able to collect data for my study. I plan to visit the school once a week for the period from December 2003 to June 2004. The research plan will be as follows. I need to have an initial meeting with the staff of English to explain the purpose of the study, encourage them to participate, and clarify how I intend to collect the data. Participation will be voluntary and interviews will be conducted at times that are convenient for each participant. In the end, I plan to conduct a group interview to check the data with them. I will ensure that my presence does not disturb the work in the school in any way. The names of participating schools and teachers will not be disclosed when reporting the study. Looking forward to your consent to grant me the permission to interview the teachers. Thank you for your cooperation. Yours sincerely, Fatma Alwan Ex-supervisor of English Doctoral Candidate, University of Exeter, UK.
Appendix VI
214
Address of Invitation to Participate (EL Teachers) November, 2004 Dear Colleagues, Thank you for your cooperation in accepting my invitation to this meeting. I am currently studying at the University of Exeter in the UK. My doctoral thesis is EFL teachers’ perceptions of curriculum change in the UAE. As you know, the previous curriculum materials that have been in use for more than a decade in the secondary schools were changed in the past few years including this year. In this process of change, there are things that satisfy you and there are things that do not meet your expectations. According to my experience with you throughout the past years, I feel that you have valuable views that you wish to express. I have selected your school as part of my study because I believe that you are interested in making your voice reach the people concerned. After getting the doctoral degree, I intend to join the Curriculum Development Centre in the Ministry of Education. The results of this research study will be illuminative for me to be able to put into practice what teachers look forward to. I am gathering you today to see who would like to participate in this study. The research design requires that participants be interviewed as many times as needed to elicit their views on the topic of curriculum change. Participation in the research is optional and the number of teachers participating is not an issue if some of you do not wish to be included. So, you have the right not to participate without providing reasons. However, your contribution is extremely valuable for this research as you may have important information that would enrich the findings of the study. All the data will be confidential as no one will have access to them except me. You will also get the chance to review what you say in the interview that may be recorded if you agree to. In the end, you will get a summary of the findings and my interpretations, which you may confirm or reject if you wish as well. I look forward to your agreement to participate. If, however, at any time you wish to withdraw from the study, you have the right to without apologising as I understand that you are busy professionals and participating in this type of research is a great commitment. I am grateful in advance that you will give me your valuable time and input. Kind regards Fatma Alwan (University of Exeter)
Appendix VII-A
215
Interview Schedule (First Round)
1. Can you talk about your work experience?
2. Can you tell me what in your opinion a curriculum is?
3. Can you tell me what curriculum development involves?
4. Can you explain what is meant by ‘curriculum change’?
5. What exactly changes when we say ‘curriculum change’?
6. What aspects of the curriculum makes it new? (Textbooks? Tests? Teaching
techniques?)
7. Can you tell me about the current changes in the curriculum?
8. In what aspects of the curriculum has change occurred? To what extent do you
consider this as change?
9. Do the current developments meet expectations from the field (teachers, students and
administrators)? How?
10. How do you feel about curriculum change?
11. How do you feel about having to deal with a new curriculum?
12. Do you think you are playing (or have played) a role in the process of curriculum
change?
13. Can you talk to me about the recent changes in the curriculum?
14. Do you think that the curriculum has improved? In what ways?
15. What are the current curricular developmental plans? What is your role in them?
16. Where do you see yourself in the process of curriculum change?
17. What sort of needs analysis was carried out? How do you think the needs were
specified?)
18. How do you identify the needs of your students?
19. In your opinion, what are the most pressing problems for your students as language
learners?
20. To what extent are they met in the current curriculum?
21. What is the basis on which tests are written?
22. Who produces them?
23. What is the relationship between what you teach and what you test?
216
24. Can you talk about the overall approach in the current curriculum? (What are the
characteristics of this approach?)
25. What materials are available for use by teachers?
26. How are teachers expected to deal with the material? (Teach from a textbook/select
own materials/ adapt these materials/ create their own?)
27. According to the new curriculum, in your opinion, what would be regarded as good
teaching?
28. To what extent do the curriculum materials limit/ enhance your (the teacher’s)
freedom in the classroom?
29. What is your role as a teacher in the classroom with regard to the curriculum? (What
is your current contribution to the curriculum?)
30. What else would you like to do in addition to your current roles? (What stops you
from doing this in the meantime?)
31. From your experience, what are the mechanisms within the curriculum for gathering
information? (about needs/ materials/techniques)
32. Can you tell me in what ways are these mechanisms used to improve the elements of
the curriculum on a constant basis?
33. Can you now describe your role in the curriculum? (How is it different from your role
in the former curriculum?)
34. How do you see yourself functioning in this role? (periodically/ on a daily basis)
35. How do you feel about this role?
36. To what extent are you satisfied with this role?
37. To what extent do you think that you as a teacher are playing the role you should be
playing in the curriculum?
38. What else would you like to contribute to in the of curriculum development?
39. Can you explain what is done from the part of the curriculum department to get
feedback from teachers? (With regard to: learner needs, language testing, materials
development, evaluation)
40. How do you convey your opinion to the curriculum department?
41. What aspects of the new curriculum reflect response or non-response to feedback
from you/ the field?
42. What curriculum-related recommendations do you wish to convey to the curriculum
department?
217
43. How do you plan to make them known to the curriculum department?
44. How were you prepared to deal with the new curriculum?
45. How do you feel about this training? (Suitability? Meets expectations?)
46. Can you explain to me the support, facilities and resources that are available for you
for adaptation of the curriculum?
47. What else do you recommend? ( with regard to support, facilities and resources)
48. Can you talk about the support you receive to facilitate your classroom teaching?
(administrative/ curricular)
49. What do you think of this type of support?
50. What else do you recommend?
51. Can you talk about your personal development attempts to complement training?
52. How effective do you see them in supporting your classroom teaching or your role in
the new curriculum?
53. Would you like to talk about other aspects related to curriculum change that we had
not discussed in this interview?
N.B. The above Interview questions are listed according to the order of the research questions that
they serve.
Appendix VII-A
218
Interview Schedule (Second Round)
1. Can you explain to me who has the authority to change the curriculum or to call for
curriculum change?
2. Who do you think should have the authority to call for change?
3. Can you tell me on what basis the curriculum should be changed?
4. To what extent has the new curriculum taken care of the Emirati learner’s
characteristics, such as school and classroom behaviour?
5. To what extent has the new curriculum taken care of the Emirati learner’s learning
styles?
6. To what extent has the new curriculum utilised the wider learning culture in the
UAE in the form of extra curricular activities/ supplementary material?
7. In your opinion, will the curriculum be acceptable if the exam is changed?
8. To what extent will things improve with the current curriculum if exams become
language based?
9. Can you describe your feelings when you teach the book for the first time and when
you teach it again?
10. With regard to adapting the material: how do you know that what you are doing is
effective?
11. In your opinion, what is the benchmark for checking the effectiveness of what you
do/ the way you teach?
N.B. Not all interviewees were asked all the questions in the second interview as some of them have
mentioned the relevant data in their first interview.
Appendix VIII
219
Sample Transcripts of Interviews
Interviewee (T-2)
Interviewer: Can you talk about your work experience? Interviewee: I have ten years of experience in the UAE, nine of them as a secondary school teacher.
I have taught third secondary for seven years. Interviewer: To be clear about the concept of curriculum, can you tell me what in your opinion a
curriculum is? Interviewee: Curriculum should cover text-books, activities to be done in class, extra-curricular
activities should be included. Things that I do inside the classroom and things students should do. It is not just the textbook.
Interviewer: Can you explain what is meant by ‘curriculum change’? Interviewee: Here, what changed for us is just the book. Interviewer: So, can you tell me what curriculum development involves? Interviewee: It involves not only textbooks but other aspects such as teaching techniques and tests. Interviewer: So, when we say that the curriculum has changed, what changed exactly? Interviewee: What changed in the book is the material but my responsibilities are still the same.
What should I do is still the same, exams are still the same, what changed with the textbook is the marking scheme whereas we expected that they would change the way they examine students, how we teach students. We still have to depend on testing reading, testing listening as for the skills, nothing changed. They have changed the material only but everything else is still the same.
Interviewer: How about teaching techniques? Interviewee: We are developing our teaching techniques depending on the seminars we attend. So,
we have been renewing our teaching techniques for the previous books, this is something we do for our own development. It is for self-development, it has nothing to do with the books.
Interviewer: What exactly are the current changes in the book? Interviewee: They increased the length of lessons. They have also taken out the listening texts from
the book but that is only for the third secondary. They did not put the listening texts in the Pupil’s Book, this is the only change. A lot of activities are in the new book. The new book has so many activities. They are student-centred. There is also a teacher’s book in this course, in the past we had a general teaching guide that we did not refer to. The teacher’s book gives brief suggestions of how to deal with each lesson.
220
Interviewer: If you consider these aspects that changed in the curriculum, do you see these as
change? Interviewee: Actually, it is showing off. Because these are people who think they are superior to
teachers. The people who made the book for the third secondary, I mean. They think they are superior to us, so they are showing off. The language taught is not classic English, it is mostly slang. There are points we used to teach our students as such and now they have change. For example, the functions, expressions that we have always taught as ‘advice’ are now given as ‘suggestions’ and ‘obligation’. May be this is used in the native language, but in our classical English that we were taught and that we have been teaching for years, these things were not used. Some sentences appear as slang English. As if somebody is sitting at a café talking to his friend. That is not English to be taught. If you go back to some lessons, you will find that the paragraphs in them are slang English.
Interviewer: So can you recognise areas in which the curriculum has improved? Interviewee: The texts are very interesting. They give the students information. They make students
think. It develops their thinking. It teaches students how to think. In the old textbook we didn’t have this skill. Still, it is dry, it is not essential or communicative English. You cannot feel that it is a textbook for teaching English as a language. It is an Arabic book for the Arabs, It is not authentic, you feel that it is fake, it is not authentic.
Interviewer: After several years of waiting for things to change, do you think that these changes
meet the expectations of the teachers? Interviewee: In some aspects, yes. These activities that are stuffed in the book are similar to what
we used to supplement the old books with. If we are given more time, pupils would enjoy them, but this is not the case. There are so many lessons, too many activities to be done in class. Our students are not used to working on their own. Now they need to do self-help work. Our students are used to being taught every new word in the classroom, and they expect all the activities to be carried out in class, they are not used to home assignments, especially large ones. In the previous textbooks, they were none, and the students depended mainly on teachers. If I deal with them, they will do them, if I ask them to do them as home assignment, nothing will be done. Now, with these too many activities, some activities need to be done at home but students refuse to do them. They think that the teacher is a poor manager of time and she could not cover the syllabus. For instance, there are more than two pages of texts in each lesson in the Pupil’s Book and a minimum of three pages in the workbook. This makes a minimum of five pages. How can I cover all of this in one period or two or even three?
Interviewer: So, are you saying that it partially meets the teachers’ expectations but does not meet
the expectations of the students? Interviewee: Not all changes are necessarily for the better. Yes, they have made changes, they
minimised our efforts as teachers as we used to prepare worksheets for more practice. But, the point that they have given so many exercises covering one point and few grammar practices is a problem. Why? Especially for the third secondary, I am teaching my students the first and second conditional from the start. The students say that they have learned them in first and second secondary. On the other hand, there
221
are areas of grammar that they have not tackled, why don’t they teach them this. Compared to the previous books, we are working a lot as well but to study and supplement the material. They minimised our efforts with regard to preparing worksheets as they have given us enough activities. Things we used to type and spend a lot of time preparing them. Still they maximised our efforts in search for information. There are questions that you cannot find answers in the text for. Sometimes texts and questions do not match. From where should I get the answers? I have this text with comprehension, what I check is what is based on the students’ own information and not what is in the text. There are so many incomplete ones. You as a teacher have to look, search and give the students feedback. Students are also lost. Search for what? What is the definite thing that we should search for? I do not know. The book is based on providing us with a theme, an open one and we are expected to search for information. Questions are very big, and the text itself, it is very weak. Why, because the content looks like it is based on ‘cut-and-paste’ sources.
Interviewer: How do you feel about curriculum change, then? Interviewee: Frankly speaking, when I first got the book, I was very thrilled. Why? Because after
seven years of having to teach the same old material. I was very happy. To teach the first few lessons, I was happy with surfing the internet in search of more information about the topics tackled. As the course proceeded, I discovered that there is too much to be done in a short time. I cannot cope, so what I want to ask is, those who made this book, did they have a calendar in front of them? Did they count the lesson with the days off? Did they count days on which students are absent if they fall between two holidays? Did they count the days taken for the school extra curricular activities when lessons are lost? One day they are out on a trip, another day they have an open day, then again there is another activity in which students have to participate in competitions. We miss too many lessons. Did they put in their plan that days will be cut off and there will be some occasions, why so many lessons and activities without any arrangement. And why is this redundancy? I spend fifteen lessons talking about one topic. It is too much, I do not why? They haven’t taken into consideration the circumstances in which students work.
Interviewer: Based on your experience, to what extent do you think that you as a teacher are playing
the role you should be playing in the curriculum? Interviewee: Do you mean teachers? We never did! How? Interviewer: Do you feel you are part of it? Interviewee: No, of course not. They change and they give and we take. Our role is to receive. We
are passive receptors. We just receive orders and high commands. Even we cannot cancel. The reason for this is that it is a new book. May be I decide to cancel some parts and they appear on exams. Whose responsibility is it? Who would take the responsibility? And when we asked them to do something about it. Some teachers say that we can skip what we think is unnecessary. Others say that we do not know what is important for the exam, so they say we cannot skip anything. So, do we have any role? We just teach. We are passive receptors.
Interviewer: What are the current curricular developmental plans? What is your role in them? Interviewee: They say that all these books will be cancelled and they will use a new series. I do not
know when this will happen, God only knows.
222
Interviewer: What is your role in this? Interviewee: In future change? You are asking the same question and I told you: we are not
involved. Those who are responsible for curriculum, they are in their ivory tower away , far away from the field. They do not know what we need. Even there is no contact between the curriculum centre and the schools. They are staying far faraway. I do not know why. Is it because they are superior or because nobody invited them to see how things are going in schools. Sorry to say, they do not know how it works. For curriculum development, ask those who are in the field. Ask those who daily confront problems. Ask those who daily see students, deal with students and who daily deal with their fantastic books. Why do you choose for me what to teach? If I want your help, you are a helper, why do you impose things? These textbooks, who is concerned with them, you or me? Ask me and my students first.
Interviewer: So is you consider the process of curriculum change, where do you see yourself in the
process? Interviewee: Where do I see myself? Out of the circle! Where am I? Consider me and my students.
If it were a pyramid, I am in the very very far bottom. The orders were to make a new book and we came back from our summer vacation and found the new book. Even if we were in the country, we wouldn’t be invited to say our opinions on the rough copy. The book was made, distributed. The process is distribute, teach, examine, end of story.
Interviewer: Normally, the process of curriculum change begins with needs analysis. What sort of
needs analyses were carried out for this kind of change? Interviewee: Nothing! I told you, up till February of last year we had been asking if there would be
a new book for our students who were taught book 10 and eleven and whether they would use the old book or not. When we heard from our colleagues that their old books changed into a different format in terms of long lists of vocabulary, and long texts, we asked them for the plans. Up till February until the answer came. Nobody had clear information, we have been complaining about the old book. As for the new one, nobody consulted us, nobody asked us if we wanted change what change we would like. No body offered comparing the old book with those new ones for years one and two of the secondary change in order to improve on them for the third secondary. May be there was needs analysis somewhere else but not in our zone. For us we didn’t have any, nobody asked us for our opinions of what students need or how to improve on the previous books. I do not know the basis on which the needs were specified. May be they took the views of supervisors. I have no idea. May be they consulted other people in the field, may be higher ones. May be they asked supervisors because they are our channel. When we complain about the books, we normally complain to supervisors. So may be this was the link.
Interviewer: Now that the books have changes, how do you identify the needs of your students? Interviewee: My students were very happy at the start then they complained that they had to talk
about the same theme. They were interested at first but not later on. Interviewer: And how do you know that they need some help in certain areas?
223
Interviewee: Well, when they show that they are not interested, they start to count how many pages we still have to deal with before we finish the unit. And you hear the sigh of relief when finally we reach the end of the unit. They are happy to deal with the new unit that follows but still it is the same old story again.
Interviewer: So, this is concerning their psychological or emotional need that has to do with
maintaining interest or motivation. What about their language needs? Interviewee: The language? They ask me: do we still have to talk about this subject only? For
language functions they are more concerned about testing. They are more concerned about what will be in the exam. They are not practicing the language for practicing the language, they are just using the language to pass the exam.
Interviewer: Can you clarify this point please? Interviewee: I check how they perform on the exam and try to help them in areas that they are weak
at. I know what they know and try to find a solution. There are points in the book that I wish I could omit. There are points that I feel they need more practice on. There are some very nice exercises for instance using “I wish”, and I wish I had the time and they had the time too to practice it more than just in a few sentences that come in the same format and using the same approach. And they have to use the same expression without any real practice of the structure. There is a difference between real English and realistic English. So, they are not developing their communicative skill.
Interviewer: With regard to the needs that your students have, to what extent are they met in the
current curriculum? Interviewee: There are areas that are very important that are not tackled. And there are areas that are
repeatedly tackled that are not needed. Why should I teach the past simple in unit one, unit two and unit three? What about the other tenses and structures? I have taught just a few rules this year. Now they have introduced similes, something that we teach second language students but not those who learn English as a foreign language. Another story is the vocabulary, some items are at a beginner’s level and some are very complicated and are not widely used. They learn “weather, rain..” what is this is it after eleven years of learning English.
Interviewer: How do you adapt the material to the needs of your students? Interviewee: I cannot consider any vocabulary item as passive ones as they may appear in the exam,
I mean those in the vocabulary box. I need to teach the students that the words have other meanings as well.
Interviewer: So, how do you relate what you teach to what you test? Interviewee: As for me, I teach something and when I test I follow the rule. I test them word for
word. When I teach them I teach them the words in context. The exam is a general one. As for the daily ones, I prepare them on my own or share with the other teacher using the same book. As teachers we teach students to use the vocabulary and not simply memorise it for the exam. This is a way of adapting the text to students needs. As for other parts in the exam, they are very closely related to the content of the book.
224
Interviewer: As for materials development, can you talk about the overall approach in the current curriculum? What are the characteristics of this approach?
Interviewee: I would say it’s an eclectic approach. We started using student-centred learning but as
the course proceeded, we faced many problems. There are too many tasks to be carried out, so many activities to be done. For some students, the material is not motivating. They liked some topics but with other topics, they get bored. They keep asking why the same topic is used in the whole unit in fifteen lessons. The content follows a thematic approach that does not take into consideration the students’ interests. There are minute and specific details that students do not need. What is more is that some lessons, like filling in forms use the same form that was given in a previous book. Those who put this book, didn’t they go back to the other books? I have a lesson with four different forms. Why again? If I ask the students to do them at home they fear that it would appear in the exam as functional writing and ask to do it in class. They are afraid to do things at home because they are afraid that it would appear in the exam. The problem is that what we test is greatly related to what we test. They do not accept home assignments; they are not used to doing things on their own at home. I do not blame them because in our exam, what I teach is what I test. Students are mainly concerned about exams. Now, because of lack of time, I teach using translation. I know it is useless, it is forbidden but I have no choice. The last three lessons I used this method. But I consider it a failure. How do people use it? How was it a method before? Because when I started teaching, the students could not follow. I was forced to follow this method to cover the content to make up for the days on which students were absent. Translation is not working with me, it is not teaching it is not English at all. I am so sorry to say it is against the rule to speak Arabic in the classroom; it is against the rule to use audio-lingual for a long time. I found my students lost. With this book, there should be lots of frontal teaching to be able to cover the content. I was forced to use a method I am not convinced with.
Interviewer: How are teachers expected to deal with the material? According to the new curriculum,
in your opinion, what would be regarded as good teaching? Interviewee: In the Teachers’ Book, which is supposed to guide, they do not guide you to anything.
They leave you at a loss. Things that you really need and leave you frustrated, you can’t find an answer for them in the Teacher’s Book. And things that are trivial, such as multiple choice items, they provide answers. So they give answers to some exercises- not all the exercises are answered. Only some are answered. For those you really need, you can’t find the answer to. It is left blank. In addition, the guiding steps for teaching are nothing helpful. You can find instructions such as “teach as in the previous lesson” then you go back to the previous lesson, and it refers you to another lesson and there is nothing helpful. They wrote the book, they made the cake, they know the ingredients, and you know how and when to mix and when to add. Why didn’t they give us workshops, seminars, or come to school- not all schools, let’s say make general meetings to tell us how to teach what in which way. We are teachers but they are the creators of the book and they know every piece in it.
Interviewer: This leads us to talk about how you were prepared to deal with the new curriculum. Interviewee: Nothing, Nothing! We just came to school from our vacation two days before the
students started school. The workbooks were available but the Pupil’s Books were not. Ten days later we received the book. We didn’t have any training. May be they think that because we have enough experience that we did not need the training. A
225
whole book, for one year, you are responsible to do it yourself. You are responsible for ninety students. Whether you do it right, you do it wrong, whether you were lucky to have good students or not. Whether you could manage or not. Start it. You skip it and it is in the exam and you are in problem.
Interviewer: It seems to me you are not happy with this situation. Interviewee: Of course, we had a problem with the supervisor and he was replaced. When this
supervisor came it was too late for training. Interviewer: What about support on the job? Can you explain to me the support, facilities and
resources that are available for you for adaptation of the curriculum? Interviewee: Yes if I go to ask the supervisor then he will be helpful. He helped me with testing as I
do not know what will be in the exam. I did not know what was considered functional writing and what was not. He does not have time to visit the school more often. He helped in getting us the cassettes. We need help because it is our first time to teach the material.
Interviewer: What about support from the school with regard to resources? Interviewee: Are you dreaming? Are you dreaming? Nothing from this school. We stayed one
whole month without air-conditioners in some classroom in summer, and you are talking about resources! I used to take students to an air-conditioned auditorium that was dark without lights.
Interviewer: So, what support would you like to have? Interviewee: There should be an internet service where I can show my students what I want. There
are film that I found in some sites and I would like my students to watch them. I have them on a CD anyway, so we do not have a place with the proper technology to show them to my students. It is hard to book the computer lab because the computer teachers have classes too. I would like to have facilities. In a dream school, in the Utopia, I need my own room with all the resources, a satellite T.V. and a computer. I have taped videos but do not know where to show them.
Interviewer: Now, to what extent do the curriculum materials limit or enhance your freedom in the
classroom? Interviewee: The materials sometimes enhance my freedom and at other times limit me. It depends
on the text. However, I am not free to change anything. I can teach one lesson before the other but I am not allowed to skip anything. I do change the way things are taught but I do not know if that is right. The problem in this is that I am teaching a general stage where students will have general examinations. I am limited by this fact, I am limited by the general exam. I may decide to skip the final lesson where students are asked to write summaries of the previous lessons not because they know how to do them but because if you turn the page, you will find summaries provided for them. But I do not skip anything, I want my students to learn how to write regardless of the fact that they have a ready model with them. It depends on the teacher, and what is right or wrong differs from one person to the other. What you see wrong, I may see right. Other teachers say it is completely fine to skip this part of the unit where models are offered. Who defines what is right and what is wrong? The curriculum
226
writers should decide, should make it clear to us. Anyway, I am perfectly sure that if we discuss the book with them, they will strongly defend their work.
Interviewer: Now that we are clear about with your role. What is your role in the classroom? Interviewee: Because I feel I have developed myself as a teacher, I see that I tend to minimise my
role inside the classroom. There are many activities that require the students to work on their own. There are things that they like to do but feel that they are a waste of time considering the amount of material in the syllabus that must be covered as anything may appear in the exam. The activities in the book are too many but time is too short. I see myself talking a lot. There are things that you need to induct at times. They ask me to finish the lessons and skip the activities that may not appear in the exam… In some sense, I feel that I am a social reformer as some of the activities are related to their life. For instance, there was one activity about keeping a spending journal. Based on what the students have written, I was able to advise them on how to be sensible in spending their income. It highlighted some errors that needed to be focussed upon and I was able to do this. I am also a guide when it comes to helping them to search for information on the internet, for instance. And I am a consultant when they need academic help even in matters related to health. Because if you have a unit that talks about lifestyle, the students keep asking for advice on what to do in certain situations. It is the thematic nature of the book that tends to create this role for me as a teacher. I tend to raise the awareness of the students in matters related to their lives. Add to that correction that I have to do daily for ninety students of at least three pages each. If I teach one task it means that I have to check that they have done it correctly in their workbooks.
Interviewer: So, you do play various roles. What other roles would you like to play? Interviewee: I dreamt that some of the lessons can be taught by some of my bright students on their
own. Interviewer: And what stops you from doing this? Interviewee: Information, too much information to be given, too many skills to be tackled. The
skills are integrated and there are so many activities that should be carried out in one class. How could any of them do it? And add to that that I was not trained to teach in this book, so how can the students do it?
Interviewer: What else would you like to do in terms of curriculum? Interviewee: In the first stage, I want to be consulted as a teacher. I want to have a say in what to
teach my students. I want them to ask me if the materials are suitable for the students or not, if it meets their interests or not. If they talk to the students even they will know that many topics are not interesting to deal with, and even if they were interesting, it is hard to keep the students interested in fifteen lessons talking about the same topic everyday. In the first stage, teachers and students should be consulted regarding the themes in the book… the curriculum people are sitting in their ivory tower up there.
Interviewer: And how do they get feedback about the material from teachers? Interviewee: I don’t know. May be the supervisors are the link. When we have problems we consult
the supervisor. May be the supervisors are the link… The supervisor asked us if we found something wrong in the book just to write it down. They are concerned about printing errors only. Even in the old books, they only corrected mistakes to be fair.
227
Any other changes suggested were not done. I don’t know if our feedback reaches them or not on the way up. There is something wrong with the communication with them. The channels may lead to nowhere. I do not want to be unfair about this.
Interviewer: Is your role now the same as with the old curriculum or do you see a difference in it
now? Interviewee: It is the same, nothing has changed. I am a teacher, nothing has changed. Can you
change me? Give me materials that will. I am doing the same tasks, I am preparing exams, marking them, teaching students, doing exercises and giving homework. What changed? Nothing.
Interviewer: How do you feel about this role? Interviewee: I am running away. This is the last year I am teaching. For me, that is enough. I am not
saying enough teaching because I hate teaching, I am being faced with so many frustrations…We are not free to do things the way we would like them to be done. Whatever you do, you are not appreciated. They blame everything on teachers. They say there are weak students because teachers are not working. This may be because the book is not interesting or the way the test the students is not suitable any more. We are testing memorisation. For instance, we do not test free writing because in the exam composition should be related and within what is covered in the book. We do not test comprehension because comprehension should be related. Students can predict what will appear in the daily exams…the roles I am currently playing are not what I want to do. I want to teach my students to enjoy learning. I would prefer to design my own material even if the topic is specified for me. Let them provide us with the objectives and we will prepare our materials. I can design my work. Teachers working in the UAE are very well qualified to do this as they undergo examinations in the selection process. We can design our own material. If they think that we cannot design material let them train us to do it. Why should curriculum design be central? If we have major goals to achieve now, then I do not think they will be achieved with the current books.
Interviewer: I cannot get this. Aren’t the goals stated in the teacher’s book? Interviewee: The goals are there but the trick is to carry them out. Let them make the equations
healthy. Do not make it on the basis that I teach only. I feel that I am being rushed to cover the material without achieving the goals. How can we cover this huge content other than by speeding up lessons? I pity my students. Those who stated the objectives should have considered the timing as well… I wonder why they do not ask for our opinion about the curriculum.
Interviewer: And why do you wait for them to ask? Why don’t you have the initiative? Interviewee: Initiative? What will I say? Nothing will be done. Who are we fooling? Suppose I
phoned them and told them about my opinion. My opinion is that their curriculum cannot be carried out even if I were a witch.
Interviewer: So you mean that the problem of content is the main issue, is that what you mean? Interviewee: In the previous books, that were shorter we had a problem with content.
228
Interviewer: So, you cannot recognise that there has been a response to your previous complaints about curricula.
Interviewee: May be next year. Now let’s face it, nothing can be done now. Interviewer: If I were to convey your remarks to the curriculum centre, what would you like me to
say? Interviewee: Regarding the same book? Regarding the things to be done in the future? Well, at least
cut off two units and from each unit take out at least five lessons. Interviewer: So, you want them to reduce the amount of material to be covered. Interviewee: That is number one. Second, put some active English. And third, revise the
vocabulary, especially comparing them to the previous books. Revise the English, because there are too many mistakes. This book has been mostly written by native speakers. There are mistakes in the language that need to be reconsidered. Anyway, we Arabs are so precise. May be it is natural and that the language has changed, I do not know. In addition, give us as many seminars as possible. We will cost you nothing. We are ready in our zone as we have free time for training on one of the weekdays as we teach till eleven o’clock. We have several venues. Why not they make seminars during working time? Definitely, there must be people in the curriculum centre who can market the book, do the training, collect feedback and so on. There might be points in the book that I do not know. May be they can show me how to deal with them.
Interviewer: And how are you planning to convey your opinion to the curriculum centre? Interviewee: I have a list of negative points listed by one of the teachers in another school. I called
so many teachers to ask for their opinion and that is how I got the paper. Interviewer: Now let’s talk again about professional development. What are your personal
development attempts to complement training? Interviewee: I attend conferences and workshops arranged by TESOL Arabia. I also give staff
presentations, present at some conferences in addition to reading in the area of foreign language teaching.
Interviewer: How effective do you see these personal development activities in supporting your
classroom teaching or your role in the new curriculum? Interviewee: They have developed my awareness of what I need to improve in my performance. I
have changed my teaching techniques. I tend to use more student-centred activities whenever possible. I stopped spoon-feeding them. This is because of seminars and workshops. I have searched for the best ways of teaching listening, and now I adopt a method that I find helpful with my students.
Interviewer: Have you realised the effect of this on your students’ learning or motivation for
example? Interviewee: Yes, of course, their motivation is enhanced. Even for myself, it is extremely
motivating to try new teaching techniques in class because it is a change. I feel also
229
that my students are happy when they carry out new activities that they are not used to doing before.
Interviewer: Are there other aspects in the curriculum that you would like to talk about and we have
not covered? Interviewee: No, but what I want to emphasise is that the UAE with all its resources should test the
curriculum before introducing it to schools. They spend too much, let the resources be spent in schools. A new textbook requires piloting the material, training teachers and evaluating the product. How can a course book be prepared in four months? If they want to develop the curriculum, they have to do what is required of them. If a job is worth doing, it is worth doing it right.
Interviewer: Thank you for participating in this research. …….. Interviewer: What do you know about the curriculum document? Interviewee: What’s that? Interviewer: A document that states the objectives of the curriculum. Interviewee: (laughing) another question, please! Interviewer: This means you haven’t seen it. Interviewee: Who am I to see it? I told you I am out of it. Interviewer: Who do you think has the authority to call for curriculum change? Interviewee: No idea! Really, I don’t know. Interviewer: And who do you think should have the authority to ask for change in curricula? Interviewee: We teachers should have the right to ask for change. Interviewer: On what basis should change be called for? Interviewee: Depending on the students’ needs. Another issue that makes change necessary is when
there are too many problems with the curriculum and the results of the students show deterioration in standards.
Interviewer: I agree with you. With regard to the current curriculum, you talked earlier about the
weaknesses of the students. Has the new curriculum taken into consideration the weaknesses of the students?
Interviewee: No, there is no evidence of this in the books. Consider for instance the length of texts.
Texts are too long, there are too many new vocabulary items that are not required for the exam but they are necessary for understanding the texts. The words are so essential to understanding that without them, the students wouldn’t get the meaning. The students find it hard to follow up. This is ridiculous. I try to avoid translation and make the students guess the words from examples that I give, as the context does not
230
show the meanings most of the time. It is higher than their level. Do you know that one lesson takes four pages of the book and five pages of the workbook? We have to rush to cover it. Yes, the book is full of pupil-centred activities but it’s too long. It teaches them critical thinking but still, the exam is based on memorisation.
Interviewer: In your opinion, will the curriculum be acceptable if the exam is changed?
Interviewee: That will be reasonable. Consider reading comprehension for instance. Comprehension
implies that students read and comprehend. What is the point when I give a reading comprehension text in the exam that is related to something the students already know? What’s the comprehension in it?
Interviewer: To what extent will things improve with the current curriculum if exams become
language based?
Interviewee: To some extent, we will not be obliged to cover the entire book. But still, it needs
modifications; it needs to be reduced to fit the given time. Interviewee: (T-6) Interviewer: Can you tell me about your work experience? Interviewee: I have more than 15 years of Experience. I worked in a private school in the UAE for
two years before joining the Ministry 1991. I worked in Umm Al Qaiwain for 5 years. Then I transferred to this zone and have been working in the secondary stage for 9 years. I have experience in both preparatory and secondary stages, the old curriculum and the new one.
Interviewer: Can you tell me what in your view a curriculum is? Interviewee: It’s the syllabus. It is something designed. What I like my students to know to be able
to communicate in English. It is what is in the books and what helps us convey the message.
Interviewer: And can you explain what is meant by ‘curriculum change’? Interviewee: It means changing the course materials that we teach. When something changes, it
means, of course that it becomes better. Here, this doesn’t seem to be true. Interviewer: What changes when a curriculum changes? Interviewee: Here the methods of teaching didn’t change. According to our life, I think everything
changes. As teachers, we pursue change and development. But according to the ministry, they only design the book, but they didn’t tell us how to teach it. So, they have changed only the curriculum, the material itself, the book.
Interviewer: Can you tell me what curriculum development involves?
231
Interviewee: This includes improving the current textbooks. Of course, we should ask teachers who are working in the area or the field because they know which is good for students, what makes students communicate better. So, teachers should be asked before. Of course, we should change the material in a useful way that enables the students to communicate in English. But what happens in reality is that the books remain without improvement and when they are changed, they are changed without consulting teachers.
Interviewer: What aspects of the curriculum make it new? Interviewee: I am currently teaching the first and the second secondary, book 10 and book 11.
When you teach every year one new book it is a big burden. Interviewer: So, how do you feel that you have two books to teach? Interviewee: I enjoy my time when I prepare a new lesson. I find up-to-date information in this
book. But if I teach a new book every year, I feel it is tiring. When you take a new book, you prepare everything. You do not prepare only the lesson but also the aids that you are going to use. The aids themselves take a long time to prepare. PowerPoint, drawings, pictures, OHTs and the lesson plans. It takes a long time and effort from the teacher. It will be tiring if you move every year to a new syllabus.
Interviewer: According to the new curriculum, what would be regarded as good teaching? Interviewee: The textbook doesn’t give us any way of teaching. It depends on the teacher and his or
her own way of teaching. Of course, the teacher should develop new ways every time. We cannot teach in the same way every day. Teachers should develop themselves and look for up-to-date methods.
Interviewer: And how do you develop yourself? Interviewee: Of course, I attend conferences, meetings, workshops, I am a member in TESOL
Arabia. I subscribe to the FORUM magazine. I am a regular conference delegate. I also use the internet to look for new ways of teaching.
Interviewer: How effective do you see your personal development attempts in supporting your
classroom teaching or your role in the new curriculum? Interviewee: I apply everything I read about or I attend. What’s the benefit If I don’t? Of course, if
there is a workshop on improving my teaching, I do apply what I learn. If there are ways of motivating students, I also use them. When I find new ways of teaching stories or dialogues, I apply them in my class. I find varieties of ways of teaching. Of course, this helps in improving the quality of learning that my students have.
Interviewer: And we say that the curriculum has changed and you said that it meant that the
material has changed. Has anything else changed? Interviewee: Only the materials. The way of examining the students, for example, remained the
same. So, it does not differ. We were teaching the old curriculum and now we are teaching the new one but we are still examining them in the same way as in the old curriculum. There was no change at all. Even the teaching techniques, you can say that they remained the same except for teachers to use new ways on their own.
232
Interviewer: In general, how do you feel about curriculum change? Interviewee: I find the books better than before. The change became better. Book 10 for example,
which is for the first secondary is better than the old book for the same class. But the way the information are displayed in the book should be more enjoyable. All the books, even book 11, which is better than book 10..but all the lessons go in a routine way: listen, read and answer all the time. There is no variety in the way of displaying information. This is number one. There should be the skill of making dialogues. There should be exercises which urge them to speak more than they do now. I think also the marking scheme should not have 50 for oral and 50 for written. 50 on oral is too much in evaluation it should be less, say 30, for example, like in the preparatory stage. Of course, we should have oral exams too. Sometimes you find there are girls who are good at speaking and they are bad in writing. And, bearing in mind we are teaching a language, we should measure other ways of communicating than writing, I mean other skills too. Not only writing information that they have studied by heart. We find ourselves teaching for exams, not for communication. So, we train students to answer the questions that may appear in the exam. We have a huge syllabus. The teacher’s job from the beginning of the year is to finish this syllabus. There are too many lessons, too many words, too many structures. So, the teacher has to teach all of this. If you want your students to be good at English, to communicate well, we this shouldn’t be the case. We often read in newspapers that students in government schools are not as good as students in private schools when communicating in English. This is because of the curriculum itself. It doesn’t give us time to teach students how to speak, or how to communicate to each other. Because you are teaching, even in the new curriculum, you find that the lesson comes in three pages in the pupils’ book and even more in the workbook. Although the new curriculum is better than the last one. Why do we have to teach too many words in one line, for instance? In one line, there were 6 new words in one of the lessons.
Interviewer: To what extent do you consider the current change in the curriculum as real change? Interviewee: I am not saying that changes in the books are not real changes. But you can find a
similarity in topics between the two curricula. The same topics are repeated but using different texts. The same units had the same names before: agriculture, jobs and careers, .. you can find these in the old curriculum every year. Every year, they have been examined on how to apply for a job. Also in the new curriculum, you see the same letter, the same unit, the same topics. May be different texts but the same topics. Another fact is that we cannot find connection between units. Each unit is not related to the unit before. All units should have a link among them. They should be connected together with one binding theme. Here we have 6 units, each one is totally separate from the other one.
Interviewer: When we want to change curricula, there should be defined steps. Interviewee: Of course. Interviewer: To what extent are you playing the role you should be playing in curriculum change? Interviewee: Of course, they did not follow any definite steps when they changed the previous
curriculum. They gave it to us and we have to teach it. They didn’t ask any teacher about…I do not know if they asked other teachers in other schools. I don’t know, but
233
nobody asked us about the syllabus. Nobody asked us about the curriculum and what we want.
Interviewer: Where do you see yourself in the process of curriculum change? Interviewee: I am only a teacher. I am teaching what they give me. Interviewer: So, where do you see yourself in the process of curriculum change? Interviewee: A teacher only. I am going to do what I am required to do. My job here in the process
of curriculum change is teaching. I am only a teacher. I am a doer. I am going to do what I am required to. What I have to do: teaching. Teaching what is with me, like someone who is hungry and he has a sandwich. He has to eat only this sandwich, he has no variety, he has no choice. When we have attended the last conference with TESOL Arabia (CTELT 2003) all the lectures were on how to prepare your own exam as a teacher, how to correct your own exam as a teacher using the internet and the computer. What can we do? What benefit we can get if we are not free to apply what we learned? We have to produce the exams following specifications given by the ministry.
Interviewer: Are you saying you don’t have any hand in… Interviewee: I don’t have any hand in designing the exam. I have to write questions according to the
rubrics that we have. They designed it for us and I have to teach that they have prepared for us.
Interviewer: So your role is minimised to teaching, is that what you mean? Interviewee: Yes. I am just a teacher. Interviewer: What is your role as a teacher of the curriculum? Interviewee: Of course, as a teacher, I do everything. I am a prompter, I explain the materials, I
prepare my own aids. I prepare my OHTs, CDs with PowerPoint presentations. I do everything the curriculum needs. I play the role of an examiner. I have to prepare my own exams, according to the rubrics specified. I am a facilitator, trainer, coach, everything. I have to do everything in class.
Interviewer: So, you have a big role to play in the classroom.. Interviewee: And outside the classroom. Interviewer: What else do you do outside the classroom? Interviewee: I am responsible for a class. I have to collect all the grades-books from all the teachers
of this class for all subjects. I have to revise them and prepare report-cards. I have also to supervise outside activities in the school. I participate for celebrations on special occasions. I have a duty once a month to watch the girls at the end of the school day. I wait till they are all gone by buses or driven by their parents. Teaching has become a very hard job. As a teacher, you have to seek development beside the daily work. My time for school is not from 7 AM to 2 PM for school, it has to continue at home. I have to complete my work at home. All my time is for teaching.
234
Interviewer: I agree with you on this. But how do you feel about this role? Interviewee: Of course, I want to be only a guide to my students. I want the Ministry of Education
to help us, to prepare us some workshops or seminars that help us. If you are teaching a new syllabus, they should prepare training for teachers on this new syllabus. Instead of running outside and paying our own money on training and development, we need training. If they want to improve the students, they have also to help in developing the teachers.
Interviewer: What sort of training did you get for first and second secondary? Interviewee: I didn’t get anything. They didn’t prepare any training for us. They have just given out
the material without preparing a training course. I told you we have to look, to search for training courses anywhere. Last year we attended the training courses that were designed for new teachers in Zayed University, because we are seeking to learn anything. This refreshes our experience. Why not they prepare training courses.
Interviewer: What support do you get for adaptation of the curriculum then? Interviewee: There isn’t any support. I told you that I have to look for everything. There are no
teaching aids even. Even the teacher’s book is not of help to us. It doesn’t give any help to the teachers. You have to find the most suitable way for teaching by yourself, so that you can motivate the students to work with you. All the lessons are presented in the same routine in the book. The students get bored if we do the same that is required in the book. Even the listening, not all the lessons should be made for listening. In book 12, it is better, they have different listening passages. I think it is better than the one we are teaching. The listening texts are short and are not included in the textbook. Not all the texts are listening, what’s the benefit they get from this?
Interviewer: How are you expected to deal with the materials available? Interviewee: Of course, sometimes I modify a task. For instance, in book 10, there is a lesson about
the internet in lesson 2 and in unit three there is a lesson about the internet, so I have to modify and give this lesson after giving unit 3. There are two parts of one story in different units, I teach them in one week. By the way, although the book is into its third year, the picture has an additional family member not in the story.
Interviewer: Have you sent your remark to the curriculum centre? Interviewee: I didn’t teach it on its first year. Our colleagues must have given them their feedback.
Anyway, you can find long texts, a lot of words. If you are teaching a story, is it logical to have too many new words in it? In the first secondary, there are four units in each term. This is too much. There are too many structures: passive voice, reported speech, making questions, reporting statements, conditional ‘if’ , connective,…everything. You can find all structures in the first unit. Instead of teaching them real language for communication, you have to teach them structures. Even the functions should be taught in context and they are not. In each lesson, you can find two new functions. Sometimes you can find two or three functions. So there is a long list of functions.
Interviewer: You mean there is too much to cover and you can’t cancel anything.
235
Interviewee: Book 11 is fine because it has three units. We finished it without any stress or tension. But in book 10 there are 4 units and we must finish them on time before the exam. So, it takes a long time.
Interviewer: I understand this is your second year of teaching Book 11. Interviewee: No, this is the first year to teach book11 and the second year to teach book 10. Last
year, book 10 was new for me. This year book 11 is new for me. Interviewer: And have you sent any recommendations to the curriculum centre? Interviewee: No. Interviewer: Aren’t they asking for feedback every year? Interviewee: No, the first year only. Interviewer: In your opinion, what is the overall approach in the book? Interviewee: It is not mainly organised according to coherent and linked themes. You can find no
connection between the units. The units should be connected. They should depend on one theme that links all the units. Even when we consider structures or functions. You cannot find any gradual progression.
Interviewer: To what extent do the curriculum materials limit or enhance your freedom in the
classroom? Interviewee: Of course, it limits me. I have to finish. I have the amount of material. The content is
too huge so I have to finish them. I am required to finish the syllabus because the students are going to be examined in this material. So, I have to finish the syllabus, this is number one. But I have to train them for the exam.
Interviewer: And what is the relationship between what you teach and what you test? Interviewee: Of course, I teach for exams. Really, I teach for exams because the students have to
learn all the information by heart. When I explain a new structure or I give them a new rule, they have to learn it by heart. When I give them new functions, they have to learn them by heart. When they have a new topic, they should be trained to write by themselves. I train them on how to write by themselves. But still there are students who are weak who do not know how to write. They try to learn by heart the composition paragraph that we have done.
Interviewer: Do you give extra materials that are not meant for the exam? Interviewee: There is no time to give them something else. I have to give them something which is
related to the exam. If I finish the syllabus at the end of the term it will be something that I dream of.
Interviewer: What else would you like to do in addition to this? Interviewee: I would like to give something else. I would like to train them to read newspapers in
English, read magazines and works of literature. I want them to learn language for communication. If we want to do this we have to finish the syllabus before. If you
236
finish the syllabus, you can’t find time to do extra work and if you decide to do this for warming up, you will find that you don’t have time to complete your syllabus. You know that we sometimes take extra classes to finish the syllabus. We don’t depend on the six classes that we have every week. Sometimes we come on hour earlier to school to give extra classes before the school day begins. Sometimes we come on Thursday (the weekend) to give extra lessons. In the meantime, we stay two hours more after the school day ends just to give extra classes to finish the syllabus. The main problem is that the syllabus is stuffed. We have to finish it. We have no time to teach the students how to teach the language. We cannot cancel anything as it might appear in the exam.
Interviewer: Are there any mechanisms for collecting feedback about the curriculum? Interviewee: Nobody contacts us; we know just the names on the book cover. Interviewer: Is your role in the new curriculum the same or different from your role in the old
curriculum? Interviewee: The same of course, it didn’t change. Interviewer: And how do you see yourself functioning in this role? Interviewee: I am not happy about my role because I am the instructed slave. I have to do what I am
told to do; I have to do what I am required to do. I don’t find a way to do what would benefit my students, like reading literature.
Interviewer: So, you’re saying that you are not satisfied with it. Interviewee: Of course I am not. Interviewer: What recommendations do you have in this regard? Interviewee: Of course teachers should be asked before changing the curriculum…what they need,
we should give a curriculum that helps in teaching the foreign language in a better way. It should contain less material, less new vocabulary. We should give them something to learn from literature, poems, novels. This way it helps improve their language and their critical ability. We should have dialogues and students should prepare their own dialogue. This helps the students to communicate in real life situations.
Interviewer: What are the current curricular development plans? Interviewee: I have heard that they are going to bring a new curriculum. Of course we are
astonished because this is a new curriculum. This curriculum took a long time of us to prepare them and the aids for them. This took a lot of time from us. You cannot teach without aids. English is normally difficult for students to understand. They find it difficult. So, you need something to make it easier. So it took a long time and too much effort to prepare the needed aids for the new books. Now, how do they give us a new book this year and they change it on the following year?
Interviewer: But you said you were not happy with the new curriculum.
237
Interviewee: Yes, I am not very happy with it but it is tiring to see books change very quickly… I think they will bring a ready-made set of books from Britain. It will be better because this is their language.
Interviewer: And what will your role be in the curricular developmental plans? Interviewee: If I played any role before, I would play a role in the coming one, but I haven’t played
any role. I do not expect they will change the way they work. Interviewer: Do you think teachers are playing the role they should be playing in curriculum
change? Interviewee: No, teachers are not given a chance to participate in any change. They are only
teaching what is in their hands. Interviewer: And what recommendations do you have in this regard? Interviewee: If I am asked to contribute to the curriculum, I want to give my opinions with regard to
the needs of the children. I want also to prepare materials for my students according to their needs. Only teachers know what their students are in need of. I want to be given new materials which are suitable for the students. I want to be consulted to check that the materials are suitable before they reach the students. I also want to give feedback on the books and see that the books are modified accordingly.
Interviewer: Is there any way for you to contact the curriculum centre concerning your feedback? Interviewee: Of course they should contact us. We don’t know who they are. We do not know the
way to reach them. Do you think that if I get their phone number and ask them to take into consideration what to change they will respond? They will say who is this teacher? Who is this intruder?
Interviewer: So, what curriculum-related recommendations do you have? Interviewee: Of course, teachers should be asked before they write the books. But if they are going
to bring a ready-made syllabus, we are not going to have a hand in it. But if they are going to prepare the books locally, they should ask teachers their experiences. What is suitable for the girls, what makes them better.
Interviewer: You mean the needs of the students. Interviewee: Yes, they should also prepare some aids which help us like video tapes, CDs, posters,
cards and so on. There should be aids. Teachers should not be left to prepare the teaching aid. We should be given everything that facilitates classroom teaching.
Interviewer: You said before there was no needs analysis to find out the needs of the learners. Interviewee: There should be materials prepared for the excellent students. Also there should be
materials for weak students. The teacher has to do these things. Interviewer: What are the most pressing problems for your students as language learners? Interviewee: They are weak at communication. They cannot prepare their own questions; they
cannot make up a dialogue.
238
Interviewer: To what extent are these needs met in the curriculum? Interviewee: No. There are also structures. Even functions, they are a good way of communication
but the way of testing functions is very bad. This makes them study all expressions by heart. When we correct the exam papers we need to check the answers against the book…Even if we consider writing, the writing task does not help them a lot. The vocabulary comes in very long lists of new words. They have to learn them by heart. Students find that it is difficult for them to study English. When I ask them to explain why they are weak they say that they cannot understand English. They also say that they do not like English. They find it difficult to study English, so they are not going to study because it is difficult for them to read English on their own. Of course, this weakness has been accumulated.
Interviewer: To what extent does the curriculum attempt to remedy this weakness? Interviewee: It doesn’t. The weakness is still there. The curriculum doesn’t help. Interviewer: You see that there are needs that your students have that are not answered in the
books. On what basis were the needs specified then? Interviewee: I don’t know on what basis they are preparing the books. I don’t know how they define
the goals even. Some stories are translated from Arabic to English. I am with giving Arabic stories but the way they are given. There is for example a very long story with a lot of new words. You think that the events are not connected too. I am with giving such stories but in a very simple way.
Interviewer: What support, facilities and resources are available for you for adaptation of the
curriculum? Interviewee: Photocopying is available for exams but we have to type them for ourselves. We don’t
have internet here and the library is not very helpful as a resource. Interviewer: What do you think of this type of support? Interviewee: They are trying their best. The school provides us with a room for the English club.
We have a data show. This device enables us to use PowerPoint lessons. But the library needs more books that help the students. But the students have no time to go to the library to look for information. I think that most students have internet at home but they don’t have time to find information on the internet because they have to study, study and study to finish their subjects. All the other subjects are stuffed too. Students don’t have time to read for enjoyment. They have no time to read for improving their level. They have no time to practice their hobbies too.
Interviewer: What else do you recommend with regard to resources? Interviewee: They have to reduce the amount of content first, the number of units, vocabulary and
structures. Interviewer: What else do you recommend as support to your teaching? Interviewee: As we can find in some schools in another zone, we want special well-equipped
classes for each of the teachers of English. I would like ready-made teaching aids.
239
Even for photocopying, sometimes you find the machine out of order. We spend on photocopying outside the school. Even the basic equipment is not available for us, like the tape recorder. We have to buy our own recorders. I know that the school is not supported well by the ministry. They cannot afford to supply the needs for all the subjects. Take for example the computer in the English club, it is old. Sometimes you prepare a wonderful lesson on PowerPoint at home but you cannot use it at school as it is not compatible with the old version at school. It does not display our work it is only Windows 95. We have to buy a new computer. How? There is no budget for the school. The school bought a data show for the staff. We need a lot of things to help us do our job. We need a class, with everything the teacher needs.
Interviewer: Thank you for participating in this research, would you like to talk about other aspects
related to curriculum change that we had not discussed in this interview? Interviewee: No, I think we have discussed everything important. ….. Interviewer: Can you explain to me who has the authority to change the curriculum or to call for
curriculum change? Interviewee: I don’t know. Interviewer: Who do you think should have the authority to call for change? Interviewee: The teachers are the only people who deal with the curriculum and they know about its
problems and the students’ needs. Teachers always look for the better, so they should be entitled to ask for change in the curriculum.
Interviewer: What idea do you have about the curriculum document? Interviewee: I don’t know. I have seen only the textbooks. Interviewer: To what extent has the curriculum taken into consideration the characteristics of the
learners that you mentioned previously? Interviewee: We can find only lessons. We cannot find anything that satisfies the learners. For
example, the students are not motivated to learn. As I said before, our goal is to cover the syllabus. We do our best to make the lessons look interesting. We cannot do anything else to motivate the students like bringing our own material. Still, the problem is that it is stuffed. It doesn’t give us way to give extra material that interest the students and meet their needs. We are limited by the exam too.
Interviewer: Suppose they changed the format of the exam into a language-based one, to what
extent will the current curriculum be acceptable? Interviewee: I think this will not be enough. The curriculum itself should improve. Tests that
evaluate language proficiency are welcome but still the books do not satisfy the students’ needs. It doesn’t qualify the students to sit for such an exam.
Interviewer: You have taught one of the books twice. Can you talk about the experience when you
first teach the book and when you teach it a second time?
240
Interviewee: Of course, in the second year, you will try to add more. If you prepare some aids, you can use them, it will not be tiring like when you teach it for the first year. In the first year, you begin from zero. You don’t have any teaching aids, so you have to prepare every thing by yourself. So when you teach the book for the first year. You find it tiring because you need to prepare aids, worksheets…everything. When you teach it for the second year, you have already your own aids and you can add more things.
Interviewee: (T-10) Interviewer: Can you tell me about your work experience? Interviewee: I have been teaching in the UAE for twelve years in secondary schools. I have changed
schools in which I teach. Change in life is very important. Change means difference. Interviewer: Can you tell me what in your opinion a curriculum is? Interviewee: Curriculum is the ideas, topics and lessons you teach in a school. The material we
teach to the students. Interviewer: Can you tell me what curriculum development involves? Interviewee: Curriculum development is improving the books. It is not necessary to teach so many
items of new vocabulary. It is necessary to discuss nice ideas. When developing the curriculum, they should pay attention to students’ interests. What they like. Go to schools and ask them what they like. If they like something, they will learn it. I have a criticism on book 10. The first two days they felt it was too boring. We tried to teach it in a very interesting way but they didn’t like it. The way teachers present the curriculum should be done in a model way.
Interviewer: We say that the curriculum has changed, so what do we mean by curriculum change? Interviewee: The curriculum changes giving us more interesting topics in the books. The topics are
really more interesting, not like the old one. You can feel the new developments in the country through this curriculum. There are topics like internet, GM food, ..the topics are varied and interesting at the same time, not boring.
Interviewer: This means you approve of the topics discussed in the book. Interviewee: Yes, the topics are fine but not the way they are presented. The amount of vocabulary,
no. The amount of functions, no. It is very hard to teach them. The texts are too long, the vocabulary lists are too long.
Interviewer: Was this the same in the old curriculum? Interviewee: Concerning the old curriculum, the topics were not interesting at all. Some topics were
useless. There are certain lessons that I did not like throughout the eight years I taught the books. But now the topics are very very interesting but the way of presenting them, I do not feel that I am teaching a language. I am just giving them information: study, write, do...they don’t have time to practise.
Interviewer: Was this the same in the old curriculum?
241
Interviewee: Yes, the same for structures for the first and the second secondary, I didn’t teach the third secondary. For the first secondary, in the old book, there was no time for students to practise the language they are learning. And as I told you the topics were very traditional and not interesting and so on. Now, they are more interesting and more attractive, but there is no time at all to cover them well. For example, there are 23 new vocabulary items, for one lesson. That is in the new curriculum, Ok, the lesson is very interesting, but how can I teach 23 new words in it? Really, I couldn’t cover it in a proper way. I found difficulty in presenting the lesson. How many words can an ordinary child learn in one lesson? Let’s say 4, 5, 6, 7? 23? I wanted to divide the lesson but I had no time. Another instance is a letter, which I have given in an interesting way but try to read the letter yourself. Many teachers complained about it.
Interviewer: Did you teach this book last year? Interviewee: No, this is the first year I teach it. As for the first secondary, I have been teaching it for
three years. Interviewer: So you are teaching two books for this year. Can you describe your feelings when you
teach a book for the first time and when you teach it again? Interviewee: It is not the same feeling. This time I feel lost, there is too much to cover. Anyway, the
1st secondary is a different case, I have taught it for three times but I have the same problem every time. I feel it is very difficult to present the many words in every lesson. The second secondary is more interesting. The book is less by two units and this makes it easy to finish within the given time. Yes, the curriculum is new to me but it gives me less trouble, I don’t know may be this is because I am teaching the scientific section. One class is an exception, but till now I feel lost in the first secondary. I feel that I can’t cover all the lessons in a proper way, in a way that the students will get the benefit, I mean. Of course not all all the areas I mean but most of the time. On the other hand, I can now mange the time. As usual, the first year, I don’t do lots of extra activities. The first year is for teaching the curriculum but my creativity appears in the second year. In the third, I am also more active. But I expect to be bored in the fourth year that I need to change what I am teaching.
Interviewer: In general, how do you feel about curriculum change? Interviewee: We need it really. Even I am talking about the difficulties in the first secondary but I
enjoyed it. Imagine what it feels to be teaching the same book for ten years to two or three classes each year. The old curriculum has been the same in schools for more than ten years. The topics were traditional whereas interests of students have changed over time.
Interviewer: What aspects of the curriculum make it new? Interviewee: Actually it is just the textbook. Interviewer: What about the teaching techniques? Interviewee: The teaching techniques changed a little bit because of the nature of the tasks in the
book but you can say they are actually the same. Interviewer: In what way is the new curriculum different from the old one?
242
Interviewee: Just with regard to the topics, the topics are now more interesting. But if you consider the new books, for the first semester, our students have 22 kinds of functions. This is too much for the students. Why do we do this to our students? We don’t hate them actually to make them suffer.
Interviewer: Isn’t it a kind of revision? Interviewee: No, we can’t say revision. In addition, we cannot focus on the negative aspects of the
curriculum alone, even our students have many problems actually. They are irresponsible; they cannot remember what they learned in the previous year. They keep saying last year our teacher didn’t do so and so even if you yourself were their teacher the year before. But 22 types of functions or expressions are too much for our students. And most of these functions are new.
Interviewer: Do the current developments meet the expectations from the field? Interviewee: No. As I told you, I was happy with the change of topics and lessons but with the
needs of our students in mind, the change doesn’t give them anything. And I didn’t feel a difference between students who learned English from first primary and those who learned it from four primary in the old curriculum. Where is the problem here? May be there is a little change that cannot be mentioned…the curriculum should meet the expectation of teachers and students but now it doesn’t. I prefer a little amount in each lesson to give the chance to my students to read, to answer, to role play and do many activities better than giving them a hundred vocabulary items in a few lessons. I think the benefit will be better if the content is less.
Interviewer: Do you think you are playing or have played a role in the process of curriculum
change? Interviewee: I remember once we had a visiting committee from the ministry, that was may be 5
years ago when I was in a different school. They asked us about the curriculum and I told them that there was a clear gap between one book and another. The gap between the first and the second secondary in the old curriculum was very big. The first secondary book was more difficult. And I told them about the lessons which were useless and I showed them examples. So, we gave our ideas about the books. We were not satisfied. And we told them why.
Interviewer: Was this a regular mechanism in the ministry to evaluate the curriculum through visits
to schools? Interviewee: No, it wasn’t a regular mechanism, it was done only once…but we normally write the
comments when we are asked to. Interviewer: Following that evaluation, have you seen any improvement in the old books during the
subsequent years? Interviewee: No, there was no change of any sort but may be they were thinking. They were
thinking of changing and may be our ideas convinced them. Interviewer: But has anyone come to your school to ask you about the new books? Interviewee: No, you are the first person to ask us about the books.
243
Interviewer: If we consider the process of curriculum change, where is your part in it? Interviewee: As a teacher I would love to be considered the leader in curriculum change. But
currently...I prepare extra materials and ask my students to do the same too. I encourage them to search on the internet to learn more about the topics they are studying. They have a special notebook that they divide into different sections to include the different aspects of the language. And this is what we miss in the new curriculum, why don’t we divide the work. If you ask students to study structures, they do not understand what structures include. Why don’t they divide the book for them into different sections? In one lesson, they have structures, vocabulary, functions… they don’t know what to do. I mean, let us divide the book into sections. And grammar, I learned English in this way in Syria. Grammar was at the end of the book. In this way, you know what grammar is but you are giving the lesson, giving the new vocabulary. In the workbook, you have grammar, after this you have functions, you explain them and the students are confused.
Interviewer: I didn’t get what you mean, do you mean that you don’t like the book to be organised
around themes and that you prefer a structural or a functional approach? Interviewee: That is what I mean. I want the book to be divided into sections. Students are dying to
buy extra commercial pamphlets that have such divisions. They have the same information in the book arranged in order.
Interviewer: Was this the same problem in the old curriculum? Interviewee: Yes, it was the same. Sometimes you had one exercise with five rules of grammar. Our
students will never learn grammar in this way. Grammar needs to be explained for them. For one rule of grammar, I need sometimes two lessons to explain it for them and make them practise it. We cannot say this is revision, they don’t remember anything. Unfortunately, they don’t remember anything. This is a problem, also we don’t want to make a generalisation but there are just a few bright students who can remember.
Interviewer: And what do you think is the cause of this problem that they forget easily what they
learn? Interviewee: They neglect their school work, that is why they forget what they learn. They don’t
study. If they study the lessons on the same day just for a short time, they will remember what they learn. But the situation here is that they shut the book after the lesson and that’s all. How will they remember the next day even? And with this amount of new vocabulary? If they don’t revise their lessons daily, how will they learn?
Interviewer: So, the students have certain needs. Was there any needs analysis carried out before
preparing the new curriculum? Interviewee: No, nothing. Interviewer: How do you identify the needs of your students? Interviewee: Actually there are many ways for learning about students’ needs. I discover them
through daily participation, in their exams. Sometimes I ask them directly to say what specific areas they need help in. They have many problems, social problems...I love
244
my students; I maintain a friendly relationship with them. I am not only their teacher, I also advise them on other aspects of their lives. I try all the time to lead them to the right way.
Interviewer: And do you think the book meets your students’ needs? Interviewee: Not at all. They are burdened even with the amount of vocabulary they should learn. Interviewer: What are the current curricular developmental plans? Interviewee: I heard a rumour that I don’t like. If the books will change then it will be OK, I heard
that they will change it with a readymade curriculum. This affected our way of preparing the lessons. If I know that the books will not change, I will prepare more resources and teaching aids to use with the current books. But I stopped, why should I work on a dead curriculum? It doesn’t mean I didn’t do anything at all but I have now a plan, if there is a fixed curriculum, I will try to do certain things for the books. I may distribute the work to other schools too. The way I am preparing each lesson is unique. I try to prepare each lesson in a creative way with the necessary worksheets and transparencies. But since they are saying the books will change, why should I work on a dead curriculum? Especially that I am teaching two books. So, I work on preparing resources but to a limited extent. The new curriculum makes my imagination soar. I like the topics.
Interviewer: In the process of curriculum change, what is your role in the development plans? Interviewee: I just teach what they give me to teach but try my best to present them in the best
possible way. I don’t think that the lessons will be more difficult to present than the current ones.
Interviewer: So, there was no kind of needs analysis when the books were prepared. On what basis
were the needs specified then? Interviewee: I don’t know. I have no idea actually but as I told you I find it dense. It is full as if
students are a sack to fill. I feel the students are like this. There are lessons that are really hard to present as they are complicated and full of new words.
Interviewer: In your opinion, what are the most pressing problems for your students as language
learners? Interviewee: They are de-motivated, they forget very quickly too. In addition, our students are
divided into two sections there are UAE nationals and there are expatriates. When we consider locals, we don’t find that they have interest in learning. There are a few exceptions but nationals are not like expatriates and I find this a burden. Some mothers are not educated, I find this a problem. I am a teacher. I myself find difficulty following up my children, so how can an uneducated mother follow up her children?
Interviewer: And the language problems? Interviewee: The language problems? Pronunciation, listening is very bad. They are not clear at all.
And even the students hate them. Sometimes I force them to listen, but most of the time I give them the lessons as reading comprehension…they are also weak in structures and forget them easily.
245
Interviewer: To what extent are these needs met in the curriculum? Interviewee: No, they aren’t. For example, there are too many structures that do not allow for
practise as the material is too big. Also, there are recorded texts but they are not clear. Also if you consider the noise from air-conditioners, listening is not suitable in classes.
Interviewer: And how are teachers expected to deal with the materials available to them? Interviewee: We teach what is in the books but sometimes we need to supply additional things
whether worksheets or ideas and of course, the teaching aids need to be prepared by the teacher. We are not restricted to what is in the books.
Interviewer: According to the new curriculum, what is regarded as good teaching? Interviewee: I think teachers teach in their own way and only observers can tell if what they are
doing is good or not. There are procedures in the teacher’s book but I don’t follow them. I tried it in the first secondary and I saw it didn’t fit into my way of teaching. I have a certain way in presenting my lessons. I couldn’t follow the suggestions in the book. May be this is something wrong with me, even I cannot take a worksheet prepared by a colleague and use it for my students in class. I have a way of presenting my ideas that I cannot use the ideas of other teachers and this is the same with the teacher’s book. We are working hard. We try to search for more information to be able to teach what is in the books. Take the lesson on GM food for instance; I searched too many sites on the internet to be able to teach the lesson. We are not restricted to what is in the books.
Interviewer: To what extent do the curriculum materials limit or enhance your freedom in the
classroom? Interviewee: They sometimes restrict me. This is because of content and the length of the syllabus.
You can say it is shortage of time. Interviewer: Now, let’s consider your role in the curriculum inside the classroom. What is your role
in the classroom? Interviewee: I teach the books. I prepare worksheets to adapt the material. Interviewer: What else would you like to do in addition to your current role? Interviewee: I try to research, read a lot. This helps me in the classroom, it reflects on my
performance. This year I bought a book about bridging the gap between teacher and learner. I haven’t read it yet. I will read it, if I find it interesting, I will try to summarise it in a research paper. If not I am thinking of another topic which is learning from learners.
Interviewer: Other than preparing a research for your own personal development, what else would
you like to do in addition to your role in the curriculum itself? Interviewee: I think because I am teaching two curricula, I don’t have time to think now. But I hope
I can prepare more supplementary material and I will do this only if I hear that the books will not change.
246
Interviewer: So are you saying that what stops you is the rumour that the books will change? Interviewee: Yes, what’s the use of working hard on something that you will use only once? I will
prepare more resources for the current books when I hear that they will not be changed. This rumour that the books will be changed soon has a bad effect on us.
Interviewer: And you said there is no way for you to contact the curriculum centre to give them
your comments. Interviewee: There is no way to contact the curriculum centre. You are the first one to ask us about
our opinions. Interviewer: Has the first secondary book been modified in any way? Interviewee: I have been teaching this book for three years, nothing has been changed. Still we have
long lists of unnecessary vocabulary. However, the way I present it is different every year. But as for the book itself, nothing has changed. They haven’t changed anything except the printing mistakes this year. The problems are still the same; they haven’t done anything about them.
Interviewer: Compared to the old curriculum, how do you see your role now compared to your role
in the old curriculum? Interviewee: The books are completely different and they require different work. With the old
curriculum, we didn’t have the present technology of computers. My lessons are now different from those five years ago, I am not teaching in the same way.
Interviewer: So do you mean that your teaching techniques have changed? Interviewee: Yes, my teaching techniques have been changed completely. Before, I used to depend
on drawings, gestures and realia. That was what we had then as I didn’t have a computer at home.
Interviewer: In addition to your role as a teacher in both curricula, you told me that you used to
give feedback about the books but now you don’t. Can you tell me why you are not giving feedback?
Interviewee: Nobody has asked me for my opinion. Do you think that one voice will be heard? We
need them to go into schools and ask teachers for their opinions. I do not think that I have the courage to go and talk to them unless they contact schools.
Interviewer: As you said, your role in curriculum change is related to teaching. What else would
you like to do? Interviewee: I am satisfied with what I am doing. I like teaching and I like my students. I like
teaching English. Interviewer: So to summarise, in the process of curriculum change, you like your role as a teacher
and you think you are playing the role you wish to play. Interviewee: That’s right. I like teaching, I am thinking all the time of developing my way of
teaching. That is what I am interested in.
247
Interviewer: And what curriculum-related recommendations do you wish to convey to the
curriculum centre? Interviewee: I hope they will cut down the material. Let them take out some of the functions in the
second secondary and the grammar in the first secondary. Also the number of vocabulary items need to be reduced. Let them arrange the material too. This is more helpful when studying for the exam.
Interviewer: With regard to exams, what is the relationship between what you teach and what you
test? Interviewee: They are closely related. And this is a problem for us because we need to cover all the
material for the exam, and the material must be shorter than it is now. Less material is better than what we have now.
Interviewer: And can you tell me about how you were prepared to teach this book? Interviewee: I began preparing for book 11 in the summer holiday. Interviewer: What about the training you received? Interviewee: Training? What training? Nothing. Interviewer: What about for the first secondary. Interviewee: We had a meeting for a couple of hours. It was very helpful as we were asked to share
samples of planned lessons throughout the year. Interviewer: What else do you recommend? Interviewee: It is better if training courses are continuous. Interviewer: Currently, what support, facilities and resources are available for you for adaptation of
the curriculum? Interviewee: The supervisor is the only person we discuss problems with. We also as a staff share
our views together. I invited my colleagues and the supervisor to visit my class while I was giving a troublesome lesson to get their opinion on it. They liked my way in presenting the lesson. But this lesson came after four days of thinking after which I became really tired as the lesson was really higher than the level of the students. I got my ideas by inspiration and I stayed late at night preparing my teaching aids.
Interviewer: Why didn’t you check the suggestions in the teacher’s book? Interviewee: I don’t have it. For the second secondary, I haven’t received a teacher’s book. I don’t
need it. Most of the time I prepare worksheets then when I look at the workbook I find that they have the same tasks. I know that the teacher’s book may be helpful but we don’t have time to read it. We don’t find it interesting. It is better to spend the time thinking about the way you want to present the lesson than ..I don’t like abstract things.
248
Interviewer: Don’t you think that the teacher’s book presents another point of view as if you are discussing the lesson with a colleague?
Interviewee: No, I think it is better to discuss the lesson directly with the staff. They are very
helpful and cooperative. Interviewer: So you consider the teacher’s book only marginal and you haven’t got a copy because
of this, is that what you mean? Interviewee: Yes, I didn’t ask for the second secondary teacher’s book but I have the one for the
first secondary and I don’t use it. I never use it. I remember last year I looked at it once or twice and I didn’t follow the suggestions.
Interviewer: What else do you recommend as a means of support? Interviewee: I wish we could have direct contact with the curriculum centre….I have a point that I
want to talk about. Interviewer: Yes, go on please. Interviewee: What is the point in teaching pronunciation to secondary school students? I feel shy in
front of my students. Shall I teach this in the secondary stage and leave them for eleven years to pronounce things wrongly? I think such activities should be given in the fourth primary. It’s a shame. It is a waste of time. The students don’t need it at this stage.
Interviewer: That is a logical point of view. Well, back to the support you receive. What support do
you receive to facilitate your classroom teaching? Interviewee: From the school? We can’t say we have any kind of facilities here. We have a resource
room where there are computers and the internet but we are not allowed to give lessons there, we are not allowed to use it unless when writing a research. They are afraid that the devices will be spoiled. As for photocopying, we need to pay for this facility as we need to bring our own paper.
Interviewer: What do you think of this type of support? Interviewee: It’s very weak. Even teachers are buying their own overhead projectors. Interviewer: What else do you recommend? Interviewee: We need an English club. We need a projector and a data show. We need a language
lab. And of course we need basic facilities like typing and photocopying. Interviewer: What are your personal development attempts to compensate for training? Interviewee: I search the internet. I attend any workshop or conference available whether it is for
English or related to teaching techniques for other subjects. Interviewer: How effective do you see these attempts in supporting your classroom teaching or
your role in the new curriculum?
249
Interviewee: This has a positive effect of course. First of all, they enrich my knowledge. I also learn new ways of teaching. They are very useful, they are positive.
Interviewer: Thank you for your valuable contribution to my research. Would you like to talk about
other aspects related to curriculum change that we had not discussed in this interview?
Interviewee: I think we have discussed everything important. …….. Interviewer: Can you explain to me who has the authority to change the curriculum or to call for
curriculum change? Interviewee: I think supervisors. May be the senior supervisor…According to the reports he has
throughout the year. Interviewer: Who do you think should have the authority to call for change? Interviewee: We teachers should have the power to request change. We are in the practical
situation, we should. Interviewer: And can you tell me on what basis the curriculum should be changed? Interviewee: On the results of the students. The reactions of the students. Do they like it or not?
Actually, I like the curriculum of the second secondary too much. Book 11 is very interesting. It is also shorter compared to books 10 and 12. Book 10 also starts with a difficult unit. I don’t like it.
Interviewer: In your opinion, will the curriculum be acceptable if the exam is changed? Interviewee: I think things will improve. Interviewer: To what extent will things improve with the current curriculum if exams become
language based? Interviewee: Do you mean if it is from outside the book? Interviewer: Yes. Interviewee: It is a fine idea but it will not work with our students. It is a very good idea but it will
not work with our students. The majority of the students have weaknesses. The current exam makes them possible to pass. A language based test will reveal their weaknesses.
Interviewer: But will this make the curriculum acceptable? Interviewee: No, still it needs modifications. Interviewer: Has the curriculum taken into consideration the characteristics of learners in the UAE,
such as weaknesses and lack of motivation that you mentioned previously?
250
Interviewee: They are spoon-fed, demotivated and weak. I don’t think that there is any sign in the curriculum that it was written with these characteristics in mind. The second secondary has nice and interesting topics but the first secondary doesn’t.
251
Bibliography: Abbas, M. (2005). The Impact of Teacher Performance Appraisal. Paper presented at the
11th International TESOL Arabia Conference, Dubai, March, 9-11, 2005. Abu Hussein, G. (1999). An Interview with Dr. Sheikha Al Shamsi, Assistant
Undersecretary of Research and Curricula. The Teacher, 15 (89), 18-21. Allfrey, M. (1990). The Part of Teachers in Curriculum Change: Observations on Four
Case Studies. Unpublished M.Ed. Dissertation, University of Exeter, UK. Al-Araj, F. M. (1999). Selection and Training of Secondary School Head Teachers in the
United Arab Emirates. Unpublished Ph.D. Dissertation, University of Wales, Cardiff, UK.
Alexander, K., Taggart, A. and Thorpe, S. (1997). Teacher Renewal Through Curriculum
Innovation: Changing teachers’ pedagogies and programs. Issues in Educational Research, 7 (1), 1-18.
Al-Hai, O. A. (1990). Evolutionary Stages of the Education System in the United Arab
Emirates with Emphasis on Higher Education. Ph.D. Dissertation, University of Pittsburgh. Michigan: UMI.
Al Housani, H. A. (1996). Secondary School Administration in the United Arab Emirates:
Its Reality, Problems and Methods of Development. Unpublished Ph.D. Dissertation, University of Wales, Cardiff, UK.
Al Mansouri, K. Y. (2001). Evaluation of the Pre-Service EFL Teacher Education
Programme in the United Arab Emirates: A Responsive-Constructivist Approach. Unpublished Ph.D. Dissertation, University of Exeter, UK.
Al-Nabeh, N. A. (1982). Personnel Administration of Education in the United Arab
Emirates. Ph.D. Dissertation, Claremont University. Michigan: UMI. Al-Nayadi, M. A. (1989). Educator’s Perceptions of the Teacher Evaluation System in the
United Arab Emirates. Ed.D. Dissertation, The George Washington University. Michigan: UMI.
Al Nuaimin, A. R. (1991). An Evaluation of the programme for professional preparation of
secondary school teachers in the U.A.E. Unpublished Ed. D. Thesis, Islamic University of Imam Mohammed Bin Saud, Saudi Arabia.
Alraway, M. K. (1988). An Analysis of the Competencies Needed By Secondary School
Teachers of United Arab Emirates. Ed.D. Dissertation, University of Pittsburgh. Michigan: UMI.
252
Al-Sadan, I. A. (2000). Educational Assessment in Saudi Arabian Schools. Assessment in Education, 7 (1), 143-155.
Al-Taneiji, S. O. (2001). The Relationship Between Parental Involvement and School
Success in the United Arab Emirates. Ph.D. Dissertation, University of Colorado at Denver, Michigan: UMI.
Altheide, D. L. & Johnson,, J. M. (1994). Criteria for Assessing Interpretive Validity in
Qualitative Research. In N. K. Denzin & Y. S. Lincoln (Eds.). Handbook of Qualitative Research. Pp. 485-499. Thousand Oaks, California: Sage Publications.
Altraifi, J. S. (1999). The Perceptions of Women teachers in the United Arab Emirates of
the Conditions under which they work. Unpublished Ph.D. Thesis, University of Wales, Cardiff, UK.
Alwan, F. (1990). English for UAE: An Analytical Study of the Books of the Secondary
Cycle. Paper presented to the English language Curriculum Department. Alwan, F. (1995). The Use of Communicative teaching Techniques in EFL Classes in the
U.A.E. Public Schools: Cooperative Learning. Paper presented at the First Symposium for EFL Teachers, November 1995.
Alwan, F. (2000). Towards Effective In-Service Teacher Development in the United Arab
Emirates: Getting Teachers to be in Charge of their Own Professional Growth. Unpublished M.A. Dissertation, University of Bath, UK.
Alwan, F. (2001). Self-development for Teachers in the UAE. In Troudi, S.; Riley, S. &
Coombe, C. (Eds). TESOL Arabia Conference Proceedings: EFL in the new Millennium. Pp. 177-197. Dubai: TESOL Arabia.
Alwan, F. (2003a). Using Teaching Portfolios for Evaluating EFL Teachers in the UAE:
Validating a Floating Concept. Language Teacher Education Module Assignment. University of Exeter. (Unpublished).
Alwan, F. (2003b). Teacher’s Roles in Leading Innovations and Managing Educational
Change in the United Arab Emirates. Leadership and Management in Education Module Assignment. University of Exeter. (Unpublished).
Alwan, F. (2004a). Motivation in Foreign Language Learning in the UAE: A Social
Constructivist Perspective. In Davidson, P.; Al-Hamly, M.; Khan, M.; Aydelott, J.; Bird, K. & Coombe, C. (Eds). Proceedings of the 9th TESOL Arabia Conference: English Language Teaching in the IT Age. Pp. 294-311. Dubai: TESOL Arabia.
Alwan, F. (2004b). Teacher Evaluation: A Star Academy Approach?. Paper presented at the
8th International CTELT Conference, December, 2004.
253
Alwan, F. (2005). Portfolio Evaluation: Validating a floating concept? Paper presented at the 10th International TESOL Arabia Conference, March, 2005.
Amro, F. A. (2001). The Main Problems and Difficulties that Affect the Action of teachers
of English in Jordanian Public Schools. Unpublished M.A. Thesis, University of Jordan.
Anfrara,, V. K.; Brown, K. M. & Magione, T. L. (2002). Qualitative Analysis on Stage:
Making the research Process More Public. Educational Researcher, 32 (7), 28-38. Apple, M. W. (1997). Is There a curriculum Voice to Reclaim?. In D. J. Flinders & S. J.
Thornton (Eds.). The Curriculum Studies Reader. Pp. 342-349. New York: Routledge.
Atkinson, E. (2000). Behind the Inquiring Mind: exploring the transition from external to
internal inquiry. Reflective Practice, 1 (2), 149-164. Azzari, H. N. & Mansour, S. H. (1998). The Reality of Educational Supervision in the
United Arab Emirates. Sharjah: Sharjah Educational District. (Unpublished). Badri, F. A. (1991). Perceptions of English As a Foreign Language Teachers Regarding
the Supervisory Practices in the United Arab Emirates’ Secondary Schools. Ed.D. Dissertation, The George Washington University. Michigan: UMI.
Bailey, K. M. (2000). The best laid plans: teachers’ in-class decisions to depart from their
lesson plans. In K. M. Bailey & D. Nunan (Eds.). Voices from the Language Classroom.Pp. 15-40. Cambridge: Cambridge University Press.
Bailey, K. M.; Curtis, A. & Nunan, D. (2001). Pursuing Professional Development: The
self as Source. Boston: Heinle & Heinle. Balfakih, N. M. (2003). The Effectiveness of student team-achievement division (STAD)
for teaching high school chemistry in the United Arab Emirates. International Journal for Science Education, 25 (5), 605-624.
Barrow, R. (1984). Giving teaching Back to Teachers: A Critical Introduction to
Curriculum Theory. Sussex: Wheatsheaf Books Ltd. Beattie, M. & Thiessen, D. D. (1997). School-Based Restructuring and Curriculum Change:
teachers’ and students’ contrasting perspectives. The Curriculum Journal, 8 (3), 411-440.
Becher, T. & Maclure, S. (1978). The Politics of Curriculum Change. London: Hutchinson
of London. Becher, T. & Maclure, S. (1982). Agents of Change. In T. Horton & P Raggatt
(Eds.).Challenge and Change in the Curriculum. Pp. 80-90. Kent: Hodder and Stonghton.
254
Beck, J.; Czerniak, C. M. & Lumpe, A. T. (2000). An Exploratory Study of Teachers’ beliefs regarding the implementation of Constructivism in Their Classrooms. Journal of Science teacher education, 11 (4), 323-343.
Beijaard, D. & De Vries, Y. (1997). Stability Building Expertise: a process perspective on
the development or change of teachers’ beliefs. European Journal of Teacher Education, 20 (3), 243-255.
Bel Fekih, C. M. (1993). Modern Secondary Education in the United Arab Emirates:
Development, Issues and Perspectives. Ed.D. Dissertation, Temple University. Michigan: UMI.
Bell, J. (1995). How to Complete your Research Project Successfully: A Guide for first-
time Researchers. Buckingham: Open University Press. Benesch, S. (1996). Needs Analysis and Curriculum Development in EAP: An Example of
a Critical Approach. TESOL Quarterly, 30 (4), 723-738. Ben-Peretz, M.; Mendelson, N. & Kron, F. W. (2003). How teachers in different
educational contexts view their roles. Teaching and Teacher education, 19, pp. 277-290.
Berg, B. L. (2001). Qualitative research methods for the Social Sciences. Boston: Allyn
and Bacon. Bernstein, B. (1974). Class, Codes, and Control: Theoretical studies towards a sociology of
language. London: Routledge and Kegan Paul. Berwick, R. (1994). Needs Assessment in Language Programming: from Theory to
Practice. In R. K. Johnson (Ed.). The Second Language Curriculum.Pp.48-78. Cambridge: Cambridge University Press.
Best, J. W. & Khan, J. V. (1989). Research in Education. New Delhi: Printice-Hall of
India. Bird, K. and Owais, A. (2004). The Teaching Portfolio. In P. Davidson; M. Al-Hamly; M.
Athar Khan, J.Aydelott; K. Bird, and C. Coombe (Eds.). Proceedings of the 9th TESOL Arabia Conference: English language Teaching in the IT Age, Vol. 8, pp.353-360. Dubai: TESOL Arabia.
Blake, D.; Hanley, V.; Jennings, M. & Lloyd, M. (1996). Change in Teacher Education:
interpreting and experiencing new professional roles. European Journal of teacher Education, 19 (1), 19-34.
Block, D. (2000). Problematizing Interview Data: Voices in the Mind’s Machine? TESOL
Quarterly, 34 (4), 757-763. Bloomer, M. (2001). Young Lives, Learning and Transformation: some
theoreticalconsiderations. Oxford Review of Education, 27 (3), 430-449.
255
Borg, S. (1998a). Data-based Teacher Development. ELT Journal, 52 (4), 273-281. Borg, S. (1998b). Teachers’ Pedagogical Systems and Grammar Teaching: A Qualitative
Study. TESOL Quarterly, 32 (1), 9-38 Borg, S. (1999). Teachers’ Theories in Grammar Teaching. ELT Journal, 53 (3), 157-164. Borg, M. (2001). Teachers’ Beliefs. ELT Journal, 55 (2), 186-188. Borg, S. (2003). Teacher Cognition in Language Teaching: A review of research of what
language teachers think, know, believe, and do. Language Teaching Abstracts, 36 (2), 81-109.
Bowers, R. (1992). Memories, metaphors, maxims, and myths: Language Learning and
Cultural Awareness. ELT Journal, 46 (1), 29-38. Breen, M. (1987). Contemporary Paradigms in Syllabus Design 1. Language Teaching
Abstracts, 20 (2), 81-92. Breen, M. (Ed.) (2001). Learner Contributions to Language learning: New Directions in
Research. Harlow, England: Longman. Breen, M. (2002). From a Language Policy to Classroom Practice: The Intervention of
Identity and Relationships. Language and Education, 16 (4), 260- 283. Breen, M. P. & Littlejohn, A. (Eds.). (2000). Classroom Decision-Making. Cambridge:
Cambridge University Press. Brindley, G (1994). The role of needs analysis in adult ESL programme design. In R. K.
Johnson (Ed.). The Second language Curriculum. Pp.63-78. Cambridge:Cambridge University Press.
Brousseau, B. A. & Freeman, D. J. (1988). How do Teacher Education Faculty Members
Define Desirable Teacher Beliefs?. Teaching and Teacher education, 4 (3), 267-273.
Brown, A. J. & Dowling (1998). Doing Research/ Reading Research: A Mode of
Interrogation for Education. London: Falmer Press. Brown, J. D. (1995). The Elements of Language Curriculum: A Systematic Approach to
Program Development. Boston: Heinle and Heinle Publishers. Burden, R. (1998) How Can We Best Help Children To Become Effective Thinkers and
Learners? The Case for and Against Thinking Skills Programmes. In R. Burden & M. Williams (Eds.) Thinking Through the Curriculum. London: Routledge.
256
Burns, A. (1995). Teachers’ Voices: Curriculum design and change. Paper presented at JALT Conference, Nagoya, November, 1995. (ERIC Document Reproduction Service No. ED406 850)
Burns, A. (1999). Collaborative Action Research for English Language Teachers. Cambridge: Cambridge University Press.
Burr, V. (2000). An Introduction to Social Constructionism. London: Routledge.
Burton, D. (1996). Qualitative Methods: Design and Data Collection Issues. Sheffield: University of Sheffield.
Campbell, J.; Smith, D.; Boulton-Lewis, G.; Brownlee, J.; Burnett, P. C.; Carrington, S. &
Purdie, N. (2001). Students’ Perceptions of Teaching and Learning: the influence of students’ approaches to learning and teachers’ approaches to teaching. Teachers and Teaching: Theory and Practice, 7 (2), 173-187.
Celce-Murcia, M. & Olshtain, E. (2000). Discourse and Context in Language teaching: A
Guide for language teachers. Cambridge: Cambridge University Press. Chamot, A. U. (2001). The role of learning strategies in second language acquisition. In M.
Breen (Ed.). Learner Contributions to Language learning: New Directions in Research. Harlow, England: Longman.
Cohen, L. & Manion, L. (1995). Research Methods in Education. London: Routledge. Collins, P. R. & Waugh, R. F. (1998). Teachers’ Receptivity to a Proposed System-wide
Educational Change. Journal of Educational Administration, 36 (2), 183-199. Collinson, V. & Cook, T. F. (2000). “I don’t have enough time”: Teachers’ Interpretations
of Time as a Key to Learning and School Change. Journal of Educational Administration, 39 (3), 266-281.
Connelly, F.M. & Clandinin, D. J. (1988). Teachers As Curriculum Planners: narratives of
experience. New York: Teachers College Press. Coombe, C. (2005a). Developing Test Specifications. In D. Lloyd, P. Davidson & C.
Coombe (Eds.). Fundamentals of language Assessment: A Practical Guide for Teachers in the Gulf. Pp.17-23. Dubai: TESOL Arabia.
Coombe, C. (2005b). Washback and The Impact of High-stakes Tests on Teaching and
Learning. In D. Lloyd, P. Davidson & C. Coombe (Eds.). Fundamentals of language Assessment: A Practical Guide for Teachers in the Gulf. Pp.31-39. Dubai: TESOL Arabia.
Coombe, C. & Hubley, N. (2005). The Cornerstones of Language Testing. In D. Lloyd, P.
Davidson & C. Coombe (Eds.). Fundamentals of language Assessment: A Practical Guide for Teachers in the Gulf. Pp.3-16. Dubai: TESOL Arabia.
257
Cooper, P. & McIntyre, D. (1994). Teachers’ and Pupils’ Perceptions of Effective Classroom Learning: Conflicts and Commonalities. In M. Hughes (Ed.). Perceptions of Teaching and Learning. Pp.67-95. Clevedon: Multilingual Matters.
Cronbach, L. J. (1985). Course Improvement Through Evaluation. In M. Golby; J.
Greenwald & R. West (Eds.). Curriculum Design. Pp. 399-413. Kent: The Open University
Crotty, M. (Ed.). (1998) The Foundation of Social research: Meaning and Perspective in
the Research Process. London: SAGE Publications. Dalton, T. H. (1988). The Challenge of Curriculum Innovation: A Study of Ideology and
Practice. London: The Falmer Press. Davies, I. (1993). The Reform of Education: How and Why are Guideline Documents
Produced For Teachers and Are They of Any Value?. Curriculum, 14 (2), 114-124.
Davis, K. A. (1992). Validity and Reliability in Qualitative Research on Second Language
Acquisition and Teaching. TESOL Quarterly, 26 (3), 605-608. Denzin, N. K. & Lincoln, Y. S. (Eds.)(1994). Handbook of Qualitative Research.
Thousand Oaks, California: Sage Publications. ____________ (2000). Development of the English Language Curriculum of Public
Schools (Sample for level 1-5-9 & 12) in the United Arab Emirates: Project 1. Dubai: UAE Ministry of education. (Unpublished).
Dreyfus, A. & Mazouz, Y. (1989). The Perceptions of the teachers as a Basis for Co-
operative Planning of In-service Activities. European Journal of teacher Education, 12 (3), 253-263.
Dubin, F. & Olshtain, E. (2000). Course Design. Cambridge: Cambridge University Press.
Duit, R. & Treagust, D. F. (2003). Conceptual change: a powerful framework for improving science teaching and learning. International Journal of Science Education, 25 (6), 671-688.
Duke, D. L. (Ed.). (1995). Teacher Evaluation Policy: From Accountability to Professional
Development. New York: State University of New York. Elliott, B.; Brooker, R.; Macpherson, I. & McInman, A. (1999). Curriculum Leadership as
Mediated Action. Teachers and teaching: Theory and Practice, 5 (2), 171-185.
Elliott, J. (1994). The Teacher’s Role in Curriculum Development: an unresolved issue in English attempts at curriculum reform. Curriculum Studies, 2 (1), 43-69.
___________ (1994). English Language Curriculum Document for Basic and Secondary
Education. Dubai: Ministry of Education.
258
Enteistle, N. & Smith, C. (2002). Personal understanding and target understanding:
Mapping influences on the outcomes of learning. British Journal of Educational Psychology, 72, 321-342.
Ernest, P. (1994). An Introduction to Research Methodology and Paradigm. In Radnor, H.
A. (Ed.) Educational Research Monograph Series. Exeter: University of Exeter. Everard, K. B. & Morris, G. (1996). Effective School Management. London: Paul Chapman
Publishing Ltd. Finch, M.A. (1981). Behind the Teacher’s Desk: The Teacher, The Administrator, and the
Problem of Change. Curriculum Inquiry, 11 (4), pp. 321-342. Fox, M. (2001). Constructivism Examined. Oxford Review of Education, 27(1), 23-25. Fox, M. (2003). Opening Pandora’s Box: evidence-based practice for educational
psychologists. Educational Psychology in practice, 19 (2), 91-102. Fraenkel, J. R. & Wallen, N. E. (2000). How to Design and Evaluate Research in
Education. USA: McGraw-Hill Higher Education. Freeman, D. (2002). The Hidden Side of the Work: Teacher Knowledge and Learning to
Teach: A perspective from north American educational research on teacher education in English language teaching. Language Teaching Abstracts, 35 (1), 1-13.
Fullan, M. (1993). Change Forces: Probing the Depth of Educational Reform. London:
The Falmer Press. Fullan, M. (1999). Change Forces: The Sequel. London: The Falmer Press. Fullan, M. (2001a). Leading in a Culture of Change. San Francisco: Jossey-Bass. Fullan, M. (2001b). The New Meaning of Educational Change. New York: Teachers
College Press. Fullan, M. & Hargreaves, A. (1992). Teacher Development and Educational Change.
London: The Falmer Press. Fullan, M. G. & Stiegelbauer, S. (1991). The New Meaning of Educational Change.
London: Cassell. Gahin, G. & Myhill, D. (2001). The Communicative Approach in Egypt: Exploring the
Secrets of the Pyramids. TEFL Web Journal, 1 (2), Retrieved on April 5, 2005, from http://www.teflweb-j.org/v1n2/Gahin_Myhill.html
259
Galton, M. (1998). Making a Curriculum: Some principles of curriculum building. In J. Moyles & L. Hargreaves (Eds.). The primary Curriculum: Learning from international perspectives. Pp. 73-80. London: Routledge.
Galton, M. & Isaac,J. (1983). Changing Classrooms. In M. Galton & B. Moon (Eds.).
Changing Schools…Changing Curriculum. Pp. 255-256. London: Harper and Row.
Ganguly, A. (2001). The Management of Curriculum Change. In S. Rassekh. & J. Thomas (Eds.), Final report, Seminar on the Management of Curriculum Change and Adaptation in the Gulf Region, Muscat, Oman, May 17-21. Retrieved on April, 2, 2003, from http://www.ibe.unesco.org/Regional/GulfStatesProjects/GulfStatesProjectsPdf/omanrep.pdf
Gardner, W. E. (1995). Developing a Quality Teaching Force for the United Arab Emirates: mission improbable. Journal of Education for Teaching, 21 (3), 289-301.
Gardner, W. E. and Abu Libde, A. (1995). Professional Development Schools: how well
will they travel? Journal of Education for Teaching, 21 (3), 303-315. Gatbonton, E. (1999). Investigating Experienced ESL teachers’ Pedagogical Knowledge.
The Modern Language Journal, 83 (1), 35-50. Ghareeb, K. (1996). INSET in the United Arab Emirates: An Evaluation and
Recommendations for Future development. Unpublished M.Ed. Dissertation, Centre for English Language Teacher Education, University of Warwick, UK.
Gibbs, D. (1998). The miracle baby: curriculum change and primary English: An
Australian Case-Study. Journal of Curriculum Studies, 30 (2), 181-198. Gibbs, C.; McCallum & Brown, M.(1999). Primary Teachers’ Beliefs about Teaching and
Learning. The Curriculum Journal, 10 (1), 123-134. Glean, C. (1984). Teacher Perspective on Curriculum Change. Curriculum, 5 (2), 30-33. Glesne, C. & Peshkin, A. (1992). Becoming Qualitative Researchers: An Introduction. New
York: Longman. Golby, M. (1985). The New Educational Consensus. Curriculum, 6 (2), 5-12. Golombek, P. (1994). Putting Teachers Back into Teachers’ Knowledge. TESOL Quarterly,
28 (2), 404-406. Golombek, P. (1998). A Study of Language Teachers’ Personal Practical Knowledge.
TESOL Quarterly, 32 (3), 447-462. Graves, K. (Ed.). (2003). Teachers as Course Developers. Cambridge: Cambridge
University Press.
260
Guba, E. G. & Lincoln, Y. S. (1989). Fourth Generation Evaluation. Newbury Park: Sage
Publications. Guba, E. G. & Lincoln, Y. S. (1994). Competing Paradigms in Qualitative Research. In N.
K. Denzin & Y. S. Lincoln (Eds.). Handbook of Qualitative Research. Pp. 105-117. Thousand Oaks, California: Sage Publications.
Guefrachi, H. & Troudi, S. (2000). Enhancing English language Teaching in the United
Arab Emirates. In K. E. Johnson (Ed.), Teacher Education. Pp. 179-204. Virginia: TESOL
Hacker, R. G. & Rowe, M. J. (1998). A Longitudinal Study of the Effects of Implementing a National Curriculum Project upon Classroom Processes. The Curriculum Journal, 9 (1), 95-103.
Hadley, G. S. (1999). Innovative Curricula in Tertiary ELT: A Japanese case study. ELT
Journal, 53 (2), 92-99. Halliday, J. (2002). Researching Values in Education. British Educational Research
Journal, 28 (1), 49-62. Hanrahan, M.; Cooper, T. & Burroughs-Lange, S. (1999). The Place of personal writing in
a PhD thesis: epistemological and methodological considerations. Qualitative Studies in Education, 12 (4), 401-416.
Hargreaves, D. H.; Hopkins, D & Leask, M. (1994). The Empowered School: The
Management and Practice of Development Planning. London: Cassell. Harris, C. (2001). History Curriculum Development in New South Wales: Issues of Control
and its Impact on Teachers. Paper presented at 2001 Curriculum Conference: Education Futures and New Citizenships, September 29- October 1, Australia, Capital territory. Retrieved on May 15, 2002, from: http://acsainc.com.au/content/2001_history_curriculum_development_in_new_south_wales.pdf
Harrison, I. (2000). Look Who’s Talking: Listening to voices in curriculum renewal. In K.
M. Bailey & D. Nunan (Eds.). Voices from the Language Classroom.Pp. 283-303. Cambridge: Cambridge University Press.
Hayes, D. (2000). Cascade Training and Teachers’ Professional Development. ELT
Journal, 54 (2), 135-145. Head, K. & Taylor, P. (1997). Readings in Teacher Development. Oxford, UK: Macmillan
Heinmann Hedgcock, J. S. (2002). Toward a Socioliterate Approach to Second Language Teacher
Education. The Modern Language Journal, 86 (3), 499-317.
261
Hokal, A. I.(1999). School Effectiveness in the U.A.E., The Educational Monitoring System in U.A.E. Primary Public Schools, A Case Study of The Dubai Educational Zone. Unpublished Ph.D. Dissertation, University of Exeter, UK.
Hokal, K. & Shaw, K. (1999). Managing Progress Monitoring in the United Arab Emirates
Schools. The International Journal of Educational Management, 13 (4), pp. 173-179.
Holliday, A. (1997). Appropriate Methodology and Social Conext. Cambridge: Cambridge
University Press. Holliday, A. R. (2001). Doing and Writing Qualitative Research. London: Sage. Holly, D. (1973). Beyond Curriculum: Changing Secondary Education. London: Hart-
Davis, MacGibbon. Holt, M. (1986). Schools and Curriculum Change. Berkshire: McGraw-Hill. Hopkins, D. & Reynolds, D. (2001). The Past, Present and Future of School
Improvement:towards the Third Age. British educational research Journal, 27 (4),459-475.
Huberman, A.M. & Miles, M.B. (1994). Data Management and Analysis Methods. In N. K.
Denzin & Y. S. Lincoln (Eds.). Handbook of Qualitative Research. Pp. 428-444. Thousand Oaks, California: Sage Publications.
______________ (2001). In-house Material Needs Analysis: A Collaborative Study. UAE:
Institute of Nursing, English Language Department ( Unpublished) Isaac, J. (1983). Teacher Education in the Future. In M. Galton & B. Moon. Changing
Schools…Changing Curriculum. Pp.71-91. London: Harper and Row. Jackson, P. W. (1980). Curriculum and Its Discontents. Curriculum Inquiry, 10 (2), 159-
177. Jacob, R & Frid, S. (1997). Curriculum Change: What Do Teachers and Students Really
Think? Paper presented at the Annual Meeting of the American Educational Research Association ( Chicago, IL, March 24-28, 1997) (ERIC Document Reproduction Service No. ED409 275)
Janesick, V. J. (1994). The Dance of Qualitative Research Design: Metaphors,
Methodology, and Meaning. In N. K. Denzin & Y. S. Lincoln (Eds.). Handbook of Qualitative Research. Pp. 209-219. Thousand Oaks, California: Sage Publications.
Johnson, H. & Saville-Troike, M. (1992). Validity and Reliability in Second Language
Acquisition and Teaching. TESOL Quarterly, 26 (3), 602-605.
262
Johnson, R. K. (Ed.) (1994). The Second Language Curriculum. Cambridge: Cambridge University Press.
Johnson, K. E. (1999). Understanding language teaching: Reasoning in Action. Canada:
Heinle and Heinle Publishers. Karavas-Doukas, K. (1998). Evaluating the Implementation of educational innovations:
lessons from the past. In P. Rea-Dickins & K. P. Germaine (Eds.). Managing Evaluation and Innovation in Language teaching. Pp. 25-50. London: Longman.
Kerr, J. F. (1970). Curriculum Change in Emergent Countries. In G. Howson (Ed.).
Developing a New Curriculum. Pp.53-78. London: Heinemann Educational Books.
Khanji, J. S. (2000). Variables Affecting the Choice of Learning Strategies: Perceptual
Styles and Brain Hemisphericity. Unpublished Ph.D. Dissertation, University of Khartoum, Sudan.
Khlaifat, A. S. (1992). Higher Education in the United Arab Emirates: University of United
Arab Emirates and its Development. Ph.D. Dissertation, University of North Texas. Michigan: UMI.
Kiviven, O. and Ristela, P. (2003). From Constructivism to Pragmatist Conception of
learning. Oxford Review of Education, 29 (3), 363-375. Korthagen, F. & Lagerwerf, B. (1996). Reframing the Relationship between Teacher
Thinking and Teacher Behaviour: levels in learning about teaching. Teachers and teaching: Theory and Practice, 2 (2), 161- 187.
Kotter, J. P. (1996). Leading Change. Boston: Harvard Business School Press. Kumaravadivelu, B. (2003a). Beyond methods: Macrostrategies for Language Teaching.
New Haven Ct. ; London : Yale University Press. Kumaravadivelu, B. (2003b). Method, antimethod, postmethod. In A. Pulverness (Ed.).
IATEFL 2002 York Conference Selections. Pp. 11-19. Kent: IATEFL. Kumaravadivelu, B. (2003c). Response 1. World Englishes, 22 (4), 565-567. Lazaraton, A. (2003). Evaluative Criteria for Qualitative Research in Applied Linguistics:
Whose Criteria and Whose Research?. The Modern Language Journal, 87 (1), 1-12.
Lieberman, A. (1997). Navigating the Four C’s: Building a Bridge over Troubled Waters.
In D. J. Flinders & S. J. Thornton (Eds.). The Curriculum Studies Reader. Pp. 350-354. New York: Routledge.
Lincoln, Y. S. & Guba, E. G. (1985). Naturalistic Inquiry. Newbury Park: Sage
Publications.
263
Ling, L. M. (2002). A Tale of Two teachers: teachers’ responses to an imposed curriculum
reform. Teacher Development, 6 (1), 33-46. Loughrey, B.; Hughes, A.; Bax, S.; Magness, C.; Aziz, H.; Badry, R.; Alwan, F.; Abbas,
R.; Araishi, M. & Al Samadi, K. (1999). English Language Teaching in the UAE Evaluation Report. Roehampton Institute: University of London. (Unpublished).
Rassekh, S. & Thomas, J. (Eds.), (2001). Management of Curriculum Revision and Change: a synthesis of the national reports. In S. Rassekh. & J. Thomas (Eds.), Final report, Seminar on the Management of Curriculum Change and Adaptation in the Gulf Region, Muscat, Oman, May 17-21. Retrieved on April, 2, 2003, from http://www.ibe.unesco.org/Regional/GulfStatesProjects/ GulfStatesProjectsPdf/omanrep.pdf.
Mann., P. ( 1983). Curriculum Change: Constraints and Approaches. In M. Galton & B. Moon. Changing Schools…Changing Curriculum. Pp.32-37. London: Harper and Row.
Marcus, G. E. (1994). What Comes (Just) After “Post”? The Case of Ethnography. In N. K.
Denzin & Y. S. Lincoln (Eds.). Handbook of Qualitative Research. Pp. 563-574. Thousand Oaks, California: Sage Publications.
Markee, N. (1997). Managing Curricular Innovation. Cambridge: Cambridge University
Press. Marlow, S. E. & Minehira, N. J. (1996). Principals as Curriculum Leaders: New
Perspectives for the 21st Century. HSLA Monograph. Retrieved on 15 January 2004 from http://www.prel.org/products/Products/Curriculum.pdf
Martin-Jones, M. (2000). Bilingual Classroom Interaction: A review of Recent Research. Language Teaching Abstracts, 33 (1), 1-9.
Maxwell, J. A. (1996). Qualitative Research Design: An Interactive Approach. London:
Sage. Maykut, P. & Morehouse, R. (2001). Beginning Qualitative Research: A Philosophical
Guide. London: Routledge. McGrail, E. (2005). Teachers, Technology, and Change: English Teachers’ Perspectives.
Journal of Technology and Teacher Education, 13 (1), 5-24. Merriam, S. B. (1998).Qualitative research and Case Study Applications in Education. San
Francisco: Jossey-Bass. Nespor, J. (1987). The Role of Belief in the Practice of Teaching, Journal of Curriculum
Studies, 19 (4), 317-328.
264
Newman, J. M. (1998). We Can’t Get There from Here. Phi Delta Kappan, 80 (4), http://www.pdkintl.org/kappan/knew9812.htm
Nunan, D. (1988). The Learner Centred Curriculum. Cambridge: Cambridge University
Press. Nunan, D. (1997). Developing Standards for Teacher research in TESOL. TESOL
Quarterly, 31 (2), 365-367. Nunn, R. (1996). Learning from Qatar: Evaluation of methods-in-use. The Language
Teacher, 20 (3). Retrieved on 20 March 2004, from http://www.jalt-publications.org/tlt/files/96/mar/nunn.html
Olesen, V. (1994). Feminism and Models of Qualitative Research. In N. K. Denzin & Y. S.
Lincoln (Eds.). Handbook of Qualitative Research. Pp. 158-174. Thousand Oaks, California: Sage Publications.
Oppenheim, A. N. ( 1996). Questionnaire Design, Interviewing and Attitude Measurement.
London: Printer Publishers. Osborn, M.; Croll, P.; Broadfoot, P.; Polland, A. McNess & Triggs, P. (1997). Policy into
Practice and Practice into Policy: Creative Mediation in the Primary Classroom. In G. Helsby & G. McCulloch (Eds.) Teachers and the National Curriculum. Pp. 52-65. London: Cassell.
Owais, A. (2005). Teaching English in Public Schools in the UAE: Challenges Lead to
Changes. Paper presented at Issues in teaching English in Public and Higher Education in the UAE Conference, Dubai, March, 2005.(unpublished).
Pajares, M. F. (1992). Teachers’ Beliefs and Educational Research: Cleaning Up a Messy
Construct. Review of Educational Research, 62 (3), 307-332. Pajares, F. (1999). Current Directions in Self-Efficacy Research. In M. Maehr & P. R.
Pintrich (Eds). Advances in motivation and achievement. Volume 10, Pp. 1-49. Greenwich, CT: JAI Press.
Popkewitz, T. S. (2000). The Denial of Change in Educational Change: Systems of Ideas in
Construction of National Policy and Evaluation. Educational Researcher, 29 (1), 17-29.
Popper, K. (1970). Objective Knowledge. London: Hutchinson. Powney, J. & Watts, M. (1984). Reporting Interviews: a code of good practice. Research
Intelligence, 17, September, 164-168. Print, M. (1993). Curriculum Development and Design. Sydney: Allen & Unwin. Punch, K. F. (1998). Introduction to Social Research: Quantitative and Qualitative
Approaches. London: SAGE Publications.
265
Punch, M. (1994). Politics and Ethics in Qualitative Research. In N. K. Denzin & Y. S.
Lincoln (Eds.). Handbook of Qualitative Research. Pp. 83-97. Thousand Oaks, California: Sage Publications.
Radnor, H. A. (1994). Qualitative/ Interpretive Research: Collecting and Analysing
Interview Data. In Radnor, H. (Ed.) Educational Research Monograph Series. Exeter: University of Exeter.
Radnor, H. (2002). Researching Your Professional Practice: Doing Interpretive Research.
Buckingham: Open University Press. Radnor, H. A.; Poulson, L. & Turner-Bisset, R. (1995). Assessment and Teacher
Professionalism. The Curriculum Journal, 6 (3), pp. 325-342.
Rassekh , S. (2001). The need for curriculum adaptation in the Gulf region: some elements for reflection. In S. Rassekh. & J. Thomas (Eds.), Final report, Seminar on the Management of Curriculum Change and Adaptation in the Gulf Region, Muscat, Oman, May 17-21. Retrieved on April, 2, 2003, from http://www.ibe.unesco.org/Regional/GulfStatesProjects/GulfStatesProjectsPdf/omanrep.pdf
Rassekh, S. & Thomas, J. (Eds) (2001). The Management of Curriculum Change and Adaptation in the Gulf region. Final report of the Aeminar Held in Muscat, Oman, 17-21 February 2001. Geneva: International Bureau of education, The Oman National Commission for UNESCO. Retrieved April 2, 2003, from http://www.ibe.unesco.org/Regional/GulfStatesProjects/GulfStatesProjectsPdf/omanrep.pdf
Rea-Dickens, P. & Germaine, K. P. (Eds.). (1998). Managing Evaluation and Innovation in
Language Teaching: Building Bridges. London: Longman. Reagan, T. G. & Osborn, T. A. (2002).The Foreign Language Educator in Society: Toward
a Critical Pedagogy. Mahwah, New Jersey: Lawrence Erlbaum Associates. Reid, W. A. (1975). The Changing Curriculum: Theory and Practice. In W. A. Reid & D.F.
Walker (Eds.) Case Studies in Curriculum Change. Pp. 241-259. London & Boston: Routledge & Kegan Paul.
Richards, J. (2003). Curriculum Development in Language Teaching. Cambridge:
Cambridge University Press. Richards, K. (1994). Teachers’ Knowledge: From Guessing What Teachers Think to
Finding out What Teachers Know: The Need for a Research Agenda. TESOL Quarterly, 28 (2), 401-404.
Robson, C. (2002). Real World research: A Resource for Social Scientists and Practitioner-
Researchers. Oxford: Blackwell Publishing.
266
Rodgers, T. S. (1994). Syllabus design, curriculum development and polity determination. In R. K. Johnson (Ed.). The Second Language Curriculum. Pp. 24-34. Cambridge: Cambridge University Press.
Roelofs, E. & Terwel, J. (1999). Constructivism and authentic pedagogy: state of the art
and recent developments in the Dutch national curriculum in secondary education. Journal of Curriculum Studies, 31 (2), 201-227.
Romero, M. (1998). Educational Change and Discourse Communities: representing change
in postmodern times. Curriculum Studies, 6 (1), 47-67. Rossman, G. B. & Rallis, S. F. (2003). Learning in the Field: An Introduction to
Qualitative Research. Thousand Oaks, California: Sage Publications. Rowe, K. J. & Sykes, J. (1989). The Impact of professional Development on Teachers’ Self
Perceptions. Teaching and teacher Education, 5 (2), 129-141. Ruane, J. M. (2005). Essentials of Research Methods: A Guide to Social Science Research.
Oxford: Blackwell Publishing. Schur, Y.; Skuy, M.; Zietsman, A. & Fridjhon, P. (2002). A Thinking Journey Based on
Constructivism and Mediated Learning Experience as a Vehicle for Teaching Science to Low Functioning Students and Enhancing their Cognitive Skills. School Psychology International, 23 (1), 36-67.
Schwandt, T. A. (1994). Constructivist, Interpretivist Approaches to Human Inquiry. In N.
K. Denzin & Y. S. Lincoln (Eds.). Handbook of Qualitative Research. Pp. 605-608. Thousand Oaks, California: Sage Publications.
Schwandt, T. A. (2001). Dictionary of Qualitative Inquiry. Thousand Oaks, California:
Sage Publications.
Seliger, H. W. & Shohamy, E. (1990). Second Language Research Methods. Oxford:
Oxford University Press.
Seller, W. (2001). Reforming Schools: building the capacity for change. School Leadership
and Management, 21 (3), 255-259.
Sharkey, J. (2004). ESOL teachers’ Knowledge of Context as Critical Mediator in
Curriculum Development. TESOL Quarterly, 38 (2), 279-299.
Shatat, Y. (1995). The teacher’s Status: whereto? The Teacher, 11 (58), 56.
Shaw, K. (1994). Writing up a Dissertation. In Radnor, H. A. (Ed.) Educational Research
Monograph Series. Exeter: University of Exeter.
267
Shaw, K., Badri, A. & Hukul, A. (1995). Management Concerns in the United Arab Emirates state Schools. International Journalof Educational Management, 9 (4), 8-13.
Sheldon, L. E. (1988). Evaluating ELT Textbooks and Materials. ELT Journal, 42 (4), 237-
246 Short, P.M.; Greer, J.T. & Melvin, W.M. (1994). Creating Empowered Schools: Lessons in
Change. Journal of Educational Administration, 32 (4), 38-52. Shulman, L.S. (1988). Disciplines of Inquiry in Education: An Overview. In R. Jaeger (Ed.)
Complementary Methods for Research in Education (pp.3-17). Washington: AERA Silverman, D. (2001). Doing Qualitative Research: A Practical Handbook. London: Sage
Publications. Smith, D. L. (1990). Curriculum Reform in Australia: Retrospect and Prospect.
Curriculum, 11 (2), 70-79. Smith, D. (1991). Educating the Reflective Practitioner in Curriculum. Curriculum, 12 (2),
115-121. Spikes, P. J. (1992). Imposed Change and the Experienced Teacher. In M. Fullan & A.
Hargreaves (Eds.), Teacher Development and Educational Change. P.p. 36-55. London: The Falmer Press.
Stake, R. E. (1995). The Art of Case Study Research. London: SAGE Publications. Strauss, A. L. (1987). Qualitative Analysis for Social Scientists. Cambridge: Cambridge
University press. Sugrue, C. (1997). Student teachers’ Lay Theories and teaching identities: their implication
for professional development. European Journal of teacher Education, 20 (3), 213-225.
Sulaiman, K. (1987). The Relationship of Selected Variables to the Academic Success of
Students from the United Arab Emirates at American Colleges and Universities. Ed.D. Dissertation, The George Washington University. Michigan: UMI.
Suliman, O. M. (2000). A Descriptive Study of the Educational System in the United Arab
Emirates. Ed.D. Dissertation, University of Southern California. Michigan: UMI. _____________ (2004). Summary of Educational Statistics (2003-2004). Documentation
and Statistics Section, Information and Research department. Dubai: UAE Ministry of Education.
Tantawi, S. A. (1995). Overcoming Low Achievement: Appearance and Reality . The
Teacher, 11 (56), 16-19.
268
Tashakkori, A. & Teddlie, C. (1998). Mixed Methodology: Combining Qualitative and Quantitative Approaches. London: Sage Publications. Taylor, S. J. & Bogdan, R. (1984). Introduction to Qualitative Research Methods: The
Search for Meanings. New York: Wiley-Interscience. Terhart, E. (2003). Constructivism and Teaching: a new paradigm in general didactics.
Journal of Curriculum Studies, 35 (1), 25-44. Terwel, J. (1999). Constructivism and its implications for curriculum theory and practice.
Journal of Curriculum Studies, 31 (2), 195-199. ______________(1998). The Directory of Distribution of Marks in School Subjects. Dubai:
Ministry of Education. ______________(1996). The Education Policy in the United Arab Emirates. Dubai:
Ministry of Education. _____________ (2000). The 2020 Vision for Education: Strategic Domains and Goals,
Executive Projects and Programs for Educational Development in the State. Dubai: Ministry of Education and Youth.
Thomas, H. (2003). The Argument for the Meaning of Quality. ELT Journal, 57 (3), 234-
241. Tillema, H. H. (1997a). Reflective Dialogue in Teams: a vehicle to support belief change in
student teachers. European Journal of teacher Education, 20 (3), 283-295. Tillema, H. H. (1997b). Stability and Change in Student Teachers’ Beliefs. European
Journal of teacher Education, 20 (3), 209-212. Tillema, H. H. (1998). Stability and Change in Student Teachers’ Beliefs about Teaching.
Teachers and Teaching: Theory and Practice, 4 (2), 217-229. Tillema, H. H. & Knol, W. E. (1997). Collaborative Planning by Teacher educators to
Promote Belief Change in their Students. Teachers and Teaching: Theory and Practice, 3 (1), 29-45.
Toref, B. & Warburton, E. C. (2005). Assessment of Teachers’ Beliefs About Classroom Use of Critical-Thinking Activities. Educational and Psychological Measurement, 65 (1), 155-179.
Tribble, C. (2000). Designing Evaluation into Educational Change Processes. ELT Journal,
54 (4), 319-327. Vidich, A. J. & Lyman, S. M. (1994). Qualitative Methods: Their History in Sociology and
Anthropology. In N. K. Denzin & Y. S. Lincoln (Eds.). Handbook of Qualitative Research. Pp. 23-59. Thousand Oaks, California: Sage Publications.
269
Von Wright, M. (1997). Student Teachers’ Beliefs and Changing Teacher Role. European Journal of Teacher education, 20 (3), 257-266.
Warford, M. K. & Reeves, J. (2003). Falling into it: novice TESOL teacher thinking.
Teachers and Teaching: theory and practice, 9 (1), 48-65. Waters, A. & Vilches, M. C. (2001). Implementing ELT Innovations: a Needs Analysis
Framework. ELT Journal, 55 (2), 133-141. Watts, M. & Bentley, D. (1991). Constructivism in the curriculum. Can we close the gap
between strong theoretical version and the weak version of theory-in-practice? The Curriculum Journal, 2 (2), 171-182.
Webb, P. T. (2002). Teacher Power: the exercise of professional autonomy in an era of
strict accountability. Teacher development, 6 (1), 47-61. ____________ (1993), Webster’s Third International Dictionary – Unabridged. Merriam-
Webster INC Publishers. Springfield, Massachusetts, USA. Editor in chief Philip Babcock Gove}.
White, J. P. (1985). Curriculum Evaluation. In M. Golby; J. Greenwald & R. West (Eds.).
Curriculum Design. Pp. 387-398. Kent: The Open University White, R. C. (2001). Curriculum Innovation: A Celebration of Classroom Practice.
Buckingham: Open University Press. Williams, M. & Burden, R. (1998a). Teacher’s and Students’ Perceptions of Classroom
Language. In K. Head (Ed.). Teachers Develop Teachers Research. Kent: IATEFL.
Williams, M. & Burden, R. (1999). Students’ developing Conceptions of Themselves as
Language Learners. The Modern Language Journal, 83 (2), 193-201. Williams, M. D. & Burden, R. L. (2000). Psychology for Language Teachers: A Social
Constructivist Approach. Cambridge: Cambridge University Press. Wolcott, H. F. (1994). Transforming Qualitative Data: Description, Analysis and
Interpretation. London: Sage Publications. Woods, P. (1999). Successful Writing for Qualitative researchers. London: Routledge. Wright, D. (1981). Falling Rolls and Their Implications for the Management of the
Curriculum. Curriculum, 2 (1), 21-30. Wright, M. V. (1997). Student Teachers’ Beliefs and Changing Teacher Role. European
Journal of teacher Education, 20 (3), 257-266. Young, J. H. (1979). Teacher Participation in Curriculum Decision Making: An
Organizational Dilemma. Curriculum Inquiry, 9 (2), 115-127.
270
Zaidan, S. (1995). Language, Education and Development. The Teacher, 11 (56), 37. Zohar, A. (1999). Teachers’ metacognitive knowledge and the instruction of higher order
thinking. Teaching and Teacher Education, 15, 413-429.